Alesis Andromeda A6 analog synthesizer Reference Manual
Below you will find brief information for analog synthesizer Andromeda A6. The Andromeda A6 has 16 of the most elaborate synthesizer voices to date, and these voices sound absolutely wonderful. The attention to detail applied as Alesis Engineering researched the great analog synths of the past has paid off in producing an instrument that has the world-class analog sound, complete with every nuance. There’s nothing “virtual” about the A6: it is a real analog synthesizer.
Advertisement
Advertisement
1 6 - V O I C E R E A L A N A L O G S Y N T H E S I Z E R
R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
February 2001
Your shipping carton should contain the following items:
1.
Andromeda A6 synthesizer
2.
AC power cable
3.
Warranty Registration card
4.
Reference Manual
5.
A list of the Preset and User Bank Mixes and Programs
If anything is missing, please contact your dealer or Alesis immediately.
NOTE: Completing and returning the Warranty Registration card is important.
Alesis contact information:
Alesis Studio Electronics, Inc.
1633 26 th
Street
Santa Monica, CA 90404
USA
Telephone: 800-5-ALESIS (800-525-3747)
E-Mail: [email protected]
Website: http://www.alesis.com
Alesis Andromeda A6
TM
Reference Manual
Revision 1.0
by Dave Bertovic
© Copyright 2001, Alesis Studio Electronics, Inc. All rights reserved. Reproduction in whole or in part is prohibited. “A6”, “QCard” and “FreeLoader” are trademarks of Alesis Studio
Electronics, Inc.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
1
2 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Contents
C
ONTENTS
Important Safety Instructions ....................................................................................7
Instructions to the User (FCC Notice) ............................................................................................11
CE Declaration of Conformity .........................................................................................................13
Introduction ................................................................................................................15
How to Use this Manual....................................................................................................................16
Typographic Conventions..................................................................................................17
Key Terminology ................................................................................................................................18
Chapter 1: Getting Started ........................................................................................21
What You’ll Need, Unpacking, Set Up, Power .............................................................................21
Audio Connections and Pedals........................................................................................................22
MIDI Connections...............................................................................................................................23
Quick Start............................................................................................................................................26
Chapter 2: Playing the A6 .........................................................................................29
A Brief Tour of the Front Panel ........................................................................................................30
How Functions are Grouped .............................................................................................30
Interacting with the Display .............................................................................................................32
Selecting Programs and Mixes .........................................................................................................38
PROGRAM Mode Parameters...........................................................................................39
MIX Mode Parameters ........................................................................................................39
Storing Edited Programs and Mixes ...............................................................................................43
Setting Up Splits and Layers ............................................................................................................47
Using Global Mode.............................................................................................................................49
GLOBAL Mode Parameters...............................................................................................49
Master Controls...................................................................................................................................52
Volume...................................................................................................................................52
Tune........................................................................................................................................52
The Keyboard and Keyboard Modes ..............................................................................................54
Performance Features (KBD MODE, UNISON X, DETUNE) .....................................55
Portamento............................................................................................................................59
The Performance Wheels and Ribbon Controller.........................................................................65
Programming the Wheels and Ribbon.............................................................................66
Pedals and Footswitches ....................................................................................................68
The CLOCK Section............................................................................................................................69
Clock Parameters .................................................................................................................70
Sequencer ..............................................................................................................................71
Arpeggiator...........................................................................................................................79
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis ...................................................................81
An Overview of Synthesis.................................................................................................................81
Analog and Digital Technologies .....................................................................................81
A Little History ....................................................................................................................81
A Little Theory ...................................................................................................................................82
Waveforms ............................................................................................................................82
Fundamentals and Harmonics ..........................................................................................83
Sound Dynamics .................................................................................................................................84
LFOs .......................................................................................................................................87
Components of an Analog Synthesizer ..........................................................................................88
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
3
Contents
Chapter 4: Overview of the Andromeda A6 ..........................................................93
A Few Basic Concepts........................................................................................................................93
A6 Function List..................................................................................................................................95
A6 Functions At-a-Glance .................................................................................................................97
MIDI Overview .................................................................................................................................102
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters ...........................................................................103
Oscillators...........................................................................................................................................103
Oscillator Parameter Descriptions..................................................................................104
VCO Modulation ...............................................................................................................107
Filters...................................................................................................................................................116
What Filters Do ..................................................................................................................116
How Filters Are Designed................................................................................................117
How Filters Work ..............................................................................................................122
Filter Parameter Descriptions..........................................................................................127
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes ................................................................. 131
Modulation.........................................................................................................................................131
Background.........................................................................................................................131
Modulation Principles ......................................................................................................131
Hardware and Software Modulation, Default Mod Paths ........................................133
Envelopes ...........................................................................................................................................134
Envelope Properties ..........................................................................................................134
Envelope Parameter Descriptions ..................................................................................135
TIME Page Parameters......................................................................................................137
SHAPE: Selecting the Stage Slope .................................................................................139
LEVEL Page Parameters ..................................................................................................141
TRIG Page Parameters .....................................................................................................142
Envelope Modes (Norm 1 & 2, Freerun, Susrel) ..........................................................144
Envelope Modulation Triggering (MODTRG).............................................................153
How Modulation Triggering Works .............................................................................155
DYN Page Parameters ......................................................................................................158
LOOP Page Parameters ....................................................................................................160
MOD Pages .........................................................................................................................164
Envelope Examples ...........................................................................................................165
Chapter 7: LFOs, Sample & Hold and Process..................................................... 171
Low Frequency Oscillators .............................................................................................................171
LFO Parameter Descriptions ...........................................................................................171
WAVE Page ........................................................................................................................172
TRIG Page ...........................................................................................................................175
SYNC Page ..........................................................................................................................176
MOD Page ...........................................................................................................................176
Using LFOs as a Trigger Source......................................................................................176
Sample and Hold ..............................................................................................................................177
PROCESS Module.............................................................................................................................179
Tracking Generator (TGEN) ............................................................................................179
Track Gen Level and Track Gen Step.............................................................................179
Tracking Generator Parameter Descriptions................................................................180
Chapter 8: The A6 Mixing System ........................................................................183
Pre Filter Mix/Post Filter Mix ........................................................................................................183
Pre Filter Mix Overview ..................................................................................................................183
Pre Filter Mix Operation..................................................................................................................184
OSC and SUB OSC Controls............................................................................................184
RING MOD Control ..........................................................................................................184
NOISE/EXTERNAL Control...........................................................................................185
Signal Routing through the Filters .................................................................................187
4 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Contents
Post Filter Mix Overview ................................................................................................................189
Post Filter Mix Operation................................................................................................................189
Voice Mix.............................................................................................................................190
MAIN and AUX outputs ..................................................................................................190
Setting Levels in Mix Mode .............................................................................................190
Individual VOICE OUTPUT............................................................................................190
Chapter 9: Custom Modulations ............................................................................. 191
MOD Functions Overview..............................................................................................................191
Avoid duplication with hard-wired mods....................................................................191
Performance control of mods ..........................................................................................192
Using the Modulation Matrix..........................................................................................192
A Few Ground Rules.........................................................................................................197
The Control Routes Section.............................................................................................................198
To change modulation amounts using the CROUTES page: ....................................198
To change the source of a Control Route: .....................................................................199
About Signal Flow in a MOD Path................................................................................................200
About Modulation Sources .............................................................................................................201
Chapter 10: Using Effects ....................................................................................... 203
Introduction .......................................................................................................................................203
Signal Flow..........................................................................................................................203
Basic Controls .....................................................................................................................203
Analog Distortion ..............................................................................................................204
Editing Digital Effects ......................................................................................................................205
To select a Digital Effects Configuration Type:............................................................205
Editing Effect Parameters................................................................................................................206
Choosing a Parameter Page .............................................................................................206
Changing an Individual Parameter................................................................................206
MOD: Modulating Effects Send/Output ......................................................................207
Tutorial: How to Edit a Reverb .....................................................................................................208
Set the Type and Audio Levels .......................................................................................208
Set the Reverb's Decay and Tone ....................................................................................208
Set the Reverb Predelay....................................................................................................209
Change the Tone of the Reverb Decay...........................................................................209
Adjust the Mix....................................................................................................................210
Digital Effects Architecture.............................................................................................................211
The Signal Flow Through the Effects Section...............................................................211
Single....................................................................................................................................211
Dual Effects: Parallel .........................................................................................................212
Dual Effects: Mono ............................................................................................................213
Multi Chain .........................................................................................................................214
Configurations & Parameter Descriptions...................................................................................215
Reverbs ................................................................................................................................215
Delays...................................................................................................................................220
Pitch Effects.........................................................................................................................222
Table of Digital Effects Parameters ...............................................................................................227
Chapter 11: Mix Mode ..............................................................................................243
What is a Mix? ...................................................................................................................................243
Mix Channels vs. MIDI Channels...................................................................................243
Common Mix Settings for MIDI Sequencers...............................................................................244
To make a custom multitimbral Mix:.............................................................................244
MIDI Program Change Messages...................................................................................245
Editing Programs from Mix Mode ................................................................................................245
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
5
Contents
Mix SOLO............................................................................................................................245
To copy a Mix Channel from another Mix:...................................................................245
Effects in Mix Mode..........................................................................................................................246
To set effect send levels for different Mix Channels: ..................................................246
To copy an effect from another Program or Mix: ........................................................246
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions .....................................................................................247
MIDI Basics ........................................................................................................................................247
MIDI Hardware..................................................................................................................247
MIDI Messages...................................................................................................................248
To send an individual Program or Mix out as a MIDI System Exclusive dump:...................................................................................................................................253
To send an entire Program or Mix Bank out as a MIDI System Exclusive dump:...................................................................................................................................254
About receiving SysEx dumps: .......................................................................................254
MIDI and the A6 Andromeda ........................................................................................................255
A6 Channel Messages: Multitimbral Sequencing.......................................................255
Setting MIDI Parameters in Global Mode.....................................................................256
Appendix A: Glossary ..............................................................................................259
Appendix B: Table of Mod Sources .......................................................................261
Appendix C: Troubleshooting .................................................................................265
The Auto Tune Display ...................................................................................................................265
How to Use the Tune Display ........................................................................................................266
Upgrading the Operating System..................................................................................................268
Troubleshooting Chart.....................................................................................................................270
Cleaning and Maintenance .............................................................................................................272
Appendix D: Specifications .....................................................................................273
MIDI Implementation Chart...........................................................................................................273
Specifications .....................................................................................................................................274
Appendix E: Warranty .............................................................................................275
6 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Important Safety Instructions
I
MPORTANT
S
AFETY
I
NSTRUCTIONS
SAFETY SYMBOLS USED IN THIS
PRODUCT
This symbol alerts the user that there are important operating and maintenance instructions in the literature accompanying this unit.
This symbol warns the user of uninsulated voltage within the unit that can cause dangerous electric shocks.
PLEASE FOLLOW THESE PRECAUTIONS
WHEN USING THIS PRODUCT:
1.
Read these instructions.
2.
Keep these instructions.
3. Heed all warnings.
4. Follow all instructions.
5. Do not use this apparatus near water.
6. Clean only with a damp cloth. Do not spray any liquid cleaner onto the faceplate, as this may damage the front panel controls or cause a dangerous condition.
7.
Install in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
8.
Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce heat.
9.
Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug on the AC power adapter. A polarized plug has two blades with one wider than the other. The wide blade is provided for your safety. When the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet.
10. Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched, particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they exit from the apparatus.
11. Use only attachments or accessories specified by the manufacturer.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
7
Important Safety Instructions
12. Use only with a cart, stand, bracket, or table designed for use with professional audio or music equipment. In any installation, make sure that injury or damage will not result from cables pulling on the apparatus and its mounting. If a cart is used, use caution when moving the cart/apparatus combination to avoid injury from tip-over.
13. Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or when unused for long periods of time.
14. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Servicing is required when the apparatus has been damaged in any way, such as when the powersupply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has been dropped.
15. This unit produces heat when operated normally. Operate in a wellventilated area.
16. This product, in combination with an amplifier and headphones or speakers, may be capable of producing sound levels that could cause permanent hearing loss. Do not operate for a long period of time at a high volume level or at a level that is uncomfortable. If you experience any hearing loss or ringing in the ears, you should consult an audiologist.
17. WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire or electric shock, do not expose this
apparatus to rain or moisture.
8 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Important Safety Instructions
I
NSTRUCTIONS DE
S
ÉCURITÉ
I
MPORTANTES
(F
RENCH
)
S
YMBOLES UTILISÉS DANS CE PRODUIT
Ce symbole alèrte l’utilisateur qu’il existe des instructions de fonctionnement et de maintenance dans la documentation jointe avec ce produit.
Ce symbole avertit l’utilisateur de la présence d’une tension non isolée à l’intérieur de l’appareil pouvant engendrer des chocs
électriques.
V
EUILLEZ SUIVRE CES PRÉCAUTIONS LORS DE
L
’
UTILISATION DE L
’
APPAREIL
:
1.
Lisez ces instructions.
2.
Gardez ces instructions.
3.
Tenez compte de tous les avertissements.
4.
Suivez toutes les instructions.
5.
N’utilisez pas cet allareil à proximité de l’eau.
6.
Ne nettoyez qu’avec un chiffon humide. Ne pas vaporiser de liquide nettoyant sur l’appareil, cela pourrait abîmer les contrôles de la face avant ou engendrer des conditions dangeureuses.
7.
Installez selon les recommandations du constructeur.
8.
Ne pas installer à proximilé de sources de chaleur comme radiateurs, cuisinière ou autre appareils (don’t les amplificateurs) produisant de la chaleur.
9.
Ne pas enlever la prise de terre du cordon secteur. Une prise murale avec terre deux broches et une troisièrme reliée à la terre. Cette dernière est présente pour votre sécurité. Si le cordon secteur ne rentre pas dans la prise de courant, demandez à un électricien qualifié de remplacer la prise.
10. Evitez de marcher sur le cordon secteur ou de le pincer, en particulier au niveau de la prise, et aux endroits où il sor de l’appareil.
11. N’utilisez que des accessoires spécifiés par le constructeur.
12. N’utilisez qu’avec un stand, ou table conçus pour l’utilisation d’audio professionnel ou instruments de musique. Dans toute installation, veillez de ne rien endommager à cause de câbles qui tirent sur des appareils et leur support.
13. Débranchez l’appareil lors d’un orage ou lorsqu’il n’est pas utilisé pendant longtemps.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
9
Important Safety Instructions
14. Faites réparer par un personnel qualifié. Une réparation est nécessaire lorsque l’appareil a été endommagé de quelque sorte que ce soit, par exemple losrque le cordon secteur ou la prise sont endommagés, si du liquide a coulé ou des objets se sont introduits dans l’appareil, si celui-ci a été exposé à la pluie ou à l’humidité, ne fonctionne pas normalement ou est tombé.
15. Cet appareil produit de la chaleur en fonctionnement normal.
16. Ce produit, utilisé avec un amplificateur et un casque ou des enceintes, est capable de produite des niveaux sonores pouvant engendrer une perte permanente de l’ouïe. Ne l’utilisez pas pendant longtemps à un niveau sonore
élevé ou à un niveau non confortable. Si vous remarquez une perte de l’ouïe ou un bourdonnement dans les oreilles, consultez un spécialiste.
10 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Important Safety Instructions
B
EIM
B
ENUTZEN DIESES
P
RODUKTES BEACHTEN
S
IE BITTE DIE FOLGENDEN
S
ICHERHEITSHINWEISE
:
(G
ERMAN
)
1.
Lesen Sie die Hinweise.
2.
Halten Sie sich an die Anleitung.
3.
Beachten Sie alle Warnungen.
4.
Beachten Sie alle Hinweise.
5.
Bringen Sie das Gerät nie mit Wasser in Berührung.
6.
Verwenden Sie zur Reinigung nur ein weiches Tuch. Sprühen Sie keine flüssiger
Reiniger auf die Oberfläche, dies könnte zur Beschädigung der Vorderseite führen und auch weitere Schäden verursachen.
7.
Halten Sie sich beim Aufbau des Gerätes an die Angaben des Herstellers.
8.
Stellen Sie das Gerät nich in der Nähe von Heizkörpern, Heizungsklappen oder anderen Wärmequellen (einschließlich Verstärkern) auf.
9.
Verlegen Sie das Netzkabel des Gerätes niemals so, daß man darüber stolpern kann oder daß es gequetscht wird.
10. Benutzen Sie nur das vom Hersteller empfohlene Zubehör.
11. Verwenden Sie ausschließlich Wagen, Ständer, oder Tische, die speziell für professionelle Audio- und Musikinstrumente geeignet sind. Achten Sie immer darauf, daß die jeweiligen Geräte sicher installiert sind, um Schäden und
Verletzungen zu vermeiden. Wenn Sie einen Rollwagen benutzen, achten Sie darauf, das dieser nicht umkippt, um Verletzungen auszuschließen.
12. Ziehen Sie während eines Gewitters oder wenn Sie das Gerät über einen längeren Zeitraum nicht benutzen den Netzstecher aus der Steckdose.
13. Die Wartung sollte nur durch qualifiziertes Fachpersonal erfolgen. Die Wartung wird notwendig, wenn das Gerät beschädigt wurde oder aber das Stromkabel oder der Stecker, Gegenstände oder Flüssigkeit in das Gerät gelangt sind, das
Gerät dem Regen oder Feuchtigkeit ausgesetzt war und deshalb nicht mehr normal arbeitet oder heruntergefallen ist.
14. Bei normalem Betrieb des Gerätes kommt es zu Wärmeentwicklungen.
15. Dieses Produkt kann in Verbindung mit einem Verstärker und Kopfhörern oder
Lautsprechern Lautstärkepegel erzeugen, die anhaltende Gehörschäden verursachen. Betreiben Sie es nicht über längere Zeit mit hoher Lautstärke oder einem Pegel, der Ihnen unangenehm is. Wenn Sie ein Nachlassen des Gehörs oder ein Klingeln in den Ohren feststellen, sollten Sie einen Ohrenarzt aufsuchen.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
11
Important Safety Instructions
I
NSTRUCTIONS TO THE
U
SER
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try and correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:
•
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
•
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
•
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
•
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
This equipment has been verified to comply with the limits for a class B computing device, pursuant to FCC Rules. In order to maintain compliance with FCC regulations, shielded cables must be used with this equipment. Operation with nonapproved equipment or unshielded cables is likely to result in interference to radio and TV reception. The user is cautioned that changes and modifications made to the equipment without the approval of manufacturer could void the user’s authority to operate this equipment.
12 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Important Safety Instructions
CE D
ECLARATION OF
C
ONFORMITY
PRELIMINARY FOR INFORMATION ONLY
OCTOBER PRODUCTION AND ALPHA UNITS ARE NOT YET CERTIFIED
FOR EXPORT OUTSIDE THE UNITED STATES AS OF THIS WRITING
Manufacturer’s Name
: Alesis Corporation
Manufacturer’s Address
: 1633 26th Street
Santa Monica, CA 90404
USA
declares, that the product:
Product Name
:
Model Type
:
A6
Analog Synthesizer
conforms to the following Standards:
EMC
: EN 55022:1995 Class B
IEC 801-2:1984 2nd Edition, 4kV direct, 8kV air; IEC 801-3:1984 2;
3V/m 150MHz-1GHz, IEC 801-
4:1988 1st Edition 2; 1kV, 0.5kV
Safety
: EN 60065
European Contact
: Sound
17 Letchworth Point, Lechworth,
Hertfordshire, SG6 1ND, England.
Phone: +44.1462.480000
Fax: +44.1462.480800
May, 2000
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
13
Important Safety Instructions
14 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Introduction
I
NTRODUCTION
There was a time when most of us thought that analog synthesis was dead. Yeah, there were a few new analog instruments – and rather decent ones, at that – that have come and gone over the past few years. They were glimmers of hope that the robust, full and rich sounds of the analogs could peacefully co-exist with the digitals. I was excited that a handful of manufacturers were still “carrying the ball” and believed that there will always be a place in the music world for a great analog synth. But for some reason, these instruments – as good as they are – seem to be a little lacking in many respects.
Then I was introduced to the Andromeda A6. Simply stated, this box has more features and music power per square inch than any other synthesizer I’ve owned.
And I’ve owned a bunch of them, starting with an obscure little monophonic instrument called the MiniMoog
®
in 1973. To me, the A6 represents the next significant step in the development of musical instruments that celebrate this technology.
The Andromeda A6 starts out with 16 of the most elaborate synthesizer voices to date, and these voices sound absolutely wonderful. The attention to detail applied as
Alesis Engineering researched the great analog synths of the past has paid off in producing an instrument that has the world-class analog sound, complete with every nuance. There’s nothing “virtual” about the A6: it is a real analog synthesizer.
This synthesizer has more modulation and control functionality than most players can fully use in a lifetime. It has an studio-quality effects system, an elaborate MIDI system and one of the most logical and useful displays on the market. Add to that an
Arpeggiator, a classic 16-event Sequencer, a Ribbon controller and CV inputs, and you have an analog powerhouse with all of the tools — and all of the toys.
Last, but certainly not least, the A6 is gorgeous. And its striking layout and front panel artwork is every bit as functional as it is beautiful.
We’ve just touched on the some of the highlights of this product; there’s much more to be explored. After you’ve read through this Reference, and experienced the sound and feel of the A6, I’m confident that you will be every bit as excited about it as I am.
There will always be a place in the music world for a great analog synth.
Dave Bertovic
Winter 2001
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
15
Introduction
H
OW TO
U
SE THIS
M
ANUAL
S
TRUCTURE
This manual was designed to take you through the A6 in a logical order of topics.
This way, anyone who is new to this type of instrument can read through the book from front to back and get the most basic information first. The manual progressively deals with more complex topics as you read through to the end. Experienced users can simply use this manual as a reference resource, browsing through the topics as needed. An Index is provided at the end of the manual for quick referrals to specific subjects or problems. The Appendices provide technical information about the A6.
The Chapters can be grouped into five categories of information:
Overview
– Chapters 1 and 2
Chapter 1 is your basic introduction to the A6, from getting it out of the box, setting it up and plugging it in to making simple audio and MIDI connections, and hooking up pedals and footswitches.
Once you get everything connected, Chapter 2 takes you on a detailed tour of the A6.
This Chapter runs you through the most commonly used performance features of the unit, including a discussion of how the display works and how to select sounds.
We’ll also take a good look at Master Volume and Tune, the keyboard and its modes,
Portamento, the Sequencer and Arpeggiator, the two performance Wheels and the
Ribbon Controller.
Synthesis and the A6
– Chapters 3 and 4
This section of the manual starts out with Chapter 3 giving you a broad background of analog synthesis, including some history and acoustic theory. All of this is then applied to a generic analog synthesizer to illustrate the electronic counterparts of a sound’s components.
If you are new to analog synthesis, we strongly recommend that you read this
Chapter in its entirety. What you will learn here will help the rest of the manual make sense.
Where Chapter 3 provides you with concepts, Chapter 4 brings it all home to the A6.
Here, you’ll learn how the A6’s sounds are organized, and how the front and back panels are laid out. A complete list of the A6’s functions are presented along with concise descriptions.
Program Functions
– Chapters 5, 6, 7, 8, and 9
These five Chapters take you through every function that makes up a Program.
Here’s where the theory we covered in Chapter 3 meets reality: what the knobs and switches do to affect each aspect of the sound.
Sound Applications
– Chapters 10, 11 and 12
Chapter 10 covers all the bases when it comes to using the Andromeda’s powerful internal effects. Chapter 11 deals with Mix mode: the A6’s memory functions for combining two or more Programs. Mix mode is where you create splits and layers,
multiple
splits and layers and other multitimbral configurations. We’ll also explore incorporating external Programs with the A6’s internal sounds.
Chapter 12 takes a good, long look at MIDI: an introductory tutorial on MIDI functions followed by MIDI operations specific to the A6.
16 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Introduction
Technical
– The Appendices
The appendices at the end of the A6 Reference Manual provide concise information about the instrument from a technical perspective:
Appendix A is a complete reference that documents every function in the unit.
Appendix B is glossary of common terms we use throughout the manual.
Appendix C covers all warranty, servicing and maintenance issues.
Appendix D provides troubleshooting assistance and covers the majority of common problems you might incur while using the A6.
Appendix E provides a list of the A6’s technical and design specifications including the instrument’s MIDI Implementation Chart.
The Index is a comprehensive cross-reference to all of the topics and terminology in the manual.
T
YPOGRAPHIC
C
ONVENTIONS
Knob, button and back panel jack labels are printed in
SMALL BOLD CAPITALS
.
Words or phrases that appear in the display are printed using type that resembles the DISPLAY characters .
A new or important term is in italics followed by its definition or contextual meaning.
Paragraphs in italics provide additional information on a topic that might be helpful in understanding certain important concepts.
Tip
: A hint or special example called a Tip is set off from the main text by a box with a light-gray fill.
Important instructions or emphasis on a word or phrase are printed in boldface
type
.
icon like the one on the left will appear in the left margin. This indicates that this information is vital when operating the A6.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
17
Introduction
K
EY
T
ERMINOLOGY
While we define terms throughout this manual, and also provide a Glossary at the end, we’d like to list a few terms now that will help you get a head start on some of the technical expressions used in this document:
Voice
A synthesizer voice is the most basic component of a synthesizer that produces sound. A voice is all of the hardware and software that is necessary to produce one note of sound.
The A6 has 16 voices: 16 independent “sound-producing components” that play when a key or keys are played on its keyboard, or when MIDI Notes are received.
This also means that 16 voices is the limit: if you play more than 16 keys at a time (or the A6 receives more than 16 MIDI Notes), only 16 will play.
Program
and Mix
Where a voice is the instrument’s sound-producing component, a Program is all the
settings
that cause the voices to produce a particular sound. This is where many of the front panel controls come in. They are used to create the individual sounds of the
A6 and their values (settings) are stored as a Program.
A Mix is two or more Programs that can be played at the same time. Mix mode is where you make settings for splits and layers plus numerous combinations of
Programs, and keyboard/MIDI control.
RAM
and
ROM
Related to Programs and Mixes, these two terms refer to the physical circuit chips inside the A6 where data is stored. RAM stands for Random Access Memory and is a type of memory that you can change. This manual refers to RAM as user memory.
In addition to Programs and Mixes, Global setings are also stored in RAM (see the definition of Global mode later in this topic).
ROM stands for Read Only Memory and is a type of memory that is, for the most part, permanent. The A6 uses a type of ROM called Flash ROM which can be modified but only under special circumstances. So, for all intents and purposes, consider ROM to be read-only. This manual refers to ROM as preset memory.
Parameter
Virtually all of the main functions of the A6 are comprised of smaller elements or parts. These elements are all related in some way to the overall operation of the function they constitute. Each of these elements or parts is referred to as a parameter.
Using an Envelope as an example, it is comprised of no less than 47 parameters: six adjustments for time, five adjustments for level, eight trigger settings, six dynamics settings, eight loop parameters, plus settings for slope (with nine options), 12 modulation parameters and clock-synchronization settings.
Page
The display will group a function’s parameters together on the screen called a display page. Some A6 functions have more than one page because they have more parameters than can be displayed in the available screen area. This is called a multi-
page display and each page’s title is printed on a page tab which resembles a tab in a notebook.
Editing
When you make a change to a parameter in a Program or Mix, or to a Global function
– by adjusting its numeric value, turning it on or off and so forth – this is called editing.
18 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Introduction
Offset
Many of the Andromeda A6’s parameters have an additional adjustment called offset.
This is simply an adjustment of the parameter by a fixed amount
Default
When the A6 is shipped from the factory, each of its parameters has a pre-assigned value called a default. This is so that when a parameter is selected, it displays some setting – on or off status, positive or negative status, a number or another appropriate entry – that is either a neutral setting, or one that's a good starting point for editing.
Amplitude
The most common use of this word is using it to describe loudness or volume. But strictly speaking, amplitude refers to the level of a signal, its “intensity” (or lack of it) or the “signal strength”. And this includes any signal: the sound coming from the oscillators, vibrato from an LFO, an envelope and so forth.
So care must be taken not to associate amplitude with volume exclusively; it can be
(and most often is) used to generically describe a signal’s level whether it’s volume or not. When we cover envelopes in the next chapter, for example, amplitude control is one of an envelope’s main characteristics, but it doesn’t always mean volume.
We’ll simply use the term amplitude when referring to any kind of level.
Frequency
The most common use of this word is to describe musical pitch or notes. Although this is accurate, there are other things that have frequency even though you might not be able to hear them directly. Frequency is defined as rate or speed, usually expressed in “cycles-per-second” which indicates how many times a wave or pattern is repeated in one second. Cycles-per-second is most often referred to as “Hertz” – abbreviated “Hz” – named after the German physicist who established this unit of measurement, Heinrich Hertz. Many of our examples will involve frequencies in the thousands of cycles per second, referred to as “kilo-Hertz” and abbreviated “kHz”.
We’ll use the term frequency to refer to the rate of repetition of any component of the
A6: the pitch of the
VCO
s, the speed of the
LFO
s, the harmonic characteristics of the
FILTER
s and the
CLOCK
rate, among others.
Note
On
and
Note Off
The A6 can be played from four sources. The two primary ones are its own built-in keyboard, or a MIDI device such as another MIDI keyboard. It also can be played by a sequencer (including software sequencers running on a computer), or a drum machine – anything capable of sending MIDI Note On commands and a MIDI Note
Off commands. In addition, the A6 can be “played” by its own Sequencer and
Arpeggiator.
To simplify our discussions in the manual, we’ll use the term Note On to refer to a key being pressed on the A6’s keyboard, a MIDI Note On message being received by the A6, or notes being played from the A6’s Arpeggiator and Sequencer, since they all essentially accomplish the same thing.
We’ll use the term Note Off when referring to a pressed key being let go on the A6’s keyboard, a received MIDI Note Off message or the end of the Gate Time from the
Sequencer and Arpeggiator.
Trigger
and
Gate
The concept of triggers and gates is often a confusing one for many synthesizer users.
They are similar in that they both instruct a modulation source to begin, but that’s where the similarity ends.
A trigger is best described as a “go” signal that is routed from a source (such as the keyboard) to a modulation function. A trigger has no significant duration as it is
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
19
Introduction
simply an electronic pulse. Translating our definition of trigger to MIDI, a trigger is the equivalent of a Note On command.
By contrast, a gate not only performs a “go” instruction but also carries with it a duration characteristic. Using the keyboard as in the above example, a gate signal is active for the time that a key is held down; a trigger is generated only at the instant the key is first played. Translating our definition of gate to MIDI, the duration of a gate is the time that elapses between the Note On and the Note Off commands.
LED
This acronym stands for Light Emitting Diode, a technical name for a simple feature.
It refers to the small panel lights on the A6’s front panel. When an LED next to a knob or button is on, this indicates that the function is active.
Global
The term global, used often in this manual, refers to any function that affects the A6 no matter what play mode it’s in: global functions affect all Programs and Mixes. You can think of global functions as “master” functions. Master Tune is a perfect example of this – it tunes the whole instrument. Other global functions, described in detail later in the manual, include Master Volume, Pitch and Mod Wheel assignments, the
Clock’s tempo and certain MIDI functions. While not programmable in the sense of being stored with Programs and Mixes, global settings are kept in a section of RAM dedicated to global functions and are retained when the A6 is turned off.
Linear
,
Exponential
and
Logarithmic
These are mathematical terms that are used in A6 to describe the way certain functions perform, most notably Envelope stages and Portamento. When a function is said to have a “linear response”, we mean that it produces an even rate of change that, when depicted by a graph, resembles a straight line (hence the term “linear”).
Functions that have exponential and logarithmic responses produce rates of change that accelerate (speed up) or decelerate (slow down) rather than stay even. Instead of a straight line which represents simple ratios, expo and log functions are a little more complex and are graphed by curves.
20 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 1: Getting Started
C
HAPTER
1
G
ETTING
S
TARTED
W
HAT
Y
OU
’
LL
N
EED
The A6’s basic requirements include:
1.
an AC electrical outlet
2.
a stand or table to put it on
3.
audio cables and a sound system or amplifier, or a pair of headphones
U
SING THE
A6
WITH
O
THER
I
NSTRUMENTS
If you plan to use the A6 with other MIDI devices, you’ll need standard MIDI cables that connect your A6 to other MIDI devices in your system. See the topic
Hook It Up
below for more information. It would also help if you have basic working knowledge of MIDI. If you’re new to MIDI, read our MIDI tutorial in Chapter 10.
U
NPACK
I
T
The A6 is packaged in a cardboard box with molded styrofoam inserts. After you remove your A6, its AC power cord, the Warranty card and this manual, we suggest you keep all packing materials in a safe place. You’ll need the box and styrofoam in case the unit needs to be transported or shipped.
S
ET
I
T
U
P
You can place the A6 just about anywhere that’s convenient. Before placing the A6 on a stand or table, be certain that is capable of securely holding an object that weighs 40 lbs. (18.15kg). You should also consider any pounding that you might be giving it. If the stand collapses under the A6’s weight (or your playing), the unit could suffer permanent damage and you could be injured. Take the time right now to make sure that your stand is adequate.
H
OOK
I
T
U
P
P
OWER
Use the AC power cord (or equivalent) that is included with the A6. Make sure that the unit is turned off before you plug the power cord into the rear panel receptacle and the wall outlet. The unit has a universal power supply that should work with local AC power in most countries. If in doubt, check with your power company before plugging it in. In the U.S., the A6 must be plugged into a standard 117 VAC,
50 - 60 Hz outlet.
Do not attempt to use another type of power cable and do not attempt to modify this receptacle or the cable itself. Doing so may cause serious injury or death. Please refer to the section
Important
Safety Instructions at the beginning of this manual.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
21
Chapter 1: Getting Started
A
UDIO
C
ONNECTIONS
After you’ve set up the A6 and plugged it into an AC outlet, connect your A6 to a sound system. Since the A6 does not contain an amplifier or speakers, you’ll need to connect it to some kind of a sound system in order to hear it. An amp with a fullrange speaker will also suffice, as will a stereo music system with external audio inputs. You can also use a pair of standard stereo headphones with a 1/4” TRS plug inserted into the back panel.
For stereo, connect two 1/4” 2-conductor (unbalanced) audio cables from the unit’s
LEFT
and
RIGHT
jacks on the rear panel to two inputs on your sound system. For a monophonic output, use an audio cable from the A6’s
LEFT
jack. The four
AUX OUT
jacks plus the eight stereo
VOICE OUTPUTS
will be covered in Chapter 4.
For use with stereo headphones, the A6 sports a 1/4” stereo
HEADPHONE
jack on the rear panel.
In any case, turn your A6 on first, then your sound system or amplifier. Use the
MASTER VOLUME
control located near the front panel’s upper left-hand corner to set the overall output level of the synthesizer.
P
EDALS AND
F
OOTSWITCHES
Momentary, 2-conductor foot switches are used for the
SWITCH
and
SUSTAIN
inputs on the A6’s back panel. “Momentary” means that it is a spring-loaded switch that operates by “pressing and releasing” for
ON
(press) or
OFF
(release) signals.
A potentiometer, 2-conductor foot pedal is used for the
PEDAL/CV
back panel input.
This input is typically used for volume or modulation (typically vibrato, but you can use it for other types of modulation). “Potentiometer” means that the pedal mechanically operates an internal knob giving you “more” or “less” rather than
ON or
OFF like a switch. These pedals are often referred to as “rocker pedals”.
22 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 1: Getting Started
MIDI C
ONNECTIONS
If you plan to use the A6 with other
MIDI
instruments and devices in a music system, use the following guide to connect it to your rig.
As a Master
: If you intend to use the A6 as the master controller in your
MIDI rig, plug a standard
MIDI
cable into the A6’s
MIDI OUT
port. The other end of this cable should plug into the
MIDI IN
of the first slave in the system. If there are several MIDI instruments in your setup, connect
MIDI THRU
from the first slave to the
MIDI IN
of the second device and so forth to create a “chain”.
PHONES VOLUME
64 VOICE EXPANDABLE SYNTHESIZER MODULE
MIDI CHANNEL
VALUE EDIT MODE
CURSOR EDIT
MIDI CH STORE
MIX
PLAY MODE
PROG
DOWN UP
COMPARE
BANK SELECT
GLOBAL
PCMCIA EXPANSION CARDS
A
B
POWER
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
23
Chapter 1: Getting Started
As a Slave
: If you plan to control the A6 from another
MIDI
device, you’ll need a
MIDI
cable connected to its
MIDI IN
port.
You will also need a MIDI cable connected to the A6’s
MIDI THRU
if you plan to pass MIDI data from the master through the A6 to other MIDI devices in your rig. Connect one end of the MIDI cable to the A6’s
MIDI THRU
port and the other end of the cable to the
MIDI IN
of the first device in the chain.
PHONES VOLUME
64 VOICE EXPANDABLE SYNTHESIZER MODULE
MIDI CHANNEL
VALUE EDIT MODE
CURSOR EDIT
MIDI CH STORE
MIX
PLAY MODE
PROG
DOWN
COMPARE
BANK SELECT
UP
GLOBAL
PCMCIA EXPANSION CARDS
A
B
POWER
24 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
With a MIDI Patchbay:
Chapter 1: Getting Started
If you’re using a MIDI patchbay or “patcher” to connect all of your MIDI devices centrally, the patcher will have a pair of MIDI connectors for each MIDI device. The patcher’s back panel will have a series of paired
MIDI OUT
and
MIDI IN
ports for each device in your rig (the A6 being one of them).
Connect the A6’s
MIDI OUT
to the
MIDI IN
of one of the pairs. The same pair’s
MIDI OUT
connects to the
MIDI IN
of the A6. Consult the patcher’s Owner’s Manual to find out how it routes MIDI data among the devices connected to it.
PHONES VOLUME
64 VOICE EXPANDABLE SYNTHESIZER MODULE
MIDI CHANNEL
VALUE EDIT MODE
CURSOR EDIT
MIDI CH STORE
MIX
PLAY MODE
PROG
DOWN
COMPARE
BANK SELECT
UP
GLOBAL
PCMCIA EXPANSION CARDS
A
B
POWER
This covers the basics of setting up the A6.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
25
Chapter 1: Getting Started
Q
UICK
S
TART
: P
LAYING
Y
OUR
F
IRST
P
ROGRAM
A
UTO
T
UNE
Now that it's all hooked up, there's one more thing you have to do. If you've jumped the gun and played a few chords, you probably heard that the unit was way out of tune. Because the Andromeda is a true analog synthesizer, and analog circuitry is sensitive to temperature and other factors, each one of the sixteen voices (and the oscillators and filters within each voice) must be tuned before playing. Luckily, the
Andromeda has a software routine that will do this for you.
To tune the Andromeda's voices automatically:
On the left side of the control panel above the Mod Wheel, find the MASTER section, with a Volume and a Tune knob. Press the
AUTO TUNE
button beneath these, which will bring up the Auto Tune display. Press
AUTO TUNE
again to start the tuning process.
On the display, you will see each individual oscillator, pulse width, and filter tuned in turn. This takes about three and a half minutes, during which you won't be able to play the unit. (Later, you can save time by tuning only the oscillators if you wish, by pressing the button under
OSCFRQ
in the display.)
Once the unit is tuned, you'll see a screen with lists of multiple
TUNEOK
columns.
After the unit has warmed up some more, if you hear something off-key, you may press
AUTO TUNE
again.
In addition, the A6 has a feature called background tuning. This automatically tunes voices in the background without interrupting playing. (More about turning this on and off can be found in later sections of the manual.)
26 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 1: Getting Started
S
ELECTING
P
ROGRAMS
You don't have to know what all the knobs do to enjoy the A6; it comes preprogrammed with hundreds of sounds. You can simply listen to these sounds and find out more about them later. When playing the A6, the instrument operates in one of two play modes: Program mode and Mix mode. In Program mode, the keyboard plays a single sound across the entire keyboard. Program mode has 3 banks: User, Preset 1, and Preset 2. Each bank has 128 different Programs, so you have a total of 384 Programs to audition. In Mix mode, it may play different sounds in different ranges (a split), a stack of sounds on top of each other, or combination of splits and stacks. There are two banks in Mix mode (one User and one Preset) for a total of 256 Mixes. Between the two modes, you have 640 "patches" to select from.
To select Programs and Mixes:
1.
To select a Program, make sure that the A6 is in Program mode: the LED next to the
PROGRAM
button should be on. If not, press the
PROGRAM
button.
The easiest method of selecting Programs or Mixes to use the row of direct-select buttons just above the Ribbon Controller. Pressing a 2-digit
PROGRAM GROUP
button selects the “tens group”...
and pressing a single-digit
PROGRAM NUMBER
button selects the specific Program:
OR
To select a Mix
, make sure that the A6 is in Mix mode: the LED next to the
MIX
button should be on. If not, press the
MIX
button.
2. To select a specific Program, press a
PROGRAM GROUP
button then a
PROGRAM
NUMBER
button. Pressing the “
50
” button, for example, plus the “
8
” button selects Program
58
, Mix
58
, or PROG 58 in a Mix Channel.
3. You can move among Banks by pressing the
<
BANK
or
BANK
>
button:
For example, when the Andromeda is in
PROGRAM
mode, you have three Program Banks from which to choose Programs: two factory Preset Banks and the
User Bank (where you store Programs that you create).
Use the
BANK
buttons to switch among these three
Banks. Mix Mode works the same: when MIX Mode is active, use the
BANK
buttons to switch among the two
Mix Banks (one Preset and one User).
As you change programs, you'll notice various lights on the top panel will change.
Disregard this for now.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
27
Chapter 1: Getting Started
M
ASTER
V
OLUME
And finally, adjust the level using the
MASTER VOLUME
on the left side of the control panel. The
VOICE MIX LEVEL
on the right side is a programmable control—it may seem to do the same thing, but avoid using it for now.
The
MASTER VOLUME
knob is a
global (affects the A6 in all modes) volume control that determines the final output level of the unit’s
MAIN LEFT
and
RIGHT
stereo outs, the
HEADPHONE
output and the two
AUX OUT
s. It does not affect the eight stereo
VOICE OUTPUTS
. To use an audio term,
MASTER
VOLUME
is post (comes after) the
PRE
and
POST FILTER
mixes and the
VOICE MIX
. This means that any relative level settings you make within the Programs and
Mixes are preserved.
You operate this control by simply turning it: fully counter-clockwise shuts the audio outputs off, fully clockwise is maximum.
The next Chapter covers the basics of playing the A6: more detail about how to select
Programs and Mixes, understanding the various keyboard modes including setting up splits and layers and using portamento, using the performance wheels and the ribbon controller, using pedals and footswitches, and understanding the
CLOCK
section in using the sequencer and arpeggiator.
Chapter 2 will also devote much attention to the display, as it is the central focus of the A6 when operating its controls.
28 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
C
HAPTER
2:
P
LAYING THE
A6
Possibly the best way to get acquainted with the A6 is to dig in and start playing.
Feel free to skip around this Chapter if you need to get specific information quickly.
This Chapter deals specifically with functions you’re most likely to use when playing the instrument:
•
getting around the front panel
•
understanding and using the display
•
selecting Programs and Mixes
•
setting up splits and layers
•
using the Master controls
•
exploring the various keyboard modes
•
using the performance wheels and ribbon controller
•
using pedals and footswitches
•
the Clock section: using the sequencer and arpeggiator
Quite possibly the most fundamental skill you’ll need to acquire in using the A6 successfully is understanding the display. The essentials of operating the display are covered in this Chapter, and as you use the display on a regular basis, its operation will become much clearer. Once you get a hold of the concepts and procedures laid out in this section, you’ll be ready to undertake the remaining tutorials in this book.
The one glaring omission of this Chapter – which is intentional, by the way – is a tutorial on MIDI. If you need an explanation of this technology now, go to Chapter
12. The first half of Chapter 12 is devoted to the MIDI Specification, which serves as a good starting point for those new to this system. Real-world applications with numerous examples in connecting the A6 to other MIDI devices were covered in the previous Chapter.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
29
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
A B
RIEF
T
OUR OF THE
F
RONT
P
ANEL
The A6’s front panel contains a fairly large number of buttons and knobs, which is probably a lot more than most players are used to seeing on a synthesizer these days.
The A6 is designed to make editing as easy and as quick as possible: the majority of
Program voice parameters exist on the front panel with a knob or button dedicated exclusively to that function. Having dedicated knobs and buttons achieves the speed goal by not forcing you to dig through layers and layers of functions on the display just to make a simple or routine edit.
The speed of Program editing is enhanced further by the functionality of the display.
As we’ll discover in the next topic
I
NTERACTING WITH THE
D
ISPLAY
, the A6’s LCD screen employs a set of soft controls – controls that change function depending on the current screen. These eight buttons and eight knobs are used to edit whatever is being displayed. Therefore, the display area provides a second location where
Program editing can happen.
So you have a choice: you can make Program edits directly from any front panel control, or you can do it in the display area. In either case, the display will change to reflect the current edit you’re making. You can even lock the display so that it
doesn’t
switch every time an edit is attempted. More on that later.
H
OW
F
UNCTIONS ARE
G
ROUPED
Understanding how the A6’s functions are grouped will greatly enhance your ability to learn and use the instrument. The following topics describe these function groups
– called modules – of the A6.
Program-Specific Functions
There are numerous functions within the A6 that deal only with the creating or editing of Programs. In fact, most of the controls on the front panel that are in the area above the keyboard (not including the display area) are Program functions.
The front panel is laid out such that each Module and its related parameters are visually grouped by the artwork:
LFOs
PROCESS
OSC 1
OSC 2
PRE FILTER MIX
Display
and Soft Controls*
EFFECTS*
EXTERNAL INPUTS*
* also available for Mixes.
FILTER 1
FILTER 2
POST FILTER MIX
ENV 1 (PITCH)
ENV 2 (FILTER)
ENV 3 (AMP)
VOICE MIX
These functions will be covered in detail in
Chapter 4: A6 Overview
and
Chapter
5: Program Functions
. But of particular importance to note now, especially for seasoned analog synthesists who are familiar with earlier modular products, is that each of the above function groups can be thought of as a “physical module minus the patch cords”. In fact, you can “disconnect” some of these modules from the audio and control paths by setting their values to zero, in effect turning them off. That’s why they’re called “modules”.
Mix-Specific Functions
Mix mode, because of its nature in simply organizing existing Programs into splits, layers and other Voice arrangements, has far fewer controls than those for constructing the Programs themselves. Notice that Mix controls are conspicuously absent from the A6’s front panel – you access these functions from the display. The basics of layering and splitting are covered later in this chapter on page 47.
30 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Mix mode is also used when the A6 is connected to a MIDI sequencer for multitimbral recording and playback. Each Mix channel, the set of parameters that are used to control a Program in the Mix, can be assigned to a specific MIDI Channel with unique MIDI controller assignments.
Especially noteworthy of Mix mode is that it has its own set of programmable effects.
All of the effects available for enhancing Programs are included in this mode and are fully independent and programmable per Mix. This is particularly useful when constructing complex Mixes that use many different Programs. These functions are covered in detail later in this manual in
Chapter 11: Mix Mode
.
Global Functions
Global functions are those that affect the A6 no matter what mode it’s in. You can think of global functions as “master” controls such as
MASTER VOLUME
or
MASTER
TUNE
.
Also, there are certain MIDI functions that are global as well. Every MIDI instrument or device has a setting called the Basic MIDI Channel. This sets the Channel on which the instrument will normally transmit MIDI data, although the “upper” and “lower” components of splits and layers can be set to transmit and receive on Channels other than the Basic. Global Mode is covered later in this Chapter on page 50,
Using
Global Mode.
But first, let's become familiar with the Andromeda's display and soft controls.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
31
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
I
NTERACTING WITH THE
D
ISPLAY
Although the A6 has numerous knobs and buttons across its front panel, the display
(and its associated controls) is the central area to use when operating the A6. This concept holds true in all modes: with few exceptions, virtually every front panel knob and button are duplicated on-screen, and most of them will show their current settings if appropriate.
32
D
ISPLAY
F
EATURES
As a general principle, the display will group a function’s parameters together on the screen. This makes creating and editing Programs and Mixes much easier, as is getting around in Global mode.
A group of parameters on the screen is called a display page. Some A6 functions have more than one page because they have more parameters than can be displayed in the available screen area. This is called a multi-page display and the active page’s title is displayed on a page tab which resembles a tab in a notebook. The active parameter’s title is displayed in white characters with a black-highlighted tab. This way, you will always know which page and which parameter on that page is active.
In addition, the display’s usefulness is enhanced by depicting certain functions with a graphic. Furthermore, the picture changes as you make adjustments to its parameters. Envelope shapes, LFO waves and Velocity curves are displayed in graph form, just to name a few. A visual representation of the item(s) you’re changing not only makes the editing process faster, it will (in many cases) assist you in understanding the functionality of the parameters you’re working with.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
B
ASIC
D
ISPLAY
F
UNCTIONS
In its normal operating mode, the display will react to virtually any change you
make to any of the front panel controls
. When you turn a knob or press a button, the display will recall that parameter’s page and select the parameter for editing. This feature of the A6 will save you an enormous amount of time and frustration when making changes and minimizes the risk of “getting lost” when editing many parameters at the same time.
While this feature of the A6 is quite useful when working with individual
parameters
, you may want to display a particular module. In this case, press its
VIEW
button. This will display the selected module –
OSC 1
,
OSC 2
,
FILTER 1
,
FILTER 2
,
ENV 1
,
ENV 2
or
ENV 3
, etc. – and the last parameter that was used in that module will be the active one. You can then proceed to make your edits from either the screen’s controls or the module’s dedicated front panel controls.
The advantage of the
VIEW
button is that you can select a module and view its
current settings without changing any of its parameters
. If you turn one of the front panel knobs, its value will change. So if you just want to see the module’s current settings without making changes, use the
VIEW
button.
On the other hand, the advantage of a module’s dedicated front panel controls is that
you can make edits to its most commonly used parameters quickly
just by turning a knob. The choice is yours.
Soft Controls
Directly beneath the display is a series of eight untitled knobs and buttons numbered
1
through
8
. These are soft controls – controls that change function depending on the current screen. Soft controls, therefore, obtain their functional identity or
“personality” from the pages and parameters being displayed: the current function of any knob or button is determined by what is on the display directly above the control. There are three rows in most displays:
• the bottom row of the display is called the Page Row. It shows the names of display pages that can be called up by pressing the button beneath the page
tab
.
• the second row of text shows the function of each knob. We’ll refer to this row of text as the Parameter Row.
• the third row of text (in reversed text like this ) shows the current value of each parameter. We’ll refer to this row of text as the Value Row.
Tip
: Although you can select any parameter simply by turning its corresponding soft knob, this action also changes the parameter’s value which isn’t always desirable. Sometimes you just want to review the current settings of the parameters on a page without changing anything. On many pages, you can select a parameter without changing its value by pressing its page’s soft button.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
33
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Modes of Operation
Let’s start at the beginning and discuss the three basic operating modes of the A6 and how the display keeps you informed of what’s going on.
All of the operations of the A6 are grouped into three operating modes: Program mode, Mix mode and Global mode. You can access only one of these modes at a time, but switching among the three is as easy as pressing a button.
Use the three buttons on the lower left-hand corner of the display area to initiate the desired mode. When pressed, a mode button’s associated LED will light:
• pressing
PROGRAM
initiates Program mode where the A6’s single programs are played via the keyboard or MIDI, and where you edit existing Programs or create new ones from scratch. This is one of the A6’s two Play modes; the other one is Mix mode, described next.
• pressing
MIX
initiates Mix mode where the A6’s Mix programs are played via the keyboard or MIDI, and where you edit existing Mixes or create new ones from scratch. A Mix is made up of existing single Programs and is the mode you use for creating layers, splits or complex sound combinations, and for
MIDI control.
• pressing
GLOBAL
initiates Global mode where you control the A6’s global functions and master settings. These functions affect the A6 regardless of what Play mode the A6 is in. Included in this mode are items such as setting the MIDI Basic Channel and MIDI Controller Numbers, monitoring voice activity, and so forth.
Data Banks: How the A6’s Sounds Are Organized
The following block diagram illustrates how the A6’s memory is organized among the three operating modes we just discussed.
Program
Sequencer & Arpeggiator
Keyboard Modes
Portamento/LFOs/S & H
Tracking Generator
Voltage Controlled Oscillators
Pre Filter Mix
Filters
Post Filter Mix
Envelopes
Voice Outputs & Mix
Effects Send Outputs & Mix
Modulation Matrix
EXTERNAL INPUTS
CV/Audio/Hardware Routing
EFFECTS
Analog Distrotions Configurations & Parameters
Digital Effects Configurations & Parameters
MASTER CLOCK SETTINGS
Mix
MIX CHANNEL 1
Program
Settings
Mix Channel
Parameters
MIX CHANNEL 2
Program
Settings
Mix Channel
Parameters
MIX CHANNEL 3
Program
Settings
Mix Channel
Parameters
MIX CHANNEL 14
Program
Settings
Mix Channel
Parameters
MIX CHANNEL 15
Program
Settings
Mix Channel
Parameters
MIX CHANNEL 16
Program
Settings
Mix Channel
Parameters
EXTERNAL INPUTS
CV/Audio/Hardware Routing
EFFECTS
Analog Distrotions Configurations & Parameters
Digital Effects Configurations & Parameters
MASTER CLOCK SETTINGS
Global
Global Tune & Transpose
Global MIDI Filtering & Assign
Wheel, Pedal, Ribbon and
MIDI Continuous Controllers
Assignments
Edit Preferences
34 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Throughout this manual, we’ll be using the following terms to describe the memory capabilities of the A6:
• A Program bank refers to an entire bank of Programs.
• A Mix bank refers to an entire bank of Mixes.
• A User bank (there’s one for Programs and one for Mixes) refers to a data bank that uses RAM for storage and can be edited. You can think of this of bank as your “work space”: individual Programs and Mixes can be edited and stored, replaced, copied and so forth.
• A Preset bank refers to a data bank – either Program or Mix – in Flash ROM.
The A6’s Preset banks (there are three of them) are commonly called “factory presets” on many other instruments. These banks – two Preset Program banks and one Preset Mix bank – contain Programs and Mixes developed for the A6 by the Alesis Sound Design team.
Unlike Preset banks in many other synths, the A6's Preset banks can be customized by the user, but only as an Entire Bank copy operation. This means that, unlike the User banks, you cannot selectively copy just one
Program or Mix to this bank. The entire bank must be over-written at once.
• A Card bank refers to a data bank of memory provided by a PCMCIA card in the A6's back-panel card slot. An SRAM card allows the same options for storage as found for the User bank. The card may allow for a Program Bank only, several Mix banks, or a combination, depending on its size.
The A6’s memory capacity is arranged as follows:
Program mode:
• 2 Preset Program banks of 128 Programs (256 total)
• 1 User Program bank of 128 Programs
Mix mode:
• 1 Preset Mix banks of 128 Mixes each
• 1 User Mix bank of 128 Mixes
Memory Functions
Each of the two play modes – Program and Mix – contain two memory functions that are used when editing existing Programs or Mixes, or creating new ones. When pressed, a memory button’s associated LED will light:
• the
STORE
button allows you to save a Program or Mix that you’ve edited or created into the current program number, or copy it to another memory location. The procedure for saving edited Programs and Mixes is detailed on page 43.
• pressing
COMPARE
recalls the stored version of the Program or Mix you’re editing so that you can compare the edited version with the original. This button is inactive if the current program hasn’t been edited (there’s nothing different to compare).
Program mode contains a third memory-related function called
MANUAL
that’s used when creating new Programs and is only active in Program mode. Pressing this button causes the A6 to exit the current Program and create a new Program based on the current settings of all front panel controls. While this new program may not sound like anything useful – the knobs could be positioned in strange settings – it provides a good starting point for a new program.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
35
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
LOCK Function
While many of the A6’s pages make use of all eight knobs and buttons, many do not.
You may notice that sometimes knobs and buttons will become inactive because the display doesn’t need them. But there are two soft buttons –
7
and
8
– that are always active. They are used to lock the display.
As mentioned at the beginning of this topic, the display will react to virtually any change you make to any of the front panel controls. This causes a lot of display switching and can be distracting. If you want to prevent the display from switching screens when performing numerous edits, press soft buttons
7
and
8
together. This will lock the display in its current screen, and
DISPLAY LOCKED
will flash over soft knobs 4 and 5. You can continue to make adjustments to any parameter, but the display stays put. Press
7
and
8
again (or any
VIEW
button) to turn this function off.
▲ and ▼ Arrows
For the majority of parameters in the A6, numeric values are displayed with fractional amounts, represented by the digits to the right of the decimal point. This allows for very precise adjustments to be made to parameters that support fractional values. The
▲
(increment) and
▼
(decrement) arrows are used to make fine adjustments to any parameter that is displayed with a fractional value.
Holding an arrow down scrolls the values. You’ll notice that the changing values will accelerate the longer you hold the arrow button down.
Double-Arrow Reset
Pressing both arrow buttons together
will either set the selected parameter to zero or to a useful default or neutral value. For example, if the
SQR
wave’s
WIDTH parameter is selected, pressing both arrows together sets its value to 50%. If
FILTER 2
KEY TRACK
is selected, pressing both arrows together sets its value to 50. Generally, most parameters with a 0 to 100 or a -100 to +100range will reset to 0.
CONTRAST Control
The
CONTRAST
knob above the
▼
and
▲ arrows is used to adjust the contrast of the display.
The MIX SELECT Button Group
The row of rectangular buttons just below the display area are used to select the
Programs within a Mix. When a Mix Channel is ON, its associated LED will light.
When a Mix Channel is currently selected for editing in the display, its LED will blink.
When the A6 is in Mix mode, pressing one the
1/9
through
8/16
buttons selects a specific Mix Channel – the group of settings that affect each Program in a Mix (the
Program number, its transpose value, its individual MIDI Channel, etc.). Pressing a numbered button alone selects Mix Channels
1
through
8
. Pressing and holding
SHIFT
while pressing a numbered button selects Mix Channels
9
through
16
.
36 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Table of Display Functions
The following table summarizes the functions of the display’s knobs and buttons:
NAME
GLOBAL
button
PROGRAM
button
MIX
button
STORE
button
COMPARE
button
MANUAL
button
MIX
button group
SHIFT
button
1/9
–
8/16
buttons
“Soft Buttons”
“Soft Knobs”
▲ and ▼ buttons
LOCK DISPLAY
button combination
FUNCTION
Enters Global mode, displays Global screen.
Enters Program mode, displays Program screen.
Enters Mix mode, displays Mix screen.
Enters Store mode, Copy mode for Programs, Banks, and Effects, SysEx mode, and the INIT function used to reset the A6 User banks; displays the screens associated with each of the above functions.
Enters Compare mode: when editing, the stored versions of the current Program or Mix (including
Distortion and Effects) are recalled permitting a comparison to be made with the edited versions.
Enters Manual mode: every knob position on the front panel is read by the A6 and made current.
This mode is exited when another Program or Mix is selected.
Group of buttons for selecting the current Mix Channel within a Mix:
Toggles between the Mix Channels 1-8 and 9-16.
Pressing once selects the desired Mix Channel. For the current Mix Channel, pressing again toggles the Mix Channel on or off. When a Mix Channel is on, its button’s LED will blink when that Mix Channel is selected.
Eight buttons below the display that select the page shown on the Page row (the lowest row of text in the display).
Eight knobs below the display whose functions are determined by what is currently being displayed on the second row of text from the bottom (the Parameter row).
Step adjusts the highlighted value for the current parameter. Pressing both arrows together resets the current parameter to zero, a midpoint or a useful default value
Soft Buttons
7
and
8
pressed together will lock the current display screen. The word
s
DISPLAY LOCKED
will flash in the display.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
37
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
S
ELECTING
P
ROGRAMS AND
M
IXES
When playing the A6, the instrument operates in one of two play modes: Program mode or Mix mode. One method of selecting Programs or Mixes is using the row of direct-select buttons just above the Ribbon Controller. Pressing a 2-digit
PROGRAM
GROUP
button selects the “tens group”...
... and pressing a single-digit
PROGRAM NUMBER
button selects the specific Program or
Mix:
1. To select a Program, make sure that the A6 is in Program mode: the LED next to the
PROGRAM
button should be on. If not, press the
PROGRAM
button.
OR
To select a Mix, make sure that the A6 is in Mix mode: the LED next to the
MIX
button should be on. If not, press the
MIX
button. Also, in Mix mode you can work with the individual Programs that are contained within a Mix (the individual Programs that comprise a Mix are referred to as Mix Channels).
2. To select a specific Program, Mix or assign a Program to a Mix Channel, press a
PROGRAM GROUP
button then a
PROGRAM NUMBER
button. Pressing the “
50
” button, for example, plus the “
8
” button selects Program
58
when the A6 is in
Program mode, Mix
58
when in Mix mode or assigns Program 58 to the selected Mix Channel when Mix mode’s
PROG
page is displayed. See the next paragraph for details:
3. To assign a specific Program to a specific Mix Channel within a Mix, press
MIX
to enter Mix mode, then press one of the
SELECT
buttons to select a Mix
Channel. Press soft button 6 to display Mix mode’s
PROG
page. While the
PROG
page is being displayed
, pressing a
PROGRAM GROUP
and/or a
PROGRAM NUMBER
assigns that Program to the current Mix Channel. Don’t forget to turn the Mix Channel on (press the Channel’s
SELECT
button if its
LED is off).
4. You can move among Banks by pressing the
<
BANK
or
BANK
>
button:
When the Andromeda is in Program mode, you have three Program Banks from which to choose: two factory Preset Banks and one User Bank (where you store Programs that you create). Use the
BANK
buttons to switch between these Banks. Mix Mode works the same: when MIX Mode is active, use the
BANK
buttons to switch among the two Mix Banks (one Preset and one User).
The second method of selecting a Program, Mix or Mix Channel involves the display and soft knobs and is covered in the next topic.
38 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PROGRAM M
ODE
P
ARAMETERS
Pressing the
PROGRAM
button displays the Program mode display screen. As with all other A6 functions, the page and parameter that was last selected will be recalled.
The following table summarizes the Program mode parameters:
SOFT KNOB ✿
✿ PAGE TAB
PROG
DIR
1
BANK
BANK
2
NUMBER
NUMBER
3 4 5 6 7
PROG and DIR Page Parameters
The
PROG
(Program) page provides another method to select Programs in addition to the Direct Select buttons. When this page is being displayed, use soft knob
1
to select the bank and soft knob
2
to select the specific Program number.
The
DIR
(Directory) page soft knobs operate the same as in the
PROG
page. The difference is that the DIR page provides a directory-style listing of all Programs in the synthesizer, and shows ten names at a time.
8
Tip
: While either of these two pages are being displayed, you can still use the Direct
Select buttons as well as the soft knobs to select sounds.
MIX M
ODE
P
ARAMETERS
Pressing the
MIX
button displays the Mix mode display screen. As with all other A6 functions, the page and parameter that was last selected will be recalled. The following table summarizes the Mix mode parameters:
SOFT KNOB ✿
✿ PAGE TAB
MIX
DIR
1
BANK
BANK
2
NUMBER
NUMBER
3 4 5 6 7 8
ENABLE
KBD
PROG
CNTL
SOLO
KBD LO
LEVEL
PCHWHL
MID IN
KBD HI
PAN
MODWHL
MIDOUT
OUTPUT
AFTCH
MID CC
ENABLE
SEMI
SUSPDL
MIDVOL
CENTS
EXTSW
MIDPGM
MIDI CH
EXTPDL
MIDAFT
RIBBON KBD -
The DIR page in Mix mode operates exactly the same as the parameters in Program mode. For descriptions of this parameter, see above.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
39
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
MIX
The pages unique to Mix mode are
MIX
,
KBD
,
PROG
,
CNTL
and
SOLO
, described as follows:
MIX Page Parameters
PARAMETER
BANK
NUMBER
ENABLE
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
- USER -
PRESET 1
This parameter displays the current Mix Bank.
Use soft knob
1
or the
BANK
select buttons to change Banks.
000 ··· 127
This parameter displays the number of the current Mix in the current Mix Bank. Use soft knob
2
or the
PROGRAM GROUP
and
PROGRAM
NUMBER
buttons to change Mixes.
ON, OFF Use soft knob 8 to turn the currently selected
Mix Channel on or off.
PAGE
KBD
KBD Page Parameters
The abbreviation for “Keyboard,” this Mix page contains parameters that determine the keyboard range of the current Mix Channel and allow you to turn the keyboard’s control of the Mix Channel on or off.
PARAMETER
KBD LO
Low note limit *
KBD HI
High note limit *
ENABLE
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
C0 ··· G10 The lowest note on the keyboard that this Mix
Channel will play on.
C0 ··· G10 The highest note on the keyboard that this Mix
Channel will play on.
ON, OFF Turns keyboard control of this Mix Channel on or off. This is useful for setting up a Mix Channel to be played by MIDI In only and not to be affected by the A6’s keyboard.
KBD LO and KBD HI settings define the keyboard range or zone of the Mix Channel. These are the parameters you use when setting up splits and layers, as well as other specialty keyboard configurations. See page 47 later in this Chapter for the full story.
40 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
PROG
PROG Page Parameters
The abbreviation for “Program,” this page is where you set the level, pan and output jacks, transpose and fine tuning amounts, and MIDI Channel settings for the selected
Mix Channel.
This is also where you can select a Program for the Mix Channel using the
PROGRAM
GROUP
and
PROGRAM NUMBER
buttons.
PARAMETER
LEVEL
PAN
OUTPUT
SEMI
CENTS
MIDI CH
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
0 ··· 100
Sets the output level of the current Mix Channel.
-100 ··· +100 Sets the “placement” of the Mix Channel’s output in the left-to-right stereo panorama.
-100 is full left,
+100
is full right and
0
is center.
- OFF -
MAIN
AUX
Routes the audio output of the current Mix
Channel to either the rear panel
MAIN
output jacks, the
AUX
jacks or off. Note that the headphones will be active only when MAIN is selected in the display.
-60 ··· +60
Sets the transpose amount of the current Mix
Channel in semi-tones, ± 5 octaves.
-100 ··· +100 Sets the transpose amount of the current Mix
Channel in semi-tones, ± 5 octaves.
1 ··· 16 Sets the MIDI Channel that the current Mix
Channel will use to send and receive.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
41
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
CNTL Page Parameters
The abbreviation for “Controllers”, this page permits you to enable/disable local and
MIDI controllers for the selected Mix Channel.
The parameters on this page determine whether or not the displayed controllers affect the currently selected Mix Channel. Use the parameter’s corresponding soft knob to turn the function on or off.
PAGE
CNTL
Page 1
PARAMETER
PCHWHL
MODWHL
AFTCH
SUSPDL
EXTSW
EXTPDL
RIBBON
- KBD -
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
ON, OFF Enables, disables the A6’s Pitch Wheel.
ON, OFF Enables, disables the A6’s Modulation Wheel.
ON, OFF Enables, disables keyboard Aftertouch. MIDI In aftertouch is turned off or on in Page 2, below.
ON, OFF
Enables, disables the rear panel
SUSTAIN
jack and
MIDI In sustain pedal control.
ON, OFF Enables, disables the rear panel
SWITCH
jack.
ON, OFF Enables, disables the rear panel
CC PEDAL
jack.
ON, OFF
Enables, disables the A6’s Ribbon Controller.
ON, OFF Enables, disables the A6’s keyboard.
The
CNTL
parameter group contains 16 parameters, displayed eight at a time. Press soft button
7
to toggle between the two display sub-pages.
CNTL
Page 2
MID IN
MIDOUT
MIDCC
MIDVOL
MIDPGM
MIDAFT
ON, OFF
Enables, disables MIDI In control of the current
Mix Channel.
ON, OFF Enables, disables MIDI Out control from the current Mix Channel.
ON, OFF Enables, disables MIDI continuous controller commands such as sliders and knobs on another
MIDI device.
ON, OFF Enables, disables MIDI volume control.
ON, OFF
Enables, disables MIDI program change commands.
ON, OFF Enables, disables MIDI Aftertouch.
SOLO function
This is not a “page”, actually; you can press Soft Button 8 to solo a Mix Channel when you’re on any of the pages of Mix mode. This “solos” the currently selected
Mix Channel (indicated by the green blinking LED over the SELECT button) so you can concentrate on one layer of a Mix without hearing the others.
42 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
S
TORING
E
DITED
P
ROGRAMS AND
M
IXES
Chapters 5 through 8 explore the details of editing existing Programs and Mixes, and provide all the information for creating completely new ones. When a Program or
Mix has been edited or a new one is created, you’ll need to save your work. This is where
STORE
mode comes in.
STORE
mode allows you to save into the current Program or Mix number (also referred to as a memory location), or copy it to another memory location in the User or
Card bank. Note that you cannot store to a memory location in any Preset bank.
STORE M
ODE
P
ARAMETERS
2 3 4 5 6 7
SOFT KNOB ✿
✿ PAGE TAB
PROG
1
DIR
COPY
INIT
SYSEX
CARD
1
BANK
BANK
TYPE
PROGS
BANK
INIT
NUMBER
NUMBER
SRCBNK
MIXES
NUMBER
SRCNUM MIXCHN*
RCV-TO ALL
8
DSTBUF* DSTBNK* MIXCHN*
NAME BANK NUMBER 0 - 9 UPPER LOWER OTHER NAMES <- ->
1 The first tab, displayed here as
PROG
, shows that the A6 is in
STORE
mode for Programs.
When the A6 is in
STORE
mode for Mixes, this tab will display
MIX
.
* These parameters appear in the COPY page depending on the TYPE chosen.
T
O STORE A
P
ROGRAM OR
M
IX TO MEMORY
:
1. Press
STORE
. For Programs (Mixes), the screen will display the message:
SELECT PROGRAM (MIX) AND BANK AND HIT STORE TO SAVE
2. To store the current edited version of a Program or Mix to the same memory location, press
STORE
again. This will overwrite the old version of the
Program or Mix that is currently in this (User or Card) memory location.
3. To store an edited Program or Mix to a different memory location, use soft knob
1
(or the
BANK
buttons) to change Banks and use soft knob
2
(or the
PROGRAM GROUP
and
PROGRAM NUMBER
buttons) to change the Program or
Mix number. The press
STORE
again. This will overwrite the Program or Mix
that is currently in this User or Card memory location.
To abort the store, press either the
PROGRAM
or the
MIX
button.
If you want to re-arrange the order of Programs and Mixes, you can use this procedure to copy Programs and Mixes that you just want to move around – they don’t have to be edited to be copied. On the other hand, the
STORE
function has a DIR page and a
COPY
page that are designed to make these operations easier as described below.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
43
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
DIR Store Procedure
When you press the
STORE
button the first time to initiate a store, you can press soft button 2 to enter the
DIR
(“Directory”) page. Here you can view the entire list of 128
Programs or Mixes by name. This way, if you want to store a Program or Mix to another memory location, you can see in advance which Program or Mix will be overwritten.
Use soft knob
2
to select the destination Program (or Mix). Press
STORE
again to complete the store. To abort the store, press either the
PROGRAM
or the
MIX
button.
COPY Page Parameters
PAGE PARAMETER
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
COPY
TYPE PRG BANK
MIX BANK
Copy the entire Program/Mix Bank to the
Destination Bank. This is the only way to change a
Preset Bank.
PRG DFX
MIX DFX
Copy the Digital Effects parameters of the selected Program or Mix to the selected Edit
Buffer.
SRCBNK
Source Bank
SRCNUM
Source Number
DSTBNK
Destination Bank
DSTBUF
Destination Buffer
PRG AFX
MIX AFX
Copy the Analog Distortion parameters of the selected Program or Mix to the selected Edit
Buffer.
MIX CHAN Copy a Mix Channel to a different Mix Channel in the Edit Buffer.
Selects the Bank you want to copy from.
USER
PRESET 1
PRESET 2*
CARD*
O-127 Selects the number of the Program or Mix you want to copy from. This has no effect in Program
or Mix Bank copy mode.
USER
PRESET 1
PRESET 2*
CARD*
MIXBUF
PRGBUF
Selects the Bank you want to copy to, that will be overwritten by pressing
COPY
then
STORE
.
Appears only in Program or Mix Bank copy mode.
Selects the Edit Buffer you want to copy to, that will be overwritten by pressing COPY then
STORE
.
Appears only in Program or Mix DFX or AFX copy mode.
MIXCHN
Mix Channel
1-16 In MIX CHAN COPY mode, this appears in two places. Turn Soft Knob 4 to select the source, and Soft Knob 8 to select the destination Mix
Channel.
* There is no Preset 2 option when a Mix is the source, and no Card unless an initialized card is in the memory slot.
44 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
INIT Procedure
You can initialize, or reset, all Programs in the User Bank to the
- A6 Default
Program -
, a program that returns all program settings to their default values resulting in a basic, rather “plain” sounding Program. By the same token, you can reset all Mixes to their default values as well.
To accomplish this, press
STORE
then press soft button
4
. To initialize all Programs, turn soft knob 1; to initialize all Mixes, turn soft knob
2
. In either case, the display will prompt you to press
STORE
again to complete the reset. To abort the
initialization, press either the
PROGRAM
or the
MIX
button.
Be careful: initialization cannot be reversed. There is no “Undo” like there is on personal computers.
Storing Programs and Mixes using the SYSEX Page
To store Programs and Mixes to an external MIDI device such as a sequencer or MIDI data storage device, use a System Exclusive dump. You can set the kind of SysEx dump you want to send by pressing Soft Button
5,
the
SYSEX
page of Store mode.
This page is also where you set how SysEx messages will be received. For details on using System Exclusive messages for storing to an external MIDI device, see
Chapter
12: MIDI
.
CARD Page
You can expand the Program/Mix memory of your Andromeda by plugging in PC
Card Type 1 SRAM cards, available from your Alesis dealer. The
CARD
page will show you the size and type of card currently in the memory slot on the rear panel.
The only other function of the page is
INIT
, used primarily when a card is brand new and needs to be initialized to the A6's card format, but also to erase all Programs or Mixes on a card.
T
O INITIALIZE A CARD
:
1.
Insert a PCMCIA Type 1 SRAM memory card of at least 256k size into the card slot on the back of the unit.
2.
Press
STORE
. Press Soft Button
6
, CARD .
3.
Turn Soft Knob 1 (
INIT
) all the way around until "
HIT STORE TO INIT RAM
CARD " shows in the display.
4.
Press
STORE
. Follow the prompts for whether you want the card to store only
Programs, Mixes, or both. (These may not be available if the card is less than
512k in size.)
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
45
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
NAME
NAME Page Parameters
The NAME page contains parameters that allow you to quickly and easily change the name of the selected Program or Mix. In addition, you can also change the destination Bank and Program/Mix number like you can in the PROG page.
PARAMETER
BANK
NUMBER
0 ··· 9
UPPER
LOWER
OTHER
NAMES
*
<- ->
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
- USER -
PRESET 1
This parameter displays the current Program or
Mix Bank. Use soft knob
1
or the
BANK
select buttons to change Banks.
000 ··· 127
This parameter displays the number of the current Program or Mix in the current Bank. Use soft knob
2
or the
PROGRAM GROUP
and
PROGRAM
NUMBER
buttons to save to a different Program or
Mix number.
0 ··· 9
Use soft knob
3
to select numerals 0 through 9 for the selected character.
A ··· Z Use soft knob
4
to select upper-case letters
A through Z for the selected character.
a ··· z Use soft knob
5
to select lower-case letters a through z for the selected character.
! @ # $ % &
* ( ) etc.
Use soft knob
6
to select special characters including punctuation, dashes, and so forth.
Various (see below)
Soft knob
7
allows you to select from among a list of 89 preset Program/Mix names to save you time.
Use soft knob
8
to select the character you want to change.
* The names available for selection are:
Alien
Analog
Boomy
Brass
Dark
Decay
Fretless
FM Mod
Angry Bright Deep Guitar
Another Chromatic Delayed Horns
Lonely
Loose
Lost
Low
Awesome City
Arpeg Crash
Attack
Bass
Bell
Crispy
Crying
Cutting
Dingy
Dual
Edge
Fast
Fat
Hammer
Hard
Harp
Junky
MIDI
Monster
Moon
Harmonic Morph
Octave
Oboe
Pad
Phat Sax Sync
Plucked Sequence Synth
Piano
Piercing
Porta
PW Mod
Random
Reverse
RingMod
Simple
Sloppy
Slow
Solo
Soft
String
Stupid
Technox
Timed
Thick
Trash
Twisted
Unison
Velocity
Violin
Watery
Whirling
Thunder Whistle
Tight Zither
Blues Cymbal Flute Leslie Organ Retro Sparkle Toy
Blank
46 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
S
ETTING
U
P
S
PLITS AND
L
AYERS
Splits and layers are constructed from Mix Channels in Mix mode. So make sure that the A6 is in Mix mode: the LED next to the
MIX
button should be on. If not, press the
MIX
button.
T
O SET UP LAYERS OF
P
ROGRAMS IN
M
IX MODE
:
To create a layer, we’ll “stack” one Mix Channel on top of another. This is accomplished by assigning the same keyboard range to both Mix Channels. This effectively creates two note commands for every one key that is played on the A6’s keyboard:
1. Press the
1/9
button. The display will show you the STATUS of Mix Channel 1 on the right side of the screen. If
OFF
, press the
1/9
button again or use soft knob
8
to turn Mix Channel 1 ON . The LED above the
1/9
button will blink.
2. Do the same for Mix Channel 2: press the
2/10
button. If the the status of Mix
Channel 2 is OFF, press the
2/10
button again or use soft knob
8
to turn Mix
Channel 2 ON . The LED above the
2/10
button will blink; the LED above the
1/9
button will light steady.
3. We only want to use two Mix Channels, so make sure that the LEDs above the remaining
MIX SELECT
buttons are off. Also, press the
SHIFT
button to make sure that Mix Channels 9 - 16 are off as well.
4. Next, we will assign a different Program to each Mix Channel and adjust the performance parameters. Press the
1/9
button to select Mix Channel 1. Press soft button
6
to enter the
PROG
page: a. Use the
PROGRAM GROUP
and
PROGRAM NUMBER
buttons to assign a
Program to this Mix Channel.
b. Use soft knob 1 to set the Mix Channel’s output level and soft knob
2
to set its panning position. For our purposes in this example, set PAN to -100 (all the way left).
c. Use soft knob
3
to set the OUTPUT to MAIN . Mix Channels normally default to
MAIN
, so just make sure that
MAIN
is selected. Settings for
SEMI
,
CENTS
, and MIDICH are optional for this example.
d. Press soft button
5
to display the
KBD
page. Make sure that
KBD LO
is set to
C-1 and KBD HI is set to G9 . These are the default settings for a Mix
Channel’s keyboard range which spans the entire MIDI note range of 0 -
127. Last, make sure that ENABLE is set to - ON .
e. Settings on the
CNTL
page for
MIDIIN
and
MIDOUT
are optional for this example.
5. Press the
2/10
button to select Mix Channel 2 and soft button
6
to re-enter the
PROG
page. Follow sub-steps a. through e. above in setting up Mix Channel 2 with the exception of step b. where you want to set the panning to +100 instead of
-100
. By panning Mix Channel 1 hard left and Mix Channel 2 hard right, it’s easier to hear the layer.
6. Play the A6’s keyboard. For every key you play, you should hear two
Programs at the same time. Note that the A6’s 16 voices are divided between the two Mix Channels. Each Mix Channel plays eight voices.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
47
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
S
PLITS
The major difference between a split and a layer is in the KBD settings. The KBD LO and
KBD HI
settings define the limits of the keyboard range or “zone” of the Mix
Channel. In a layer, the settings overlap; but in a split, the settings separate (“split”) the keyboard.
T
O SPLIT THE KEYBOARD IN
M
IX MODE
:
Start from the Mix we setup in layers on the previous page.
1. Press
MIX SELECT
button
1/9
to select Mix Channel 1.
2. Press soft button
5
( KBD ) and use soft knob
2
to set Mix Channel 1’s KBD HI note down to
B3
, the B below Middle C. This effectively makes Mix Channel 1 the
“lower” or left-hand keyboard zone.
3. Next, we’ll set up Mix Channel 2 to be the “upper” or right-hand keyboard zone.
Press
MIX SELECT
button
2/10
, and use soft knob
1
to set Mix Channel 2’s
KBD LO note up to C4 , Middle C.
The A6’s keyboard is now “split” between Middle C and the B below it with Mix
Channel 1 playing notes up to and including the B key and Mix Channel 2 playing all notes from Middle C and above.
Tip:
To set the Hi and Lo values using the keyboard instead of the knobs, turn soft knob
3
(
USEKBD
) to set this feature to
-ON-
. When either
KBD LO
or
KBD HI
is highlighted (by turning their soft knobs or by pressing soft button
5
( KBD ), play any note on the keyboard to set the value. Make sure to turn this off to avoid inadvertently changing split points.
Another neat trick:
To get a "hole in the middle", so one mix channel will play at the low end and high end of the keyboard but NOT in the middle, simply set KBD
LO
so it's higher than
KBD HI
. The channel will play all notes except between those two points, creating a "hole" where no notes play for that Mix Channel, while notes on either side will play (up and down to the limits of the MIDI note range). So a Mix Channel with a KBD LO limit of C6 and a KBD HI limit of C5 would be playable from the range of C-1 to C5 (inclusive) and from C6 to G9.
B
EYOND
S
PLITS AND
L
AYERS
As you can see by our previous examples of creating a split or a layer, this is only the beginning. The key point here is that we used only two Mix Channels. What happens when we use three? Or more? By activating a third Mix Channel with a layer, a threelevel layer is created. Activating a fourth Mix Channel adds a fourth layer.
Just keep in mind that each new Mix Channel, if ENABLE is - ON in the KBD page, divides the available 16 voices among the active Mix Channels. 16 voices ÷ 4 Mix
Channels = 4 voices per Mix Channel. But if ENABLE is - OFF in the KBD page, the
Mix Channel can be used to play a MIDI instrument from the A6’s keyboard and doesn’t take A6 voices away from the other active Mix Channels.
For splits, adding another Mix Channel and resetting KBD LO and KBD HI zone limits for each Mix Channel to avoid overlap creates a three-way split. Add another
Mix Channel for a four-way split and so on. If the
KBD LO
and
KBD HI
zone limits for two Mix Channels do overlap, the result is a split keyboard with a layer.
48 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
U
SING
G
LOBAL
M
ODE
GLOBAL M
ODE
P
ARAMETERS
SOFT KNOB ✿
✿ PAGE TAB
KEYBD
PEDAL
MIDI
CC MAP
PANEL
1
TRANSP
PEDMOD
MIXSEL
PED CC
PTHRU1
2
VELCRV
FSWMOD
PRGSEL
FSW CC
PTHRU2
3
SENS
4
MODE
5 6
MIDICH AFTCH
BNKSEL
RIBVCC
CC TX
RIBLCC
CC RX
RIBRCC
SYXRX
7 8
STEAL
CTLNUM CC IN
VOXMON
PAGE
KEYBD
KEYBD Page Parameters
PARAMETER
TRANSP
Transpose
VELCRV
SENS
Sensitivity
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
-24 ··· +24 semitones
This parameter adjusts the keyboard transposition ± one octave in semitone increments.
DEFAULT:
00
This does not affect the tuning of the A6, rather the Note Number output from the keyboard is transposed. The MIDI Note Number transmitted from the A6 via the
MIDI OUT
port is also transposed.
WEIGHTED
PLASTIC
1 ··· 127
DEFAULT:
WEIGHTED
Sets the "feel" of the dynamics of the keyboard.
Weighted and Plastic emulate those response curves for the A6's semi-weighted 61-note
Keyboard. Settings 1 through 127 select a fixed velocity value that the keyboard transmits. This setting affects Keyboard velocities both to the A6 itself and the MIDI Out.
0 ··· 127 This parameter adjusts the velocity sensitivity of the keyboard. When set to 0, only the hardest playing will result in velocity values of 127.
When set to 99, it's hard to get low velocity output even with very soft playing.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
49
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
KEYBD continued
PARAMETER
MODE
MIDICH
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
Sets the control output of the A6 keyboard:
LOCAL + MIDI The keyboard will play the A6’s voices and transmit MIDI Notes.
MIDI ONLY The keyboard will transmit MIDI Notes only – the A6’s voices will not be played by its keyboard. This setting is the same as “Local Off” on other instruments.
LOCAL ONLY The keyboard will play the A6’s voices only – the A6 will not transmit MIDI Notes played on its keyboard. This setting is the same as “MIDI
Off” on other instruments.
1 ··· 16 When the keyboard
MODE
is set to
MIDI ONLY
, this parameter sets the MIDI Channel that the keyboard will use to transmit. This parameter is only displayed when MODE is set to MIDI ONLY .
AFTCH
STEAL ON, OFF Sets whether voice stealing will take place under certain conditions.
PEDAL Page Parameters
Use the parameters on this page when setting up your pedals that are plugged into the A6’s rear panel. You can refer to page 68 for the physical and electrical specifications of the types of pedals that are compatible with the A6.
PAGE
PEDAL
PARAMETER
PEDMOD
FSWMOD
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
These settings affect
PEDAL/CV
input on the A6’s rear panel.
CC Use this setting if the pedal plugged into the
PEDAL/CV
jack is a continuous (“rocker” type) pedal.
CC REV
This setting causes a continuous pedal to act in reverse: pushing the pedal forward causes less instead of more.
SW Use this setting if the pedal plugged into the
PEDAL/CV
jack is a footswitch (“on-off” type).
SW REV This setting causes a footswitch to act in reverse: stepping on the pedal is off rather than on. This also means that the footswitch is always on until you step on it. Be careful.
Identical to
PEDMOD
except that the settings affect the
SWITCH
input on the A6’s rear panel.
50 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
PANEL
MIDI Page Parameters
This page controls how the Andromeda responds to incoming MIDI messages such as Program Change commands, and whether it will transmit MIDI Continuous
Controller messages. For details on setting these parameters, see
Chapter 12: MIDI
.
CC MAP Page Parameters
This page assigns particular MIDI Continuous Controller numbers to the
Andromeda’s footswitches and ribbon. It also sets the MIDI CC numbers that will be used for the Modulation sources MIDI CC A-H . For details on setting these parameters, see
Chapter 12: MIDI
.
PANEL Page Parameters
This page sets how the top panel will respond when you're editing. It's purely a matter of personal preference…there's no right or wrong way to set these controls.
PARAMETER
PTHRU1
Top panel knob pass-thru mode
PTHRU2
Mod list passthru mode
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
OFF, ON When set to OFF, moving any top panel control will make the parameter jump to the value of the knob immediately. When set to ON, the knob must pass through the current value before the value will change, allowing smoother transitions.
OFF, ON This is a pass-through mode for the Mod
SOURCE lists only; when set to ON, the source won't change until the knob passes through the current source in the list of 79 possible modulators.
VOXMON Page
This page has no soft knob or soft button control. Also designed for advanced users, it is a voice activity monitor, showing which of the Andromeda's 16 voices are currently in use. In addition to its usefulness as a troubleshooting tool to identify which voices are being used by which Mix Channels (for example), it allows users to see how a mix might be (unexpectedly) using polyphony, e.g. if an
ENV3
release is too long.
Another voice activity monitor is displayed on the main Program and Mix display.
A series of dashes will appear above the BANK and NUMBER legends showing which voices are being used as you play.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
51
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
M
ASTER
C
ONTROLS
V
OLUME
The
MASTER VOLUME
knob is a
global (affects the A6 in all modes) volume control that determines the final output level of the unit. To use an audio term,
MASTER VOLUME
is
post (comes after) the
PRE
and
POST FILTER
mixes and the
VOICE MIX
. This means that any
relative
level settings you make within the Programs and Mixes are preserved. The
MASTER
VOLUME
is routed to the unit’s
MAIN LEFT
and
RIGHT
stereo outs, the
HEADPHONE
output and the two
AUX OUT
s. It does not affect the eight stereo
VOICE OUTPUTS
.
You operate this control by simply turning it: fully counter-clockwise shuts the audio outputs off, fully clockwise is maximum.
T
UNE
MASTER TUNE
is also global and is used to tune the A6 to another instrument or tuning device. This control is post (or
“after”) the frequency of the
VCOs and Filters, Transpose and Detune. So any relative frequency settings you make within the Programs and Mixes, or global pitch changes such transpose or pitch bend, are preserved.
You operate this control by turning it to the left or right of center. Setting this knob near the 12 o’clock center position tunes the A6 to standard pitch. You will know that the knob is at 0 when the associated LED lights. Turning the knob to the left causes the A6 to tune flat; turning the knob to the right causes it to tune sharp.
Adjusting this control displays the global
TUNE
page where more precise and custom control over the global tuning can be made. When displayed, the global TUNE page shows the precise tuning frequency in hundredths of Hz. In addition to using the
MASTER TUNE
knob to adjust tuning, you can also use soft knob
1
when global
TUNE
is displayed as well as the ▲ and ▼ buttons. And remember, when the MASTER parameter is selected in global
TUNE
, pressing both arrows together resets
MASTER
TUNE
to precisely 440.00
.
Also included on the global
TUNE
page is the
BKTUNE
or “background tuning” option. Use soft knob
2
to turn it on or off. After you perform an
AUTO TUNE
(next topic), background tuning will continuously monitor the VCOs and make adjustments as they are needed. (The VCFs are not tuned in the background.)
52 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
AUTO TUNE Button
Pressing
AUTO TUNE
displays the auto tune page. Pressing it again initiates a routine that fine tunes or calibrates a number of A6 functions to an internal tuning reference.
Tip
: You need to auto-tune the A6 after you first turn it on and should do it again after it warms up (about 15 minutes). After that, background tuning (if turned on) will keep your A6 in tune as long as it is powered on.
During the Auto Tune process both VCO’s frequencies and pulse widths, and both
VCF’s frequencies and resonances are calibrated along with a number of other parameters. If you want to tune only one type of module (only oscillators, or only filters), you may select that using the soft buttons.
While Auto Tune is in process, the display shows a progress/status box and the LED next the button blinks. At all other times the Auto Tune LED is off.
For more detail on Auto Tune, see Troubleshooting on page 265.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
53
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
T
HE
K
EYBOARD AND
K
EYBOARD
M
ODES
This might be a big assumption, but we get the impression that some players may be interested in learning about the keyboard since the A6 is a keyboard instrument. All joking aside, the A6’s keyboard makes the unit a particularly versatile instrument, especially when you take into consideration the varied performance modes plus the addition of portamento.
K
EYBOARD
S
PECS
The A6’s keyboard is a 5-ocatve C-to-C semi-weighted keyboard. This means that it has a similar design to an organ as opposed to a piano, which has heavier keys due to its mechanical hammer action. But small weights under each key provide mass so the action is a little heavier than typical synthesizers.
Properties
The A6’s keyboard is sensitive to Velocity (how hard the keys are struck) and Release
Velocity (how fast the keys are let go). Velocity and Release Velocity information from the keyboard is sent to the A6’s internal Voices and to
MIDI OUT
so that receiving instruments connected to the A6 can respond to these performance dynamics.
The A6’s keyboard also responds to monophonic pressure – known in the MIDI world as Channel Pressure or Aftertouch – which means that if you play a chord and press into the keys, the A6 averages the amount of pressure you’re applying and sends that information to the Voices and
MIDI OUT
.
There is another kind of key pressure called polyphonic key pressure which reads the amount of pressure on each key and sends the individual amounts to the Voices and
MIDI OUT
.
Although the A6’s keyboard does not respond to this type of pressure, the
A6’s Voices will respond to poly pressure received from another MIDI device capable of transmitting this type of pressure.
Note Range
Although the range of the keyboard is limited to 61 physical keys, the entire MIDI
Note Range of 128 notes (numbered 0 to 127) are available. Each key of the A6’s keyboard as well as any received MIDI Note is given a number. This number is used by the A6 to determine what musical note or notes to play.
Assuming that the Transpose function (see below) is not being used, Middle C is
“Note Number 60” as far as the A6 is concerned. With that in mind, you can easily find the Note Number of any key just by adding or subtracting the number of keys up or down from Middle C.
Using the
TRANSPOSE
function, the range of the keyboard can be shifted up or down using Middle C on the A6 as your reference. See page 58.
54 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
P
ERFORMANCE
F
EATURES
KBD MODE Controls
The
KBD MODE
(“keyboard mode”) functions allow for quick and easy access to three of the most common performance characteristics of the keyboard:
UNISON X
which provides several unison playing modes,
DETUNE
which allows you to set an amount of detuning among the voices when in unison, and switching between
POLY
and
MONO
playing.
UNISON X Button
In the classic sense of the word, unison is a performance mode which slaves all voices to one key or one received MIDI Note. In the A6, unison is a set of keyboard modes in which “all-voices-play-with-one-key” is just one of the options.
Pressing this button enables the UNSN-X parameter on the KBMODE page, and lights the
UNISON X
LED. This parameter allows you to select the number of voices that will play with one key or one MIDI In note. Minimum is two voices, maximum is 16. In
STACK mode, the maximum number of voices are played, automatically allocated to maintain polyphony. For example, if you play 1 note, all 16 voices will stack on it; if you play 4 notes, each note will be a stack of 4 voices.
DETUNE Knob
Turning this knob also displays the KBMODE screen, selecting the DETUNE parameter on the
KBMODE
page. This parameter allows you to adjust the unison
DETUNE parameter. Turning this control clockwise adds detune amounts to voices playing in unison.
POLY/MONO Button
Pressing this button toggles the Keyboard Mode between
POLY
(polyphonic) or
MONO
(monophonic) type. Pressing this button also initiates the
KBMODE
screen, selecting the POLY parameter on the KBMODE page to show which Keyboard Mode is currently active. This parameter interacts with the
UNISON X
mode, permitting a polyphonic version of unison.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
55
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Keyboard Mode Parameters
Pressing the
UNISON X
,
POLY
or
MONO
buttons, or turning the
DETUNE
knob will display the
KBMODE
page. Note that the display shows
PROG MODE
or
MIX MODE
(depending on the mode selected). Separate keyboard settings are available for each mode.
SOFT KNOB ✿
✿ PAGE TAB
KBMODE
1 2 3 4 5
DETUNE UNSN-X POLY
MONOVX or
MIXMVX
*Mix mode only
ASSIGN
KBMODE Page Parameters
6 7 8
PAGE
KBMODE
Keyboard
Mode
PARAMETER
DETUNE
Unison Detune
UNSN-X
POLY
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
0 ··· 100
± cents
- OFF -
STACK
2 ··· 16
POLY
MONO
Only effective if UNSN-X mode is active.
This parameter controls the “width” of the voice tuning in Unison mode: the pitch of each voice will be staggered up and down towards the selected tuning offset.* Being able to detune voices in unison mode provides a very “fat” and rich unison sound.
Sets the number of voices that will be played by one note from a minimum of 2 to a maximum of
16, or off. If it is set to STACK, all available voices will be stacked up automatically on the keys being played.
The keyboard/MIDI In plays voices polyphonically. One voice is used for each note played (or received). If UNSN-X is on, the number of voices used per note is determined by the setting of the Unison-X parameter.
This setting allows only one note to be played, even you’re playing a chord. Each new note that is played/received while the note is held will simply change the pitch of the playing voice.
The characteristics of
MONO
mode are determined by the MIXMVX and ASSIGN parameters described next.
*See About DETUNE on the next page.
56 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
KBMODE
Continued
PARAMETER
MONOVX
Mono Voice
ASSIGN
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
1
···
16
± cents
LOWEST
ROTARY
Only available if
MONO
mode is selected in the
POLY parameter, MONOVX selects a specific voice to be played. This effectively turns the A6 into a
2-oscillator, single-voiced instrument.
This feature is useful when the individual
VOICE
OUTPUTS
on the back panel are used. If you need to isolate voice 8, for example, set this parameter to 8 .
This parameter selects which voices of the A6 will be assigned to incoming notes.
This will always play the lowest available voices.
This assigns new notes to the 16 voices so that all voices are used in turn.
About DETUNE
As an example of how voices are staggered-tuned, we’ll use the extreme setting of
100
which gives the greatest width or amount of detune among the voices.
Mode: maximum UNSN-X set to 16 (16 voices are used for one note)
If DETUNE is set to 100 (100 cents, which is equal to a semitone), the following formula is used to calculate the “spread”:
Spread =
DETUNE
setting / (# of voices – 1)
= 100/(16-1)
= 100/15
= 6.67
Voice 1
Voice 2
Voice 3
Voice 4
Voice 5
Voice 6
Voice 7
Voice 8
Voice 9
Voice 10
Voice 11
Voice 12
Voice 13
Voice 14
Voice 15
Voice 16 pitch = pitch = pitch = pitch = pitch = pitch = pitch = pitch = pitch = pitch = pitch = no change
+ 06.67 cents
– 13.33 cents
+ 20.00 cents
– 26.67 cents
+ 33.33 cents
– 40.00 cents
+ 46.67 cents
– 53.33 cents
+ 60.00 cents
– 66.67 cents pitch = pitch = pitch =
+ 73.33 cents
– 80.00 cents
+ 86.67 cents pitch = – 93.33 cents pitch = + 100.00 cents
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
57
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Additional Keyboard Functions
TRANSPOSE Button
The
TRANSPOSE
button allows you to play the A6 in a different key. This is a global setting that affects all
Programs and Mixes and remains in effect until it’s changed, even if the A6 is powered off.
To set the transpose amount, press the
TRANSPOSE
button, then turn soft knob
1
to transpose the A6 up or down in increments of one semitone.
CHORD
The
CHORD
button allows you to play a chord with a single note. When this button is pressed, any note or notes currently being played are captured or placed in memory.
Specifically, any note or notes that “haven’t received a note off command” will be captured. This means that keys you’re playing, MIDI IN notes that are playing before the MIDI Note Off command is received, or notes being held by the sustain pedal qualify for the Chord. This also means that notes fading during the Release 1 or
Release 2 stages don’t get captured.
After the Chord is in memory, playing a single note on the keyboard (or MIDI IN) will play the Chord. If you play another chord, each note will play the memorized
Chord up to the maximum of 16 total notes (the A6’s 16-voice limit). To play the original Chord in its correct key, play the original root note of the chord. All other played notes will transpose the Chord up or down from the root.
58 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
P
ORTAMENTO
A Italian term (from a Latin root) that means sliding, portamento causes the A6’s
Voices to “slide” (sometimes called “glide”) to the notes being played. When you are playing the A6 normally, played keys or MIDI Note On messages activate the Voices with the appropriate notes instantly. With portamento active, it takes a period of time – set by the
TIME
knob – for the Voices to reach the played notes by “sliding into them”.
The first important concept to understand here is that the sliding direction is determined by the notes that were previously played. For example, if you play keys in the lowest octave, turn
PORTA
on and then play keys in the upper range of the keyboard, the Voices will slide up to the higher notes. If you then play lower notes, the Voices will slide down to the new lower keys being played.
The second concept to understand is the distance between played notes. Musically speaking, we’re referring to the interval between successive notes. In contrast to the above example, if you play notes in a certain octave then continue to play in that key range, there’s a good chance that portamento may not be that distinct since the distance (interval) between the old notes and new notes is not that great.
The third concept to understand when using portamento is that it is the voices that are doing the sliding, not the keys. The A6 keeps track of all notes played and
which voices played them
so that it knows the most current note values of each of its
16 voices. Therefore, depending on what voices were played before portamento is turned on, you may get sliding from all directions or not much at all. The distance and direction of the glide depends on which voice is getting the new note relative to what note this voice played before.
P
ORTAMENTO
C
ONTROLS
Portamento is fully programmable per Program.
TIME Knob
This control varies the portamento rate, or the amount of time it takes to slide from previously played notes to the target notes. Portamento time is adjusted in either seconds or seconds-per-octave depending on the selected portamento mode. Turning this knob selects the TIME parameter on the PORTA page.
MOD Button
Pressing the
MOD
button displays the MOD page of modulation parameters for portamento. This page provides parameters for creating a mod route to the portamento’s
TIME
parameter (displayed on the
MOD
page as
PORTA RATE
), providing variations in the portamento speed. If a mod route has been created by turning the ENABLE parameter to ON , the
MOD
LED will be illuminated. Using a modulation on
TIME
, you can affect the rate of sliding in countless ways.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
59
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
ON/OFF Button
This button simply turns the portamento function on or off. When on, the LED will light. Pressing this button selects the
ENABLE
parameter on the
PORTA
page.
Portamento Parameters
SOFT KNOB
PAGE TAB
PORTA
STMODE
MOD
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
TIME
MODE
SOURCE
SPEED
OFFSET
MODE
LEVEL
CURVE ENABLE
OFFSET ENABLE
OSC EN FLT EN
8
PAGE
PORTA
PORTA Parameters
PARAMETER
TIME
SPEED
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
OFF
2 M ···
32.77 S
OCTAVE
1SPEED
Sets the speed of the glide between notes.
Minimum is
2M
or 2 milliseconds; maximum is about 33 seconds. The actual time it takes to slide between two notes is dependent upon the
SPEED setting, described next.
This parameter determines the method used to calculate the rate of portamento between notes:
When set to
OCTAVE
, the
TIME
setting is determined by the interval between notes and is expressed in “seconds per octave.” If
TIME
is set to 5.00
seconds, for example, the time it takes to slide one octave is 5 seconds. The time it takes to glide the entire length of the keyboard (five octaves) is 25 seconds.
When set to 1SPEED , the TIME setting doesn’t care about the interval in its calculations. The rate of sliding is the same between semitones as it is between octaves. Using the previous example of 5.00
seconds, it takes five seconds to glide from the E key to the F key just above it, just one semitone. It also takes five seconds to slide from the same E key to the E three octaves above it.
60 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
PORTA
Continued
PARAMETER
MODE
CURVE
ENABLE
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
This parameter is used to select from among three portamento actions:
NORMAL
LEGATO
LEGATO2
LINEAR
EXP 1
EXP 2
EXP 3
LOG 1
LOG 2
LOG 3
SCURV1
SCURV2
OFF, ON
Each new voice that is played will have
Portamento. The portamento will glide from the last note played by this voice to the new note.
Voices played staccato will not glide. While
holding
the first voice of a program, subsequent voices will glide, starting from the last key pressed.
Operates like
NORMAL
for each first voice of a program. While holding the original note
(voice), subsequent notes will not glide.
This parameter allows you to select the slope used to glide between notes. Refer to the discussionand the graphs on the following pages for a complete description of these slopes.
standard linear slope
Exponential 1: less steep version of Exponential 2
Exponential 2: standard ln curve
Exponential 3: steeper verion of Exponential 2
Logarithmic 1: less steep version of Logarthmic 2
Logarithmic 2: standard e x
curve
Logarithmic 3: steeper verion of Logarthmic 2
S-Curve 1: forward “S-Curve”, created by merging EXPO2 into LOG2
S-Curve 2: reverse progression of
SCURVE1
Enables portamento. The
ON/OFF
LED reflects the status.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
61
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
CURVE: Selecting the Portamento’s Slope
Identical to the stages of an envelope, Portamento has a user-selectable property called slope. This term refers to how gliding notes accelerate (speed up) or decelerate
(slow down) as each voice approaches its target note:
• A LINEAR slope means that gliding notes do not accelerate (or decelerate) as they progress towards their target (destination) notes. In the illustration on the next page, notice that the linear slope is depicted as a straight line (from where we get the term “linear”). The glide doesn’t speed up or slow down but keeps an even rate of change.
• An EXP (exponential) slope, however, accelerates towards the target notes: it starts out slow then speeds up as it gets closer to its destination. Rather than a straight line, it is represented by a curve. One of three exponential curves can be selected.
• In contrast, the
LOG
(logarithmic) slope decelerates towards the target notes: it starts out fast then slows down as it reaches its destination. It is represented by a curve that is the opposite of the exponent. One of three logarithmic curves can be selected.
• The
SCURV
(“S” Curve) combines the slopes of
EXP 2
and
LOG 2
. One of two
S-Curves can be selected:
SCURV1: The rising-amplitude of S-Curve 1 is characterized by acceleration during the first half of its stage using
EXP 2
, then decelerates during the last half using
LOG 2
. This is commonly known as a forward progression s-curve.
The falling-amplitude of S-Curve 1 is the opposite of its rising-amp: the stage decelerates during the first half using LOG 2 , then accelerates during the last half using
EXP 2
.
SCURV2 : The opposite of S-Curve 1 – commonly referred to as a reverse
progression s-curve – the rising-amplitude of S-Curve 2 decelerates during the first half using
LOG 2
, then accelerates during the last half using
EXP 2
.
The falling-amplitude of S-Curve 2 accelerates during the first half using
EXP
2 , then decelerates during the last half using LOG 2 .
62 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
PORTAMENTO SLOPES
Rising LINEAR Falling
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Rising EXPONENTIAL 1 Falling
Rising EXPONENTIAL 2 Falling
Rising EXPONENTIAL 3 Falling
Rising LOGARITHMIC 1 Falling
Rising LOGARITHMIC 2 Falling
Rising LOGARITHMIC 3 Falling
Rising S-CURVE 1 Falling Rising S-CURVE 2 Falling
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
63
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
STMODE Parameters
PAGE
STMODE
Start Mode
PARAMETER
MODE
OFFSET
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
This page determines where the portamento is sliding from—its start point.
LSTKEY
OFFSET
CHORD
OLDEST
-127 ··· + 127
When a new note is played, it will “slide” from the last key played.
When a new note is played, it will slide from a fixed number of semitones above or below the note, as set by the OFFSET variable set by Soft
Knob 2.
Each voice slides from its previous value. For example, whatever note Voice 8 last played, that’s where it will slide from when called upon again. The voice order is set in the
KBD MODE
section (Unison X, Poly, and Mono).
Each voice slides from the oldest note that is being held.
Sets the number of notes above or below the present note where the slide will start, when the
MODE
is set to
OFFSET
. For example, a setting of
-12 will always start sliding from an octave below the note played.
Portamento MOD Parameters
The Portamento Modulation parameters permit you to create a mod route to modulate the
RATE
parameter. Please note that, unlike most of the other
MOD
pages,
RATE is the only Portamento parameter that can be modulated.
PAGE
MOD
Portamento
Speed
Modulation
PARAMETER
SOURCE
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
NONE or any mod source
Selects one of the A6’s mod sources to modulate the Portamento’s
RATE
. The default is
OFFSET
ONLY .
LEVEL
OFFSET
ENABLE
-100 ··· 100
-100 ··· + 100
Sets the level or intensity of the mod source.
Standard mod route offset.
OFF, ON Turns the modulation OFF or ON .
The status of the parameter is also shown by the
LED next to the
MOD
button.
64 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
T
HE
P
ERFORMANCE
W
HEELS AND
R
IBBON
C
ONTROLLER
B
ACKGROUND
The A6 utilizes two performance wheels that are used mainly for pitch bend (
PITCH
) and vibrato (
MOD
). The Pitch wheel on the left is a spring-loaded wheel that snaps back to its center or neutral position when released, and is normally used for pitch bend. The Mod wheel on the right is not spring loaded and must be manually returned to its off position. It is normally used for vibrato.
But note that you can assign each one to a different destination – you are not confined to using them for strictly pitch bend and vibrato. In fact, you can make both pitch bend or both vibrato, if you so desire.
Better yet, they can be neither pitch bend nor vibrato, as you can assign these wheels to modulate any parameter of the sound that is designated as a mod destination. But best of all, you can assign the wheels to perform multiple modulations at the same
time
. Imagine a wheel causing vibrato, increasing the reverb amount, fading in the sub-oscillators and triggering the sequencer all at once. See Chapter 9: Custom
Modulations for an in-depth look at Andromeda’s “modulation matrix” that allows you to customize mod routes or mod paths to achieve out-of-the-ordinary results.
In any case, the purpose and range of these wheels are programmable per Program, which makes them incredibly flexible. Consider the possibility of a wheel being used to control the brightness of the sound instead of pitch, or to control the amount of reverb or chorus, or to alter the pulse width of one (or both) VCOs... The possibilities are virtually limitless.
Typically, the pitch wheel is set up so that pushing it away from you bends played notes up in pitch and pulling bends them down. The A6’s pitch wheel however, can have its polarity – the positive/negative attributes – reversed so that pushing pitchbends down and pulling bends up.
The pitch wheel can also be programmed so that it can have a different type of modulation on either side of the center stop. You can set the wheel to pitch bend when pushed (up or down, your choice) and change the portamento time when pulled, as just one of many, many examples.
You can think of the Ribbon Controller as a wheel that’s been stretched across the
A6’s front panel. It can be assigned to any of the A6’s mod destinations and is programmable per Program like the wheels. It operates simply by touching it with a finger and sliding it along the ribbon’s surface.
One of its attributes that distinguishes it from the wheels is that it may be divided in half—the left and right sides (from the center line mark on the top panel) may act as separate controllers aimed at separate destinations. And because the Ribbon
Controller has a much longer travel than the wheels, it typically has a more accurate response since you have more physical space across the ribbon’s surface within a given range.
In all cases – for both wheels and the ribbon – the MIDI Controller Number is userselectable and programmable per Program so you can determine how the wheels will affect other instruments via MIDI for each Program.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
65
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
P
ROGRAMMING THE
W
HEELS AND
R
IBBON
All of the Programs that ship with the A6 have default wheel and ribbon modulations stored with them. In most cases (but not all), the left wheel and ribbon are preset for pitch bend and the right wheel is vibrato. Some factory Programs, on the other hand, have the wheels and ribbon preset to other types of modulation depending on what is appropriate for the Program.
For MIDI purposes, the right wheel defaults to
MIDI Controller 1 (vibrato) and the left wheel and ribbon are assigned to Channel Pitch Bend. These assignments can be changed, however, and stored for each Program.
To make changes to either wheel, press the
PITCH
(“Pitch Wheel”)
ASSIGN
or the
MOD
(“Mod Wheel”)
ASSIGN
button. The parameters for that wheel will be displayed. Likewise, pressing the
RIBBON
button to the left of the ribbon controller displays its parameters.
PITCH ASSIGN Parameters
SOFT KNOB
PAGE TAB
PWHEEL
CROUTE
1 2 3 4 5 6
BOTRNG TOPRNG BOTCRV TOPCRV OSC 1
SOURCE LEVEL ENABLE ROUTE
OSC 2
7 8
PAGE
PWHEEL
PARAMETER
BOTRNG
Bottom Range
TOPRNG
Top Range
BOTCRV
Bottom Curve
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
- 0 ··· 48
+ 0 ··· 48
LINEAR ···
SCURV2
The A6 permits you to adjust the range of the upper travel of the Pitch Wheel independent of its lower travel:
This parameter adjusts the bottom range of the
Pitch Wheel from 0 to 48 semitones (4 octaves).
The default value is two semitones (one Whole tone).
This parameter adjusts the top range of the
Pitch Wheel from 0 to 48 semitones. The default value is two semitones (one Whole tone).
This parameter selects one of nine response curves for the wheel’s lower travel. See the discussion on curves starting on page 62.
66 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
PWHEEL
Continued
PARAMETER
TOPCRV
Top Curve
OSC 1
OSC 2
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
LINEAR ···
SCURV2
This parameter selects one of nine response curves for the wheel’s upper travel. See the discussion on curves starting on page 62.
OFF
,
ON
Turn the effect of the Pitch Wheel on
OSC 1
on or off.
OFF , ON
Turn the effect of the Pitch Wheel on
OSC 2
on or off.
MOD ASSIGN Parameters
SOFT KNOB
PAGE TAB
MODWHL
CROUTE
1 2
SCALE
SOURCE
CURVE
3 4 5
LEVEL ENABLE ROUTE
6 7 8
PAGE
MODWHL
PARAMETER
SCALE
CURVE
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
0 ··· 100 Adjusts the modulation amount from the wheel.
Higher values = more modulation.
LINEAR ···
SCURV2
This parameter selects one of nine response curves for the wheel’s travel. See the discussion on curves starting on page 62.
CROUTES (Control Routes)
A second press of either the
PITCH ASSIGN
or the
MOD ASSIGN
button will bring up the
CROUTES page. This allows you to see and change the internal routings of the controllers. By turning the ROUTE knob, you can see the source routed to that destination. You’ll need to enter this page whenever you want to create custom control setups that are different from the defaults. For more information, see
Chapter 9: Custom Modulations.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
67
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Pedals and Footswitches
Its seems as if anything plugged into an instrument that you step on is called a pedal.
Well, not exactly. There are actually two types of “foot-actuated controllers” in the context of an electronic instrument. Although it’s politically correct to called them
“pedals” generically, one is accurately called a switch, and one is accurately called a pedal. We’ll define both of them:
A foot switch is a momentary device – it is a spring-loaded switch that operates by
“pressing and releasing” for
ON
(press: foot down) or
OFF
(release: foot off) signals.
The A6 uses footswitches with a 2-conductor 1/4” connector and are plugged into the
SWITCH
and
SUSTAIN
functions of the A6.
A foot pedal is a potentiometer device – the pedal mechanically operates an internal
knob
(technically known as a potentiometer) giving you “more” or “less” rather than
“on” or “off” like a switch. These pedals are often referred to as “rocker pedals”. The
A6 uses a footpedal with a 2-conductor 1/4” connector typically used for volume and modulation and is connected to the
PEDAL/CV
jack.
The diagram below shows what the right kind of connector looks if you want to purchase a pedal or switch.
68
Footswitch and pedal functions are defined (set up) in the PEDAL page of GLOBAL mode. This set of parameters in the A6 are particularly interesting (and useful) as they permit you to reverse a pedal’s action or make its MIDI function different from its local function. For example, a rocker-type pedal that is used as a volume pedal on the A6 can be sending modulation messages out MIDI at the same time. For details on the PEDAL parameters, see page 50.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
T
HE
CLOCK S
ECTION
The A6’s Clock is a global function that provides global synchronization as a modulation source to all voices in Programs or Mixes. By global sync we mean that any A6 function that relies on tempo can get its timing from the Clock.
The timing can be steady or variable.
Some examples of A6 functions that rely on tempo are the
Sequencer and the
Arpeggiator. You can also slave modulation sources such as LFO rates and Envelope stages to the Clock when their timing needs to coincide with a song’s tempo. Normally, the A6’s LFOs run independently of the Clock as they have their own generators for
RATE
. The same applies to Envelopes whose stages are normally timed by their own circuitry. But when the need arises to synchronize one or more LFOs or Envelope stages to a common tempo, this is accomplished by slaving the desired destination to the Clock.
Conversely, you can modulate the Clock’s tempo by an LFO or Envelope or any of the A6’s 71 modulation sources. This is accomplished using
SYNC/MOD
as described below.
How the A6’s clock is integrated with the Sequencer and Arpeggiator is covered in the following topics. Slaving an LFO to the Clock is covered in Chapter 7. Slaving an
Envelope stage is discussed in Chapter 6.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
69
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
DISPLAY
PAGE
CLOCK
C
LOCK
P
ARAMETERS
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
TEMPO
TEMPO
Knob
—
—
SYNSRC
Sync Source
MODVOX
Tempo
Modulation by
Voice
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
0.4578 ···
500.0000
Beats Per Minute
The knob adjusts the tempo of the Clock from
.46 bpm to 500 bpm, adjusted in increments of
1/10000 th
of a bpm (.0001 on the display) for slower settings. To fine-adjust fractions at higher rates, use the
▲
and
▼
buttons.
This parameter selects the source from which the Clock’s tempo is generated:
LOCAL the A6’s internal dedicated clock
MIDI incoming MIDI clock from an external MIDI
Master
LFO 1, 2 or 3 the clock that controls
LFO 1
,
2
or
3
.
FIRST
OLDEST
NEWEST
This parameter is used to select the amount of modulation triggered by a voice. Use the soft knob below this parameter in the display to select one of three options, described below.
The first voice to modulate the clock will determine the modulation source amount. If this first voice is released while other voices are held, the last modulation source for the first voice is held and used.
The oldest voice playing this sequence will determine the modulation source amount.
The newest voice playing this sequence will determine the modulation source amount.
70 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
SYNC/MOD Button
Pressing the
SYNC/MOD
button that is located directly below the
TEMPO
knob displays the parameters for modulating the tempo of the Clock by any of the A6’s 71 modulation sources. Use
SYNC/MOD
to modulate the tempo of the Clock by the selected mod source.
DISPLAY
PAGE
MOD
SYNC/MOD Parameters
If the
SYNC/MOD
button is pressed, the following parameters will be shown on the display. Unlike other MOD pages, there's no DEST parameter controlled by Soft
Knob 6 because there is only one destination, the CLOCK RATE .
PANEL LABEL
—
—
—
SYNC/MOD
Button + LED
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
SOURCE
LEVEL
OFFSET
ENABLE
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
Any of the A6’s 71 modulation sources.
See Appendix B.
-100 ··· +100
Use soft knob
1
to scroll through the list of possible modulation sources.
-100 ··· +100
ON, OFF
This parameter sets the amount of modulation that will affect the tempo. Keep in mind that negative values invert the action of the selected source. For example, if Velocity is the source and a negative value for
LEVEL
is used, playing harder will reduce the level and thus slowing the tempo of the Clcok.
This parameter sets the offset or fine adjustment for the selected modulation level.
This parameter is used to turn the selected modulation on or off. Use soft knob
5
or the panel button.
S
EQUENCER
A sequence is a series of two or more “events” (usually musical notes) that play one after another – or “in sequence.” The A6 Sequencer is a simple 16-step, 3-level modulation source/note triggering module. It follows the functionality offered by the early analog sequencers found in the Moog and Buchla modular synthesizers, as well as many others.
The Sequencer is a per Program function: each of the 128 user Programs can have its own sequence that is saved in memory along with all of its other settings. This means that each program within a Mix can have its own sequence, so if you construct a Mix with 16 different Programs – each with its own sequence – the Mix will have 16 different sequences at the same time.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
71
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Layout
Each of the sequencer’s 16 “steps” or “events” consists of four components or Levels: a Note, the note’s Velocity amount, the note’s duration called Gate time, and whether a note will play or the step will be a rest, called the Type.
It is important to note here that the A6’s Sequencer, unlike many other sequencers that play their recorded notes when you press
START
, can be triggered by numerous sources. By default, the A6’s Sequencer runs when you play a note, and will play the sequence in a key signature using that note as a reference. Likewise, if a chord is played, the sequencer will sequence the chord according to its note settings.
Note that the values for the
NOTE
Level can have either a positive value or a negative value. This means that the sequence can play notes above and below the root note of the sequence. For example, a sequence is often constructed such that it starts playing when one note is played and held down. That’s the root note of the sequence which is normally set to
0
, the equivalent of “no transpose.” The
NOTE
setting for any Step can then be “tuned” up or down from the root. This flexibility in allowing note values below the root provides a way to create interesting and useful melodic patterns.
Of course you can play chords, and the sequencer will play the pattern for every note in the chord.
When an event “plays,” Note, Velocity and Gate are output to the sequencer’s assigned destination—most often the voices—simultaneously. The most common use of the Sequencer is to play musical notes, so each event will generate a Note On (plus its associated Velocity), then output a corresponding Note Off when the Gate Time has expired. Of course, if
TYPE
is set to
REST
, the Step will rest (the
NOTE
and
VEL settings are bypassed) for the amount of time that the
GATE
is set to.
But also note that the Sequencer can be used as a source in a modulation route. In this case, Note, Velocity and Gate are listed in the
MOD SRC LIST
as
SEQ LEVEL A
,
B and C respectively.
The table below shows the Sequencer Graph. The Graph can be thought of as being in any time signature or combination of time signatures. For example, common 4/4 usage would yield four bars of quarter notes with downbeats at Steps 1, 5, 9 and 13.
Depending on how you set the
RATE
setting and Gate times to fit into the song, you can also consider a sequence as two bars of 8 th
notes, one bar of 16 th
notes, and so forth. And since you can select the number of Steps, five steps of quarter notes can play a bar of 5/4 and ten steps of quarter notes can play two bars in 5/4 with down beats on steps 1 and 6. Six steps of eighth notes can play a bar of 6/8 and 12 steps of eighth notes can play a two bars of 6/8 with down beats on steps 1 and 7.
STEP (or “EVENT”)
NOTE
VEL (Velocity)
GATE
TYPE
A
•
•
•
•
B
•
•
•
•
C D
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
E
•
•
•
•
F
•
•
•
•
G
•
•
•
•
H
•
•
•
•
I
•
•
•
•
J
•
•
•
•
K
•
•
•
•
L
•
•
•
•
M N O
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P
•
•
•
•
72 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
START/STOP Button
Pressing this button starts or stops the Sequencer. This is a programmable function: if you save the Program with the sequencer running, the sequencer will run as soon as you select this program from memory. But remember: you
may not hear anything until the sequence receives a trigger, normally the keyboard.
The default trigger source is the keyboard, but you can change that if you want.
SYNC/MOD Button
screen. The Sync/Mod page of parameters allows you to modulate the tempo of the sequence. The Sync/Mod parameters table that describes their functions can be found on page 78.
Pressing this button displays the
Sequencer’s
MOD
page on the
VIEW Button
Pressing this button recalls the page of Sequencer parameters that was last used (it defaults to the GRAPH page). Using this button to enter the Sequencer edit mode allows you to examine the current settings without making any changes. You can, of course, change any setting but you don’t have to when using a
VIEW
button.
Sequencer Parameters
This section describes the parameters of the Sequencer. The summary table below shows the Sequencer’s parameter names – listed in the rows under under the
SOFT
KNOB
numbers – with their associated page (parameter group) in the
PAGE TAB
column. The tables on the following pages provide operational details of each display page.
SOFT KNOB
PAGE TAB
NOTE
GRAPH
CONFIG
TRIG
VEL
GATE
TYPE
PROGRS
SYNC
MOD
RUN
1-16
1
A
2
B
3
C
4
D
5
E
6
F
7
G
8
H
I J K L M N O P
SOURCE
BPM
PRGRSR MIN
KYMODE LENGTH LPTYPE LPCNT
LEVEL TYPE RETRIG ENABLE
USEKBD
TRGVOX
ZOOM
MODE
MIX
SYNSRC TIXSTP
SOURCE LEVEL OFFSET ENABLE
Pressing this button turns the sequencer on or off. This is the same as pressing the
START/STOP
button in the
SEQUENCER
section on the front panel.
Use soft button
8
to select a Step ( A – P ) on the GRAPH page for editing.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
73
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
GRAPH
GRAPH and 1 - 8 Parameters
The
GRAPH
page is used to set the Note, Velocity, Gate and Type values for the 16 steps:
•
Pressing soft button
1
( GRAPH ) repeatedly cycles through the NOTE , VEL , GATE and
TYPE
parameters for the selected Step.
•
Soft knobs 1 through 8 are used to select and adjust the values in each Step.
•
The graph on top shows the settings for all Steps at once. The Parameter and
Value rows of the display show the settings for eight Steps at a time (Steps A -
H or Steps I – P). Repeatedly press soft button
8
to tab between the two groups of Steps.
PARAMETER
NOTE
VEL
Velocity
GATE
TYPE
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
E-11 ··· G+10
Semitones
0 ··· 127
0 ··· 100
NOTE, REST
This parameter sets the note value of the Step. A setting of C0 indicates that the sequencer will play the note being played on the A6’s keyboard or the incoming MIDI Note.
This parameter sets the velocity amount of the note set in the
NOTE
parameter, above.
64
is the default setting.
This parameter sets the gate time or duration of the note set in the
NOTE
parameter, above.
This parameter selects the type of Step, whether it plays a note or a rest.
If
NOTE
is selected, the Step outputs the note set in the NOTE parameter along with its associated
VEL and GATE settings.
If
REST
is selected, the Step outputs the
GATE time only, effectively playing a musical rest.
74 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
CONFIG
Sequencer
Configuration
Sequencer CONFIG Parameters
PARAMETER
BPM
KYMODE
LENGTH
LPTYPE
Loop Type
LPCNT
Loop Count
MONLEG
Mono Legato
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
.01HZ ···
50.00 HZ
OFF, ON
The tempo of the Sequencer displayed in “Hz”
(cycles per second).
Under normal conditions, the sequencer will use its own clock for the the tempo. This is the situation when
LOCAL
is selected on the
SYNC page. If
CLOCK
or
MIDI
is selected on the
SYNC page, this parameter has no effect.
When
ON
, the sequencer will play a the A6’s voice(s) when a note or chord is played. This is the most common usage of the sequencer. The
NOTE , VEL and GATE values are also available as mod sources.
When OFF , the sequencer will not play a the
A6’s voice(s) when a note or chord is played.
The A6 behaves as if the sequencer isn’t running, but
NOTE
,
VEL
and
GATE
values are still available as mod sources.
1
···
16
Selects the number of Steps that the sequencer will play from 1 to 16 (Steps A through P ).
This parameter determines how the sequence
“loops” or cycles.
FORWRD
REVERSE
The sequence plays forward through the selected Steps.
The sequencer cycles backward through the selected Steps.
ROKROL
Rock-n-Roll
: The sequence cycles backward and forward through the Steps.
When the sequencer is running, this parameter determines the number of times the sequence will loop through the Steps, or turns it
OFF
:
1 ··· 240
SUSTN sets a finite number of loops from 1 to 240 repititions.
the loop will continue to cycle as long as notes are being played or the Sustain Pedal is down.
INFINT
the sequence will continue to cycle infinitely once started. The sequence can still be stopped by using the
START/STOP button.
OFF, ON
When
ON
, this parameter allows the sequence to be transposed in the middle of its cycle when you play legato.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
75
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
TRIG
TRIG Parameters
PARAMETER
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
SOURCE Many of the MOD sources such as
Mod Wheel,
Ribbon, Footswitch, etc.
This parameter allows you to select an input that will trigger the sequencer. Unlike other
MOD source menus, nothing involved with a voice is on the list, since the voices themselves are being triggered by this function.
The selected trigger source is activated when certain conditions exist. Specifically, when the selected trigger’s
LEVEL
and
TYPE
(described below) are detected, the trigger is activated.
The A6 gets its signal to generate a trigger when the
SOURCE
reaches a certain
LEVEL
that you set (next page) and when the source is “moving” in a positive or negative direction, or both (next page under
TYPE
- polarity type).
LEVEL
TYPE
-100 ··· +100
NEGATIVE
BIPOLAR
POSITIVE
This sets the level of the SOURCE (selected above) where triggering will take place.
Note that if the POLAR setting (below) is set to one of the absolute ( ABS ) options, negative
settings are treated as is they were positive
.
The trigger will occur only when the source is
“moving in a negative direction.” This means that a trigger is generated when the
LEVEL setting is reached, but only if the source is
decreasing in amplitude
.
The trigger occurs when the
LEVEL
is reached but the source can be either increasing or decreasing in amplitude.
The trigger will occur only when the source is
“moving in a positive direction.” This means that a trigger is generated when the
LEVEL setting is reached, but only if the source is
increasing in amplitude
.
ABS
: Absolute – the following polarities treat positive and negative
LEVEL
settings as if they were all positive.
ABS NEGATIVE
Absolute Negative: a trigger is generated when the source is moving in a negative direction and reaches the absolute value of the
LEVEL
.
ABS BIPOLAR
Absolute Bi-Polar: a trigger is generated when the source is moving in a either direction and reaches the absolute value of the LEVEL .
ABS POSITIVE
Absolute Positive: a trigger is generated when the source is moving in a positive direction and reaches the absolute value of the
LEVEL
.
76 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
TRIG
Continued
PARAMETER
RETRIG
ENABLE
MODE
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
OFF, ON
OFF, ON
Turns re-triggering on or off. When off, the trig source acts as a one-shot trigger. When on, the trigger acts repeatedly, restarting the sequence from the beginning.
Turns the trigger on or off.
This parameter determines how voices are played once a trigger or multiple triggers occur.
NORMAL
One trigger plays the sequence according to the
CONFIG
page settings.
STAGE
Requires multiple triggers: each Step (“stage”) in the sequence plays in order if each new
trigger has a different level
.
ADVANC
Requires multiple triggers: each Step plays in order with each new trigger.
RANDOM
Requires multiple triggers: each Step plays at random with each new trigger.
PROGRS Parameters
The Progressor allows for automatic transposing of the sequence within the limits set by the
MIN
and
MAX
parameters. Although the
PRGRSR
is the first parameter on the screen, you should set the
MIN
and
MAX
limits first, then adjust the
PRGRSR
value.
Using 0 as the base note (the key that’s being played) value, the MIN value sets the low end of the note range where transposing takes place. Conversely, MAX sets the upper limit of the note range where transposing takes place. Although both of these parameters have a -127 to +127 range, the most useful limits will be within a few octaves (
-24
to
+24
settings).
The
PRGRSR
value determines the transpose amount. A setting of
1
means that the sequence will transpose up one semitone starting at the MIN note with each repetition of the sequence until the
MAX
note limit is reached. A
PRGRSR setting of
-1 means that the sequence will start playing at the MAX key and transpose down one
semitone
with each repetition until the MIN note limit is reached.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
77
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
PAGE
SYNC
SYNC Parameters
PARAMETER
SYNSRC
Sync Source
TIXSTP
Clock Ticks per
Step
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
This parameter allows you to select the clock source that will drive the sequencer.
LOCAL
CLOCK
MIDI
2 ··· 65535
Uses the sequencer’s dedicated clock for its tempo.
Uses the A6’s global Clock for tempo.
Uses an external MIDI device for tempo.
In order to compensate for significant differences in clocks, especially external clock sources, TIXSTP allows you to designate the number of clock ticks per step. The default is
2 and each increase occurs in 3-tick increments.
About Tempos and TIXSTP
The SYNC page features a tempo display that can help you match the speed of the clock to musical values. This display calculator assumes that 24 ticks equals a quarter note, and that the music is in 4/4 time. If SYNSRC is set to CLOCK , and
TIXSTP
is set to
24
, the display will read:
0:0:Qtr Note and the sequencer will advance one Step per beat. If you want the sequencer to play twice as fast relative to the beat of the clock, set TIXSTP to 12 and the display will read
0:0:8th Note
. The format of the tempo display is:
Phrase (4 bars):Bars (4 beats):Note/tick value
So, if you want the Sequencer to advance one Step per 4-beat bar, set
TIXSTP
to
96 and the display will read 0:1:0 Ticks . If you want to slow it down so that it advances only one Step every 4 measures (assuming 4/4 time), set
TIXSTP
to
384 and the display will read 1:0:0 Ticks .
MOD Parameters
The modulation page for the sequencer is identical to the
SYNC/MOD
page for the
Clock. See page 71.
78 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
A
RPEGGIATOR
Similar to a sequence, an arpeggio is musical term that refers to the playing of notes of a chord one after another instead of playing them simultaneously. The A6’s
Arpeggiator is used to create programmable arpeggios – Arpeggiator settings are made per Program and stored in memory with each Program. An arpeggiator is extremely versatile in that intricate patterns of notes can be constructed that would otherwise be extremely difficult, if not impossible, to play manually. Also, arpeggios can be played faster than is humanly possible, or span octaves above or below the physical limits of the keyboard.
The A6 Arpeggiator is nearly identical to the Sequencer in its basic design. The main difference lies in the display layout and what you’re playing on the keyboard (or what the A6 is receiving via MIDI In).
Also, unlike the Sequencer, the Arpeggiator is a per Voice function rather than a per
Program function. This means that each playing voice is linked to its own arpeggiator. This results in 16 arpeggiators – one per Voice – each with their own status, position, and voice variables.
The Arpeggiator TRIG , PROGRS , SYN and MOD parameter pages are identical to those of the Sequencer (refer to pages 76 through 78 for the information). The only different set of parameters exist on the
CONFIG
page which is covered on the next page.
START/STOP Button
Starts and stops the Arpeggiator.
This is a programmable function for all voices in Programs or
Mixes.
SYNC/MOD Button
Pressing this button displays the
Arpeggiator’s
SYNC
page on the screen. This page of parameters allows you to set the source of the
Arpeggiator’s tempo.
VIEW Button
Pressing this button recalls the page of Arpeggiator parameters that was last used (it defaults to the CONFIG page). Using this button to enter the Arpeggiator edit mode allows you to examine the current settings without making any changes. You can, of course, change any setting but you don’t have to when using a
VIEW
button.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
79
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
Arpeggiator CONFIG Parameters
PAGE
CNFG
Arpeggiator
Configuration
PARAMETER
BPM
Beats per Minute
LENGTH
OCTAVE
CENTER
TYPE
CHORD
LATCH
RUN
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
.46 ··· 600
0 ··· 100
-10 ··· +1`0 Sets the number of octaves the arpeggio will play.
0
indicates that a held chord will only arpeggiate the notes actually held. Positive values transpose the arpeggio up that number of octaves; negative values transpose the arpeggio down that number of octaves.
OFF, ON Places the held notes in the “center” of the arpeggio: if the OCTAVE parameter above is set to
3
, the arpeggio will play three octaves above and below the chord played.
Determines the direction the Arpeggiator will play notes:
FORWRD The arpeggio will play notes in order from the lowest to the highest, and additional octaves (as set in the
OCTAVE
parameter, above) from lowest to highest.
REVERS
The speed or rate of the Arpeggiator displayed in “bpm” or beats per minute. This setting is independent of any
TEMPO
setting for the Clock or Sequencer, and is only effective when the
Arpeggiator is set to
LOCAL
in the
SYNC
menu.
Modifies the Release 2 times of the envelopes.
RNRINC
RNRCIR
OFF, ON
The arpeggio will play notes in reverse order from the highest to the lowest, and additional octaves (as set in the
OCTAVE
parameter, above) from highest to lowest.
Rock-n-Roll Inclusive – the sequence will play the arpeggio forward then in reverse, including the end notes twice: once when completing the forward direction and once when starting the reverse direction.
Rock-n-Roll Circle – the sequence will play the arpeggio forward then in reverse, but will not play the end notes twice as in RNRINC .
When off, a held chord arpeggiates as single notes. When on, a held chord is heard as a chord along with its arpeggiated notes.
OFF, ON
OFF, ON
Latch keeps the arpeggio playing after you let go of the keys. This function uses soft button
7
and is available when any Arpeggio page is displayed.
Turns the arpeggio on or off. This function uses soft button
8
and is available when any
Arpeggio page is displayed.
80 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
C
HAPTER
3
B
ASICS OF
A
NALOG
S
YNTHESIS
A
N
O
VERVIEW OF
S
YNTHESIS
The concept of a synthesizer is an instrument that is capable of producing a very wide range of sounds electronically. The huge popularity and continued development of synths since the late 60s is due, in great part, to this ability to offer so many different types of sound textures in one box.
A synthesizer’s ability to produce such an incredible variety of sound comes from its basic design: it electronically simulates the fundamental components of sound and
gives you control over each part
. The term synthesize means to “to combine parts into a whole”. And that’s exactly what a synthesizer does: the essential ingredients of sound are presented on the front panel as separate parts which are then “re-assembled” as an audible sound.
A
NALOG AND
D
IGITAL
T
ECHNOLOGIES
In today’s world, the majority of electronic keyboards are digital. Although the first synthesizers were analog, the demand for digital products led the market away from analog designs. But because analog instruments have a sound quality all their own, and because they operate somewhat differently than their digital cousins, there’s been sort of a revival of interest in this technology.
So if this is your first analog synthesizer, or your first synthesizer ever, you might be wondering what the difference is. Briefly, a digital instrument is completely
dependent on its microprocessor(s) and memory for the sounds it makes
and any control and sound-modifying functions.
An analog instrument uses electronic circuitry for sound creation and filtering that is
not
dependent on its computer chip. While the instrument’s processor provides many control and memory functions, the basic sound path is in the hardware that is
separate from the microprocessor
. In the early days of synthesizers, everything in the unit was analog, which involved many transistors, resistors, capacitors, diodes and coils of wire, and often meant no program memory, frequent manual tuning, limited sound-modifying abilities and relatively high cost.
But where did all this start?
A L
ITTLE
H
ISTORY
Electronic music as we know it today began years ago with musicians and physicists analyzing and experimenting with sound. Sound, as we might remember from high school physics, is created by an object vibrating the air causing sound waves – minor fluctuations or changes in air pressure that we perceive or experience with our ears as audible sound. The people who studied this natural phenomenon from a musical perspective put audible sound into two categories: sound that has a musical pitch and sound that doesn’t.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
81
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
For both pitched and non-pitched sounds, there are two key elements of sound that we will be working with when creating or editing Programs on the A6. First, we need to consider what makes up a sound wave: what are the components of a sound wave and how do they relate to the
A6? Second, we need to know that sound changes over a period of time, which can be a mere fraction of a second to several minutes (or longer). Let’s take a few moments to cover these two elements.
A L
ITTLE
T
HEORY
W
AVEFORMS
All audible sound consists of waveforms or waveshapes. These are the vibrating air waves our ears perceive as sound, and can be described by their “form” (or the “shape” of the wave) when depicted by a graph. Waveforms can be illustrated by simple graphs that show how they would appear on the display screen of an oscilloscope, an electronic device used to analyze sound waves. The graphs in the left column illustrate what the basic waveforms look like.
Waveforms are the primary components of the “raw” sound in a synthesizer. But instead of a “vibrating object”, these waveforms are generated electronically. This is the function of an analog synthesizer that we mentioned just a moment ago: the electronic approximation of sound waves that occur in nature.
The A6 uses 32 oscillators – electronic circuits that produce raw waveforms – to simulate naturally occurring sound waves. For our purposes in operating the A6, we’ll classify waveforms into two types based on their shape:
• Cyclical or periodic waves repeat a particular pattern over and over. The main property of a periodic wave is that it
has a musical pitch or tone
. Periodic waves, therefore, are especially useful when attempting to synthesize traditional instruments such as violins and other stringed instruments, brass and horns, reed instruments and so forth. By the same token, periodic waveforms are useful when synthesizing entirely new sounds that don’t sound anything like a violin or a clarinet.
The A6 provides four periodic waveforms which are described by the shape of the sound wave they create:
Sine, Triangle, Pulse and Sawtooth. These four basic waveforms have distinct sound personalities and lend themselves to producing certain kinds of sounds as we will discover later.
• Non-cyclical or aperiodic waves are irregular and do not have any particular pattern that is repeated. The main property of an non-cyclical wave is that it does not have a musical tone. Aperiodic waves, therefore, are especially useful when synthesizing wind, thunder, explosions or
82 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
mechanical sounds. Clever use of aperiodic waves, often in combination with periodic waveforms, have resulted in sounds that closely resemble drums, cymbals and helicopters. The A6 provides two of these non-cyclical sound sources called
Random and Noise.
Central to all sounds are two properties frequency and amplitude. Frequency is another word for pitch. Low notes on a musical instrument, for example, are said to have a low frequency; high pitched notes have a high frequency. Amplitude is commonly associated with “amount” and often (but not always) refers to the volume level of a sound: high amplitude means loud, low amplitude means soft or quiet. Frequency and amplitude are also used to describe the properties of control signals that are not audible themselves – you can’t actually hear a vibrato signal, but you can hear the
effects
of it when applied to a sound. More on that later.
F
UNDAMENTALS AND
H
ARMONICS
Periodic waveforms, when analyzed further, reveal that they actually are composed of numerous waves that combine to make up the sound that we hear. The primary wave, called the fundamental, establishes the pitch or note value of the wave. It is also the loudest of all the waves that comprise a sound.
In addition to the fundamental wave, a series of waves are present in each sound that are related to the fundamental. Called harmonics or overtones, these waves are responsible for the waveform’s timbre (pronounced TAM-ber) or tonal identity. For example, Sine and Triangle waves sound “flute-like” with the Triangle wave sounding a little brighter due to its harmonics (a Sine wave is simply a fundamental wave without harmonics). A Sawtooth wave, which has a certain harmonic structure, sound “raspy” while the Square wave, having another set of harmonics, sounds
“hollow”. Variations on the Square wave, accomplished by varying the width of the pulse, sound less hollow as the pulse width becomes narrower, to “nasally” at the narrowest setting.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
83
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
Harmonics, like other periodic waves, have frequency and amplitude. Their frequencies are musical intervals above the fundamental which can be thought of as the “root”. Their amplitudes are also based on the loudness of the fundamental: each harmonic diminishes in amplitude as you get further away from the fundamental.
84
FUNDAMENTAL
FREQUENCY
1 kHz 2 kHz
HARMONIC
PARTIALS
5 kHz 10 kHz 20 kHz
Harmonics also determine if the waveform is perceived to be “bright” or “muted”: the more harmonics present in the waveform, the brighter the sound appears to our ears. This is where filters come in.
In an analog synthesizer, the harmonic content of the sound is controlled by the filters: circuitry that controls the amount of harmonics present in the Program. By its very name, it’s implied that these circuits “filter out” harmonics. This is true: the filters provide a range or bandwidth of harmonics, sometimes called the spectrum, that the sound will contain by filtering out or removing the harmonics of a waveform generated by the oscillators. It is also possible to set the filter “wide open” (at maximum) so that all of the harmonics are present.
S
OUND
D
YNAMICS
Most of us aren’t conscious of this, but virtually every sound we hear every day is
dynamic: audible sounds make subtle yet significant changes as we are listening to them. Take a piano note, for example. When a key is played and held down, the sound the vibrating strings make goes through numerous fluctuations as the note fades out. When the hammer first strikes the strings, this initial “hit” is the loudest and the brightest part of the sound. As the note fades, notice that not only is there a gradual decrease in loudness but also in brightness as well.
Consider the differences in loudness and tonal quality that different playing styles have on just about any acoustic instrument. Think about how staccato playing sounds different than playing legato on the same instrument.
Envelopes
A synthesizer provides a number of electronic controls that are used to shape or contour the overall sound as it plays out over the duration of the note. We’re not referring to Velocity, Aftertouch or Pressure here but the synthesizer’s envelopes: electronic circuits that you can set to shape the loudness and the brightness (or lack of it) of the sound as it plays out.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
Here’s a graphical representation of a typical envelope. We’ll be covering the details of how an envelope works, what you can do with it and what all those labels mean in a later chapter. For now, we just want to show you how an envelope is graphed
(especially since the A6’s screen will display something like this when you’re editing an envelope in a Program).
Since sound waves have polarity – both positive and negative properties (a kind of
“pushing and pulling”) when moving air – a sound’s envelope also has polarity.
Using the envelope above to shape a sound wave’s volume, the wave as we might hear it could look like this:
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
85
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
In the real world, sound waves are three dimensional, radiating from a central point of origin. So our example here really looks something like this:
86 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Middle C
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
LFOs
In addition to loudness and brightness dynamics, everyday sounds are often enhanced with repeating, patterned fluctuations we recognize as vibrato. In one of its more expressive applications, a singer often adds vibrato at the end of a sustained note. As an extreme example, you can think of the high rise and fall of a police siren as vibrato on steroids.
A synthesizer uses Low Frequency Oscillators (LFOs) to introduce vibrato to the sound. Designed much like the oscillators that produce raw waveforms as the synth’s primary sound source, LFOs are not heard but are used to modulate, or change, many components of the sound that you can hear: the oscillators, filters, overall loudness and many others.
LFOs use the same waveform types as the oscillators, but their frequency range is much lower (hence the term “low frequency”) because the typical speed of LFO modulation is below the range of an audio oscillator. Using our original graph of a sine wave on page 82, the following illustration shows how this wave affects a sustained note.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
87
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
C
OMPONENTS OF AN
A
NALOG
S
YNTHESIZER
With the preceding information as background, let’s take a look at how our discoveries about sound relate to a physical electronic instrument. Here’s a series of flowcharts illustrating this concept that we will build upon over the next few pages:
1. In its most rudimentary form, the heart of synthesizer is really nothing more than a group of oscillators (to provide the raw sound), feeding the filters (to control the harmonic content of the sound), feeding the output of the instrument (where the final volume level is set).
2. Now we start adding controllers – hardware that gives the instrument playability and expression – and modulation – circuitry and/or software that is used to shape or vary the sound.
First up is the keyboard controlling the pitch of the oscillators:
88 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
3. As the keyboard is played, low notes output low frequencies from the oscillators and high notes play high frequencies. Similarly, the filters can be scaled as well. So it makes sense that the keyboard control be routed to the filters so that low notes played on the keyboard cause the filter to “close” and output fewer harmonics; high notes on the keyboard cause the filters to
“open” and output more harmonics. This type of scaling causes notes across the keyboard to have an even amount of brightness:
4. Envelope modulation is introduced into the signal flow so that the harmonic content (the envelope modulating the filters) and the overall loudness (the envelope modulating the output section) of the sound can be shaped. This shaping is controlled by you as you set the envelopes’ time and amount parameters.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
89
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
5. The keyboard is also responsible for gating the envelopes. In essence, this is really what causes the synthesizer to make a sound. When the envelopes start, they “open” and allow the filters and the output section to pass sound from the oscillators:
6. But what about pitch bend and vibrato controllers? Pitch bend routes a wheel directly to the oscillators so as to allow you to manually vary their pitch.
Vibrato uses a wheel that sends a variable amplitude (amount) to an LFO that in turn varies the pitch of the oscillators up and down slightly:
90 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
7. Last, but not least, we’ll add controller inputs for volume pedal and sustain pedal. Typically, a volume pedal varies the amplitude (again the “amount”) of the synth’s output section.
Sustain pedal control is typically routed to the Release portion of the envelopes: the stage of the envelopes that controls the time it takes for the fundamental and harmonics to fade out.
Note
: The keyboard, pitch bend and vibrato wheels, plus sustain and volume pedals pictured here as physical controllers can also be incoming MIDI information.
This covers the material for our starting point in introducing the concept of analog synthesis. In the next Chapter, we’ll apply all of this wonderful knowledge to the design and operation of the A6, including a comprehensive feature list.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
91
Chapter 3: Basics of Analog Synthesis
92 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
C
HAPTER
4
O
VERVIEW OF THE
A
NDROMEDA
A6
M
AKING
S
ENSE OF
A
LL
T
HIS
T
HEORY
:
A
N
O
VERVIEW OF THE
A6
Now that we’ve covered the bare-bones basics of analog synthesis, we can move on to see how all this theory applies to the A6.
As analog synthesizer technology developed over the years, it became more feasible to not only add more sound-modifying features (additional oscillators, two filters per voice rather than just one, more envelopes, more LFOs, etc.) but add more functionality as well. For example, early analog synthesizers had simpler envelopes with just Attack, Decay, Sustain Level and Release parameters. Advances in technology allowed the addition of a Delay portion as well as a second Decay stage and a second Release stage for more precise articulation of envelope shaping.
In addition, further refinement of analog synthesis allows the routing of standard sound modifiers to more elements of the sound than ever before. In fact, “modifying a modifier” is not only possible but commonplace. Consider modulating an LFO’s speed by an envelope or another LFO, or the keyboard, or the sustain pedal, or dozens of other sources you wouldn’t normally think of using. Later in this manual, we’ll explore how the A6’s audio mixing capabilities provide ways to combine filtered and unfiltered sounds, creating an incredible wealth of new textures. These are just a few highlights of how synthesis has grown and matured.
The A6 represents the latest and most comprehensive set of sound creation tools yet in an analog synthesizer. You’ll find all of the necessary ingredients we just covered plus countless more, including a full complement of studio-quality stereo effects and external inputs.
A F
EW
B
ASIC
C
ONCEPTS
The design of the A6 follows conventional wisdom in the way many of its functions are organized. But that’s where many synth players, especially those who are new to these instruments, get confused. Here, then, are a few fundamental principles that will help you understand how the A6 is laid out.
Essentially, the A6 operates in one of two play modes: Program mode or Mix mode.
The third mode, Global, is not a play mode but a operating mode where the A6’s master settings are made. There will be more said about Global functions later in this
Chapter.
Program Mode
In Chapter 3, we defined a Voice as the most basic component of a synthesizer that produces sound: the physical circuitry (the “hardware”) that generates audio.
A Program is the basic group of sound settings for a Voice – the pitch or tuning, harmonic content and shape, loudness, etc. – that are used to create the Voice’s tonal identity: does it sound like a flute, a trumpet, a violin, a truck, a helicopter, or a dog bark?
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
93
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
In the A6, all of a Voice’s settings are stored in memory for instant recall. So, all of the settings that you use to create a sound are “programmed” into the A6’s memory, hence the term Program for referring to a sound stored in memory.
In
PROGRAM
mode, all 16 of the A6’s Voices get the same Program information and therefore play the same sound. Playing keys on the keyboard or receiving MIDI notes all play the same sound. Things start to get interesting when you put the A6 into
MIX
mode where you take existing Programs and combine them in a wide variety of ways as described in the next topic.
Mix Mode
As the name implies, a Mix is comprised of two or more Programs. Using the A6’s
MIX
mode, existing Programs are combined to create multi-textured sounds. In its most extreme application, each of the 16 voices can be set to play a different Program.
Although rarely used, this can be accomplished quite easily.
But what about standard splits and layers? Mix mode is where splits and layers are set up and programmed for instant recall using existing Programs. The procedures for setting up splits and multi-splits, layers and multi-layers, and splits-with-layers are covered in detail in Chapter 6. Mix mode is also commonly used for multitimbral operation with an external MIDI sequencer.
External Memory
The A6’s
RAM EXPANSION CARD
port on the back panel is ideally suited for use with the Alesis 512k PCMCIA Type I RAM card (PC Card). This is a credit-card-sized memory module that adds additional Program and Mix memory for you to store your own creations in addition to the User bank. These cards are available from your
Alesis dealer. Note, however, that Alesis QCards™, which are ROM cards with sample memory designed for use with the Alesis QS series, will not work in your A6.
Using a PCMCIA RAM card provides additional storage space for you to store both
Programs and Mixes that you create. A RAM card also makes an excellent backup device that is both convenient and fast. Refer to Chapter X for the procedure to format and store sounds on the external RAM card.
External sounds from an Alesis RAM card can be used for single Programs and
Mixes. They can also be combined with internal sounds, both Programs and Mixes.
This opens up new possibilities when creating layers and splits.
94 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
A6 F
UNCTION
L
IST
We continue with a list of A6 functions. Each function will be explained in the section following this list. Detailed descriptions will be covered throughout this manual.
Memory
256 factory Programs (in Flash ROM memory)
128 user-programmable Programs
128 factory Mixes (in Flash ROM memory)
128 user-programmable Mixes
Tone Sources
32 true analog Voltage-Controlled Oscillators (2 per voice) w/ hard and soft sync and sub-oscillation
3 external audio inputs (-10dB): one input to Voice 15 Filters, one input to Voice 16 Filters and one Mono
Input to All filters
1 full-spectrum Noise Generator, capable of producing White, Pink and Red noise
Tone Modifiers
32 true analog Voltage-Controlled Filters w/ resonance (2 per voice)
Filter 1: dynamic 2-pole low-pass, high-pass, band-pass and notch
Filter 2: dynamic 4-pole low-pass
16 Ring Modulators (1 per Voice)
Modulation Sources (per Voice)
3 Low Frequency Oscillators
1 Sample-and-Hold generator
3 multi-stage, multi-mode Envelopes
1 multi-stage Tracking Generator
Audio Mixing
3 in-line signal level controls: Pre-Filter Mix, Post-Filter Mix and Voice Mix to final out through true analog Voltage-Controlled Amplifiers
Controllers
5-octave (C-to-C) velocity, aftertouch and pressure-sensitive semi-weighted keyboard
Modes: full, layer and split w/ polyphonic, monophonic and unison voicings assignable Pitch and Modulation wheels assignable, splittable Ribbon controller rear-panel Volume and Sustain pedal inputs rear-panel Oscillator and Filter control voltage inputs
Real-time Arpeggiator
16-event, programmable Step Sequencer, 1 per Program
Master Clock control
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
95
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
Effects
Analog distortion
Stereo reverb (Large Hall, Hall, Stereo Hall, Room, Chamber, Ambience,
Large Plate, Plate, Hall/Room, Plate/Room, Hall/Plate, Nonlinear)
Delays (Mono, Ping-Pong, Multi-tap, Dual)
Chorus (Stereo Chorus/Flanger, Quad Chorus, Dual)
Flange
Quad pitch shifter
Multieffects (Rotary/Room, Delay/Room, Chorus/Room, Room/Flange,
Flange/Delay/Room, Delay/Room, Chorus/Room, Flange/Room, Pass
Thru)
Display
240 x 64 multi-function back-lighted LCD
Master Controls
Master Volume
Master Tune w/ AutoTune function
Global Transpose
Rear Panel Inputs & Outputs
RAM Expansion Card slot PCMCIA Type I card slot
MIDI
Pedals
Control Voltage inputs
Filter audio inputs
In, Out and Thru
Sustain pedal, footswitch, pedal CV
Oscillator, Filter
Mono to all, Voice 15 filter, Voice 16 filter
Audio
Individual Voice outputs
Auxiliary audio outputs
Main outputs
Headphones
Power
AC receptacle eight stereo 1/4” jacks two mono 1/4” jacks
Left and Right 1/4” jacks stereo 1/4” jack standard 3-prong recessed male receptacle
96 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
A6 F
UNCTIONS
A
T
-
A
-G
LANCE
Memory
The A6 contains enough memory for three banks of 128 Programs and two banks of
128 Mixes. The Preset banks contain the 256 Preset Programs and 128 Preset Mixes we created for the A6 and are stored in semipermanent memory called Flash ROM
(Read-Only Memory). The User bank contains 128 Programs in programmable memory that you can modify to your liking, or use to store your own Programs (128 memory locations) and Mixes (128 of those, too).
Mixes are memory locations that take existing single Programs and allow you to combine them. Examples of this combining of Programs in a Mix would include layering (two Programs played by one note), and keyboard splitting (the lower range of the keyboard plays one Program such as a bass sound, and the upper range of the keyboard plays another Program such as a solo or accompaniment). It is possible to make any combination of layers and splits, with up to 16 programs playing at once.
Mix mode is also used when you want to have multitimbral control from a sequencer, or use the A6 as a MIDI master keyboard controlling other synthesizers and modules.
Programs are selected by using the row of buttons just above the Ribbon Controller.
The 2-digit buttons select the group of 10 and the single-digit buttons select the specific Sound or Mix.
Audio Sources
Referring back to Chapter 3, we covered the basic ingredients of sound and the corresponding components of a synthesizer. Using our first flowchart as an example, the oscillators are the primary sources for raw sound in the A6. To be more specific, the oscillators provide the periodic waveforms used to create sounds with musical pitch.
The A6’s oscillators are true analog Voltage-Controlled Oscillators, hereinafter referred to as the VCOs or by their panel labels
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
. As in the early days of analog synthesis, the frequency of an oscillator – what musical note it plays – is determined by the voltage it is sent by the keyboard (or other controller such as the
Pitch Bend wheel, Vibrato wheel, etc.). Low voltages produce low notes and high voltages result in high notes. Although the A6 has a digital keyboard and also responds to incoming MIDI data, its processor’s data stream that controls the VCOs is converted to an analog voltage first, then is sent to the VCOs. In addition, each of
Andromeda’s VCOs produce sub-oscillation: each VCO outputs a sine wave one octave below its
SEMITONE
tuning.
Aperiodic waves are provided by the A6’s Noise Generator, a full-spectrum
(containing the full range of frequencies) noise source for creating Programs simulating wind, thunder, earthquakes and various mechanical sounds.
The A6 also provides three 1/4” input jacks on the rear panel that allow you to connect, for example, another synth, electric piano or guitar and process these signals through the A6’s Filters and Output stages. Through these inputs, you can connect your external audio to the Filters of either Voice 15 or Voice 16 (or both for stereo), or a mono signal to all Voices.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
97
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
Tone Modifiers
Filters
Referring back to Chapter 3 again, the second component in the signal flow is the synthesizer’s Filters – the circuitry that controls the harmonic content of the sound wave. Like the A6’s VCOs, its filters are true analog Voltage-Controlled Filters. We’ll refer to them throughout the rest of this manual as VCFs or by their panel labels
FILTER 1
and
FILTER 2
.
The A6’s VCFs operate by removing unwanted frequencies from the sound waves generated by the VCOs, the Noise Generator or audio signals input to the A6 via the
EXT FILTER INPUTS
on the unit’s rear panel. This is commonly referred to as subtractive
synthesis whereby the VCOs, for example, generate a full spectrum of harmonics, and the VCFs are used to “filter out” unwanted overtones. If the sound you are creating calls for the full range of harmonics to be heard, you can either “open up” the VCFs by turning their
FREQ
controls fully clockwise or press the
FILTER BYPASS
button.
Although both VCFs appear to have identical controls, they are quite different.
FILTER 1
is a multi-mode filter – it filters harmonics in several ways.
FILTER 2
is a single mode filter – only one type of harmonic filtering is accomplished by this circuit. We’ll cover these modes in detail in Chapter 5.
Last, the A6’s VCFs are designed such that the output of
FILTER 1
can be routed into
FILTER 2
. This allows additional control over the harmonic content of the sound wave by providing a means of “filtering a filter”.
Ring Modulator
The A6’s Ring Modulator, labeled on the front panel as
RING MOD
, is another classic analog tone modifier. It generates a series of sum-and-difference overtones from the input signals, resulting often in a metallic, distorted character that is frequencydependent. For more on Ring Modulation, see Chapter 8.
Modulation Sources
The term modulation means “to change”. Musically, we use the term modulation when referring to a key change in a composition. In the world of synthesis, the concept of change applies to any control that causes variation to the original sound wave over a period of time.
The A6 offers the common sources of modulation in a synthesizer: Low-Frequency
Oscillators, Envelopes, and the Tracking Generator. (Strictly speaking, however, any change to the sound wave’s components would be considered a mod source. The keyboard, for example – and for that matter incoming MIDI notes – would be considered a modulation source because it changes the frequency of the VCOs.)
The A6’s Low-Frequency Oscillators – hereinafter referred to as LFOs – are similar to the A6’s VCOs in that they produce periodic waveforms. The difference is in the
“low-frequency” designation: LFOs produce waveforms whose frequency or pitch is usually below our threshold of hearing. Because of this, LFOs aren’t considered a source of sound in the A6 and are not part of the audio path. They’re only used for modulation.
Because of their low-frequency nature, LFOs are not only perfect for the familiar vibrato and trills, they provide a virtually unlimited source of special effects. In addition to the periodic waves, a fourth LFO in the A6 provides Sample-and-Hold modulation –
S & H
on the front panel – a classic analog mod that produces a random modulation wave.
The A6’s Envelopes are the time-dependent modulators we introduced in Chapter 2.
Commonly used to shape the harmonics (
ENV 2 (FILTER)
) and overall loudness (
ENV 3
98 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
(AMP)
) of the sound wave, an Envelope can also be routed to a VCO for pitch changes.
For this purpose,
ENV 1
is routed to the frequency of
OSC 2
. via a rotary front-panel control; it can also be routed to
OSC 1.
The Tracking Generator, found on the A6’s front panel under the
PROCESS
label and as a MOD source in many display windows, is a circuit that is used to “reshape” a modulation source. A good example of this is using the Track Gen to reshape the keyboard control. The A6 uses a standard equally-tempered keyboard, but its
linearity – a term that refers to how its musical intervals are even from octave to octave and resemble “straight line”– can be significantly changed by the Track Gen such that all five octaves can be squeezed, expanded or even inverted. The Track Gen can be applied to many other modulators in order to modify their normal behavior.
Audio Mixing
The A6 provides several points in the sound path where audio levels are mixed. They are arranged on the front panel into three function groups:
PRE FILTER MIX
,
POST
FILTER MIX
and
VOICE MIX
. The knobs in each group are used to set the level of a particular element of the sound indicated by their labels. For example, the
FILT 1 BP
knob in
POST FILTER MIX
controls the level of the band pass (“
BP
”) output of
FILTER 1
.
To set levels, each knob controls the action of a VCA or Voltage Controlled Amplifier
– a circuit that provides internal signal amplification. Much like the level knobs and faders on an audio mixer, you use a VCA’s knob to control “how much” of a particular component of the Program. In most cases, the “how much” will be an audio level, but not always. VCAs provide signal amplification – also known as
“amplitude level” or “more-or-less” control – to things like modulation amounts. The
ENV 1 AMNT
knob on
OSC 2
and the
ENV 2 AMOUNT
knobs in the VCFs are good examples of this.
The
PRE FILTER MIX
provides controls for blending both VCOs, the
RING MOD
, the
NOISE
generator and the three external Audio Inputs. As the name implies, these signal sources are mixed prior to being processed by the VCFs. On the A6’s rear panel are 1/4” jacks labeled
FILTER AUDIO INPUTS
. These three jacks are used to input external audio signals for processing by the A6’s filters.
The
POST FILTER MIX
controls the outputs of the two VCFs plus the unfiltered outputs of the VCOs’ Sine waves and the Ring Modulator. This is the final mix that is sent to the output section (via the VCA controlled by Envelope 3).
Referring to our first flowchart in Chapter 3, the
VOICE MIX
is the unit’s Output
Section. Although the A6’s main mixes are set in
PRE FILTER MIX
and
POST FILTER MIX
, this section controls the final output levels sent to the rear panel audio out jacks. At the bottom of the section the
LEVEL
knob regulates the output of everything in the
Program currently being edited: the stereo
LEFT
and
RIGHT
and
AUX 1-2
jacks plus the eight stereo
VOICE OUTPUTS
and the stereo
HEADPHONES
. A switch controls whether the output of a program will go to the Main or Aux outputs (or to neither); but a voice is always output to its individual output as long as the
LEVEL knob
is up and the
VOICE MIX
switch is ON.
Last, the
MASTER VOLUME
knob on the left side of the front panel controls the overall output of the Main outs, Aux outs, and headphones, but not the individual Voice
Outs. Unlike the
LEVEL
control, the position of the Volume control is not saved in memory as part of a Program or Mix.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
99
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
Controllers
The A6 provides all the standard hardware controllers you’d expect in a keyboard synthesizer plus a few more. Most obvious is its 5-octave (C-to-C) semi-weighted keyboard that responds to velocity and aftertouch. It can be played normally with one Program across all keys, or can be split so that one Program plays from the lower range of keys and a second Program plays from the upper range. In fact, three-way and four-way (or more) splits are easy. In all cases, split points are user-assignable and programmable. Also, two or more Programs can be layered, and the balance of the Programs as well as any transposing are user-assignable and programmable.
The A6 features several keyboard performance modes under the
KBD MODE
heading.
In addition to the A6’s polyphonic (
POLY
) play mode, monophonic (
MONO
) and unison (
UNISON X
) voicings are also available along with a wide range of Portamento
(
PORTA
) modes.
And where would we be without assignable Pitch and Modulation wheels? Notice that the controller wheels are not specifically labeled Pitch Bend and Vibrato. That’s because you can define each wheel as you like it using the
ASSIGN
buttons. Some of us like the Mod wheel to be the one on the right, because in the days of hard-wiring controllers, most manufacturers just did it that way, and we got used to it. But you can assign Vibrato to be the one on the left, if you so desire. In fact, you can make
both
wheels Pitch or both Vibrato. Or make them do something else, like add/remove brightness, control volume level, you name it.
There are also back panel inputs for
FOOTSWITCHES AND PEDALS
. The A6’s
PEDAL/CV
(commonly used for volume) and
SUSTAIN
pedal inputs allow the use of foot controllers for master volume control and sustain. A third input jack labeled
SWITCH
is ideally suited for footswitch control of patch changes. The electrical specifications for these switches and pedals are listed in Appendix C: Specifications.
That long strip of fabric along the top of the keyboard is the A6’s Ribbon Controller.
Normally assigned to the VCOs’ frequency to create a pitch bend device, it can be assigned to countless other parts of the sound.
The rear-panel
CONTROL VOLTAGE INPUTS
labeled
OSCILLATOR
and
FILTER
are the classic control inputs from the early analog era. These inputs make controlling the
VCOs and VCFs possible from external analog devices like an analog sequencer, guitar synth or wind controller.
The A6’s Real-time
ARPEGGIATOR
takes held chords from the keyboard and/or incoming MIDI Notes and creates an arpeggio from the original chord. You can arpeggiate “up” (from the lowest note being played to the highest note), “down”
(high to low), or up and down. You can also extend the range of the held notes to up to five octaves above the actual notes being played.
Another classic analog controller is the A6’s 16-event, programmable
SEQUENCER
– a
step
sequencer that takes its design right out of the pages of analog genesis. The notes and filter settings are programmed by hand – not recorded like you’d expect from a digital or MIDI sequencer. There’s a programmable sequence for each of the
128 Programs.
The
MASTER CLOCK
control sets the tempo for both the Arpeggiator and each
Sequence, and can be slaved to received MIDI Timing Clock.
100 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
Effects
The digital effects built into the A6 employ the same state-of-the-art technology as the studio products Alesis is known for. The extensive list of effects is programmable not only for each Program but for each Mix as well. This gives you the freedom to set up effects sets that work well for a single Programs, then create other effects sets that are appropriate for split or layered Mixes. This design provides enormous flexibility when applying effects to the wide variety of sound textures possible with the A6.
An analog distortion section provides several levels of the classic "overdrive" sound essential to many synth sounds, with extensive control over how much distortion is added to a given Program or Mix.
Display
The 240 x 64 backlighted display – and its associated knobs and buttons – is your control panel for operating virtually all functions on the A6. It is both a text-based window where titled and numerical values are entered and a graphical workspace where A6 functions such as LFOs and Envelopes are pictured when edited.
The display area is where you edit programs and store them. It is where you assemble Mixes from the existing single Programs, and where you make your MIDI settings.
Master Controls
MASTER VOLUME
: controls the final audio output level of the A6. Any pre- or postmixing in a Program or relative levels set among the component Sound
Programs in a Mix are not affected when adjusting the
MASTER VOLUME
.
MASTER TUNE
: controls the overall tuning reference of the A6. This knob is used to tune the A6 to another instrument. Any VCO tunings, transpose amounts or relative tunings among the component Programs in a Mix are preserved when adjusting the
MASTER TUNE
.
AUTO TUNE
: as a true analog synthesizer, the 32 VCOs and VCFs of the A6 are subject to slight amounts of tuning drift. Pressing this button twice retunes the VCOs and VCFs to standard pitch. A background tuning feature can be turned on or off as desired; normally it is left on.
TRANSPOSE
: this button transposes the A6 up or down over a two octave range.
Using Middle C as your reference, press this button and use soft knob
1
to set the transpose amount. The A6 will be globally transposed by the new interval. As with
MASTER TUNE
and
AUTO TUNE
, any VCO tunings, transpose amounts or relative tunings among the component Programs in a Mix are preserved when transposing.
Rear Panel Inputs & Outputs
RAM EXPANSION CARD
slot: accepts an Alesis PCMCIA Type I SRAM card for additional storage of both Programs and Mixes. A compatible RAM card can be formatted for storing several additional banks of your own Programs and Mixes, and can be used for data backup.
MIDI IN
,
OUT
and
THRU
ports: these standard MIDI ports are used for communication between the A6 and other MIDI-compatible devices. A thorough discussion of the MIDI functions of the A6 can be found in Chapter 8.
FOOTSWITCHES AND PEDALS
: see the discussion under the heading “Controllers” earlier in this section on page100.
CONTROL VOLTAGE INPUTS
: see the discussion under the heading “Controllers” earlier
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
101
Chapter 4: Andromeda A6 Overview
in this section on page 95.
FILTER AUDIO INPUTS
: see the discussion under the heading “Audio Mixing” earlier in this section on page 95.
Audio
MAIN
outputs: the
LEFT
and
RIGHT
1/4” jacks provide the main stereo output signal for the A6. They are fed by the
MASTER VOLUME
control after the final voice mix is set by the
LEVEL
control in the
VOICE MIX
section.
AUX OUT
: these two auxiliary audio outputs are mono 1/4” jacks that supplement the
MAIN
stereo outs. They are fed by the
MASTER VOLUME
control after the auxiliary voice mix is set by the
MAIN/AUX SWITCH
and
LEVEL
controls in the
VOICE MIX
section.
VOICE OUTPUTS
: these eight stereo 1/4” jacks provide the means to mix each of the
A6’s 16 Voices on its own mixer channel. These outputs are not affected by the
MASTER VOLUME
controls.
HEADPHONES
: this stereo 1/4” jack is used with standard stereo headphones for private listening and/or monitoring of the A6. It is fed by the
MASTER VOLUME
control after the final mix is set by the
LEVEL
control in the
VOICE MIX
section.
Power
AC RECEPTACLE
and
POWER
switch: the standard 3-prong recessed male receptacle accepts the standard grounded AC line cord. A suitable cable for using the A6
in your geographical region was included in the carton
. Longer or shorter cables may be purchased at electronics or computer stores. Do not attempt to use another type of power cable and do not attempt to modify this receptacle or the cable itself. Doing so may cause serious injury or death. Please refer to the chapter at the beginning of this manual entitled
Important Safety
Instructions
.
The
POWER
switch is used to turn the A6 on or off. As a precautionary measure, it is advised that you power on your A6 before you power on your audio system.
This prevents any audio spikes that may be output from the A6 from damaging your amplifier or speaker system. By the same token, when shutting down your rig, turn off your amplifier first then the A6. This is a good practice to follow with all of your instruments and devices.
MIDI O
VERVIEW
The A6 employs a comprehensive MIDI system for communicating with a wide variety of MIDI instruments and devices. Unlike many keyboard instruments, the A6 offers MIDI control that you wouldn’t normally expect from an instrument of its type. Of particular note, the A6 sends and receives MIDI Timing Clock. This System
Real-Time Message is usually found only on time-based devices like a sequencer or a drum machine. Since the A6 has step sequencing and an arpeggiator, these clockbased features can control other rhythm-type units or be controlled from an external
MIDI source.
The Andromeda is capable of sending and receiving on up to 16 MIDI channels simultaneously (but keep in mind that only 16 voices can sound at any one moment).
Mix Mode is used for this kind of MIDI application. In Program Mode, the A6 sends and receives on a single MIDI channel at a time.
102 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
C
HAPTER
5
P
ROGRAM
F
UNCTIONS
P
ART
1:
O
SCILLATORS AND
F
ILTERS
Up to this point in the manual, what we’ve covered so far will serve mainly as background material for the rest of the manual. But it is important background material, especially for A6 owners new to analog synthesis or analog veterans who’ve been away for awhile. For the rest of the manual, we’ll be cross-referencing portions of the previous four Chapters as appropriate.
Before we dive into Program editing and creation, let’s take a moment to review what progress we’ve made so far:
• Chapter 1 provides the info for setting up the A6.
• Chapter 2 is an expanded QuickStart guide: a working overview of the performance functions of the A6.
• Chapter 3 explains the roots of analog synthesis: what it is, how it works and how all of this began.
• Chapter 4 takes the info we provided in Chapter 3 and applies it to the A6.
This Chapter also provides a list of A6 functions and brief descriptions.
Now we’re ready to tackle programming the A6. The most intricate operations of the
A6 lie in the area of creating new Programs or modifying existing ones. As a
prerequisite to actually creating Programs on the A6, we need to understand how the functions of the A6 operate.
Let’s start by detailing the A6’s primary sound sources, the Voltage Controlled Oscillators. We’ll then cover the Filters, and the two primary modulation engines, the Envelopes and the Low Frequency Oscillators.
O
SCILLATORS
The A6’s Voltage Controlled Oscillators
(VCOs), labeled on the front panel as
OSC
1
and
OSC 2
, are the primary sound sources in the A6. Although the A6 has a
Noise Generator and inputs for external audio sources, you’ll most likely be using the VCOs for the majority of sounds you create.
We’ve already covered much of the background and primary functions of the
Voltage Controlled Oscillator in Chapters
3 and 4. In Chapter 3, we covered VCO waveforms – what they look like, what they sound like and how they are typically used to approximate familiar sounds. We also discussed the composition of a sound wave: the fundamental and its related harmonics and how filtering and envelope dynamics shape the sound.
Chapter 4 provided a brief functional overview of the oscillators. It also discussed how the VCOs (as well as other
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
103
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
A6 components) fit into the Program/Mix concept. With this as a foundation, we’re now ready to explore the VCOs from a hands-on functional perspective.
O
SCILLATOR
P
ARAMETER
D
ESCRIPTIONS
The following two tables summarize the Pages of parameters for the Andromeda’s two oscillators. Notice that most of the parameters are present in both VCOs. Where there are differences, the manual will specify “OSC 1 Only” ( FMMOD parameters) or
“OSC 2 Only” (
SYNC
parameters) in the sub-title.
OSC 1 Parameters
SOFT KNOB ✿
✿ PAGE TAB
TUNE
WAVE
ENV1
OSC2FM
NZEXT*
1
SEMI
SQUARE
ENABLE
LINFM
SOURCE
2 3 4
CENTS
WIDTH
OFFSET
EXPFM
FINE
LEVEL
LEVEL
PWM
LINFM1
1PITCH
SAW
LIVE
ASSIGN
EXPFM1
5 6 7 8
TRI SINE FILTFM
Parameters for OSC 2. See next table.
OSC2FM
PWM1 EXPFM2 PWM2
MODS
When this page is selected, the screen displays a summary table listing the five modulations for
OSC 1
. and shows different page tabs allowing access to any of the modulations. A press of soft button
1
( <<BACK ) from the MODS page will return to the
TUNE page and parameters shown above. See page 111 for details.
OSC 2 Parameters
SOFT KNOB ✿
✿ PAGE TAB
TUNE
WAVE
ENV1
1 2 3 4
SEMI CENTS FINE 1PITCH
SQUARE WIDTH LEVEL SAW
Parameters for OSC 1. See table above.
5
TRI
LIVE
NZEXT* SOURCE LINFM1 EXPFM1 PWM1
6 7 8
SINE
LEVEL
SYNC
OFFSET
FILTFM
ENABLE
EXPFM2 PWM2
MODS
When this page is selected, the screen displays a table listing the four modulations for
OSC 2
just like
OSC 1
above. See page 111 for details.
*
NOTE
: the
NZEXT
page is shared between the two oscillators—there aren't two external/noise sources.
104 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
TUNE Page Parameters: OSC 1 and OSC 2
Each oscillator has tuning knobs for coarse, fine and ultra-fine tuning control. These three controls have their neutral positions (where A-440 or Standard Pitch is achieved) at 12 o’clock. For each knob, its lowest frequency position is fully counterclockwise. As you turn a knob clockwise, its frequency increases. As you turn the knob counter-clockwise, its pitch is lowered.
DISPLAY
PAGE
TUNE
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
OCT
Panel LED
SEMITONE
CENTS
FINE
·····
SEMI
CENTS
FINE
1PITCH
SYNC
(OSC 2 only)
SYNC
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
- 60 ··· 60
The
OCT
LED will light at each octave interval as the
SEMITONE
knob, described next, is used.
Coarse tuning is accomplished with the
SEMITONE
knob. Turning this knob changes the VCO’s frequency in precise semitone increments over a ten octave range: five octaves up or five octaves down from the 12 o’clock center position (A-440).
- 100 ··· 100
± 1 semitone
For more precise tuning, use the
CENTS
knob or soft knob
2
below the display. The frequency set by the
SEMITONE
knob can be fine tuned in cents. One cent is 1/100 th
of a semitone.
- 100 ··· 100
± 1/10 semitone
Fine tuning is accomplished with the
FINE
knob or soft knob
3
below the display. The
FINE parameter changes the oscillators’ frequency in millicents. A millicent is 1/10 th a cent, or 1/1000 th
of a semitone.
of
OFF, ON If a VCO is being used as a modulation source, it may be necessary to keep its pitch at one particular frequency no matter what note or notes are being played. Turning this parameter ON will disable “keyboard tracking” of the selected VCO so that the same note is produced regardless of what keys (or
MIDI notes) are played. More on this function in the next topic
OSC 1 FM Parameters
.
OFF, SOFT,
HARD
An OSC 2 function only. See the expanded discussion of this parameter beginning on page 115.
When the TUNE page is selected for either oscillator, note that the screen displays “ A4 equals XXX.XX Hz .” Key “A4” is the third “A” key counting up from the bottom
(left side) of the keyboard. When the frequency shows 440.00 Hz, the A6 is tuned to standard pitch.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
105
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
WAVE Page Parameters
DISPLAY
PAGE
WAVE
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
SQR
Button + LED
PULSE WIDTH
SQUARE
WIDTH
—
LEVEL
SAW
Button + LED
SAW
Sawtooth
TRI
Button + LED
SINE
Button + LED
—
TRI
Triangle
SINE
FILTFM
Filter Frequency
Modulation
Output
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
OFF, ON Turns the Square Wave on or off.
0 ··· 100
This parameter sets the width of the Square Wave.
When the
SQR
parameter above is on, the graphic display depicting the Pulse Width will change when you turn the
PULSE WIDTH
control or soft knob
2
.
0 ··· 100
Sets the output level of the
SQR
wave. Note that this is the only waveform that has a level control.
The others are either on (full output) or off.
OFF, POS,
NEG
This parameter turns the Sawtooth wave output of the selected VCO to POS (positive), NEG
(negative) or off.
OFF, ON This parameter turns the Triangle wave output of the selected VCO on or off.
OFF, ON This parameter turns the Sine wave output of the selected VCO on or off.
OFF, ON
This parameter turns the oscillator's send to the
FM modulation of the filter section on or off. This
Filter FM output goes to the Filter section's CV
SRC
parameter as the
FILTFM
source (see page
129). This is used if you want to use FM to modulate the filter with the oscillator output.
106
Selecting Waveforms
When editing an existing Program or creating a new one, one of the key issues in determining what the final program will sound like is what waveform is selected in each VCO. Both
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
have identical functions for producing waveforms so our discussion here covers both VCOs.
Selecting a waveform is as simple as pressing the button next to its panel label. Each
VCO can have a different waveform and more than one waveform can be activated on each VCO. You can have all four waves on at the same time, for example.
The
SAW
and
SQR
(square wave, which is the pulse wave set to 50%) waveforms have a few controls not found on the
SINE
or
TRI
(triangle wave). Pressing the
SAW
button repeatedly toggles between
POS
(positive) and
NEG
(negative) sawtooth waves.
Referring again to Chapter 3, a positive sawtooth corresponds to the Up Saw wave and a negative sawtooth corresponds to the Down Saw.
The
SQR
wave employs a
PULSE WIDTH
knob (duplicated on soft knob 2 when this page is being displayed) that varies its duty cycle. At its fully counter-clockwise position, the duty cycle is 0% producing that “nasal” sound we described in Chapter
3 on page 83. Turning the knob clockwise, the midpoint is 50%, producing a traditional square wave that we described as “hollow” sounding. As the knob is turned clockwise from the midpoint, the duty cycle begins to narrow again until the knob reaches its full clockwise position, producing a 100% pulse width, also “nasal” sounding but with different harmonics than the pulse widths below 50%.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
VCO M
ODULATION
ENV 1 AMOUNT, OSC 2 FM and NZEXT
Of major importance in many synthesizer sounds is the ability to modulate the
VCOs. The A6 provides each oscillator with several pre-routed and three custom modulations. We’ll cover the pre-routed mods accessible from the
VIEW
page first:
ENV1 AMOUNT
,
OSC 2 FM
(found in Osc 1 only) and
NZEXT
(Noise/External).
DISPLAY
PAGE
ENV1
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
OSC 1, OSC 2
Button + 2 LEDs
ENABLE
OFFSET
ENV 1 AMOUNT
LEVEL
LIVE
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
OFF, ON This parameter is used to turn the selected modulation on or off.
-100 ··· +100 This parameter sets the offset for the selected modulation level.
-100 ··· +100
This parameter sets the amount of modulation that will affect the selected VCO’s frequency.
Keep in mind that negative values invert the action of the selected source. For example, if
Velocity is the source and a negative value for
LEVEL
is used, playing harder will lower the
VCO’s pitch.
OFF, ON This makes the front panel control
ENV 1
AMOUNT
active (“live”) for either oscillator.
The soft knobs still work but the
LIVE parameter allows control from the single front panel knob.
Using the ENV 1 AMOUNT Page
This page is displayed when you turn the
ENV 1 AMOUNT
knob on
OSC 2
or enter the page by pressing soft button
3
( ENV 1 tab) from either VCO’s main display page.
This may appear to be a little confusing a first, but just keep in mind that there’s one
ENV1 page that applies to both oscillators and three ways to get there: turn the
ENV 1
AMOUNT
knob, press soft button
3
from
OSC 1
’s main display page or press soft button
3
from
OSC 2
’s main display page.
So the first thing that you’ll notice about this page is that it contains
ENV 1 AMOUNT
parameters for both VCOs. Because each VCO has its own set of parameters (the four on the left of the display are for
OSC 1
, four on the right are for
OSC 2
), you can set them independently.
The
ENV 1 AMOUNT
knob – shown on the ENV1 Page as the LEVEL parameter on the display – controls the amplitude of
ENV 1 (PITCH)
as a mod source modulating the
frequency
of
OSC 1
,
OSC 2
or both as destinations.
Pressing the button adjacent to the
ENV 1 AMOUNT
knob rotates among four possibilities: the first press routes
ENV 1
to
OSC 1
only, a second press routes
ENV 1
to
OSC 2
only, a third press activates both VCOs as
ENV 1
mod destinations, and a fourth press turns
ENV 1
off as a mod source to the VCOs. The LEDs indicate which VCO is selected as a destination.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
107
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
Since there is only one front panel knob for
ENV 1
control, the
LIVE
parameter allows the selection of which oscillators were affected by turning the
ENV1 AMOUNT
knob.
This way you can have one oscillator set to a constant value while the other would be controlled by the
ENV1 AMOUNT
knob. Or you can have the
ENV1 AMOUNT
knob control both oscillators. The soft knobs control the
ENV1 AMOUNT
settings regardless of the
LIVE settings. The LIVE setting is only for the
ENV1 AMOUNT
knob on the front panel.
Once you have selected which VCO(s) to modulate by
ENV 1
, use the
ENV 1 (PITCH)
controls on the upper right-hand area of the front panel to adjust the characteristics of this envelope as it affects the frequency of
OSC 1, OSC 2
or both VCOs. The basics of envelope operation are provided in Chapter 6.
108 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
OSC 2 FM Parameters
Using a VCO as a Mod Source
The frequency of
OSC 1
can be modulated by
OSC 2
, hence the term “OSC 2 FM”, or
“frequency modulation by Oscillator 2”. Using this modulation is a bit more involved than simply turning the
OSC 2 FM
knob clockwise to increase the amount of
OSC 2
modulating
OSC 1
although amount is the main parameter of FM.
What is “FM”?
The abbreviation for frequency modulation, FM can be easily confused with other forms of frequency modulation such as an LFO providing vibrato or trills by modulating the frequency of the VCOs. “FM”, however, has become synonymous with modulating an oscillator by another using one of several technologies that emerged during the 1930s.
As a modulation source, a VCO oscillates at a rate that puts its frequency in the
audible range
, as opposed to an LFO which typically oscillates at a slower rate that is below the range of pitched audio. Since a VCO can cover the entire audible frequency range (and then some: 20Hz to 22Khz), its effect as a modulation source for another oscillator is much different than of an LFO.
When you modulate a VCO by another VCO, the modulation rate is high enough to produce an entirely new set of harmonics called sidebands. The result of this type of modulation is often described as “buzzing” or “metallic”. Also significant in the modulating process is VCO tracking by the keyboard. When tracked by the keyboard, the frequency of the source VCO changes with each new key played, changing the characteristics of the sound.
There are two types of oscillator-generated FM in the A6, linear and exponential.
OSC
1
features both linear and exponential FM,
OSC 2
features exponential FM only.
DISPLAY
PAGE
OSC2FM
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
OSC 2 FM —
—
—
—
—
LINFM
EXPFM
PWM
ASSIGN
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
0 ··· 100
This knob controls the amount of the FM type currently selected. There are three type of FM:
Linear, Exponential and Pulse Width
Modulation, described next.
Linear FM causes the source VCO to modulate the destination VCO such that harmonics are added without shifting the pitch of the notes except at extreme amount settings.
0 ··· 100 Exponential FM, the type found on most synthesizers that have FM, causes
OSC 1
to modulate
OSC 2
such that harmonics are added by shifting the pitch of the notes. The audible result is clangorous, inharmonic tones.
0 ··· 100 PW Mod by FM causes the pulse width of
OSC 1 to be modulated by OSC 2.
LINFM
EXPFM
PWID
Turning this soft knob selects the type of FM to be controlled by the
OSC 2 FM
knob: Linear,
Exponential, Pulse Width or combinations:
Linear + Expo, Linear + PW, Expo + PW, all three together or none.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
109
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
DISPLAY
PAGE
OSC2FM
Continued
PANEL LABEL
—
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
OSC2FM
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
0 ··· 100 This soft knob sets the amount of FM for the type(s) selected in the ASSIGN parameter above. If a combination of two or more types are assigned, notice that the amounts change together and by the same amount. Also notice that this soft knob has the same function as the
OSC 2 FM
knob in the
OSC 1
section.
Basic Operation
To get started, it’s best if OSC 2 is not heard. You can always mix it in later, but for now you should turn the
OSC 2
knob in the
PRE FILTER MIX
all the way counterclockwise. Also, be sure that
SYNC
is set of off.
Next, press the
VIEW
button for
OSC 1
, then press soft button 4 to select the
OSC2FM page. Using soft knob
4
ASSIGN , select LINEAR as the FM type. If EXPFM and PWM aren't set to
0.00
already, zero them out using soft knobs
2
and
3
(or by pressing the
▲
and
▼
buttons simultaneously).
As mentioned earlier, the
OSC 2 FM
knob adjusts the amplitude (amount) of
OSC 2
modulating
OSC 1
. You can also use soft knob
5
for this purpose, or the individual soft knobs for each type of FM.
Play a key on the A6’s keyboard. As you vary the amount, you will notice significant changes to the timbre of the sound.
Next, try experimenting with the frequency of
OSC 2
. First, vary the
SEMITONE
knob while playing the same key repeatedly and note the difference in timbre. When you arrive at a setting that sounds desirable, remember that you can fine-tune this frequency with the
CENTS
and
FINE
knobs.
While you’re working with
OSC 2
’s tuning, try experimenting with the 1PITCH parameter. Press
OSC 2
’s
VIEW
button, then press soft knob 1 to select the
TUNE
page if it’s not already active. Use soft knob
4
to turn 1PITCH on and off. Experiment with varying the amount of FM as well the tuning controls for
OSC 2
.
Notice that there’s a
MOD
button adjacent to the
OSC 2 FM
knob. This indicates that the amount of
OSC 2
modulating
OSC 1
can itself be modulated by any of 79 modulation sources, which provides for some interesting possibilities.
To FM Modulate OSC 2 by OSC 1
To route
OSC 1
to FM
OSC 2
, press one of
OSC 2
’s
MOD
buttons and select OFFSET
ONLY
(the first parameter in the list) as the mod
SOURCE
with soft knob
1
. As described on the next page, select
OSC 1
as the
NZEXT
source. Select
EXT -> EXP FM
(the last parameter in the list) as the DEST with soft knob 7 and experiment with different
OFFSET
levels.
To FM Modulate a Filter by an Oscillator
The filters can be modulated by the oscillators. In the WAVE page, use soft knob 8 to set
FILTFM to
ON
for either or both Osc 1 and Osc 2. These sources will appear in the Filters' CV SOURCE parameters as FILTFM . If Filter 1's CV IN control is up, and either filter has
FILTFM
as its CV source, the filter will be modulated.
110 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
NZEXT Oscillator Modulation Parameters
Similar in principle to
OSC 2 FM
, NZEXT modulation allows you to use four of
Andromeda’s audio sources and use them as modulation sources. By incorporating these mod routes into the A6’s modulation system, you now have the ability to use one of the synthesizer’s three noise sources or Oscillator 1, which produce very high rates of modulation, as mod sources.
Note that, similar to the ENV1 modulation, the NZEXT modulation parameters for both VCOs are shown on a single page, with
OSC 1
's parameters on the left and
OSC 2
's on the right. There is a single SOURCE selection that applies to both
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
.
DISPLAY
PAGE
NZEXT
Noise/
External
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
SOURCE
LINFM1
EXPFM1
PWM1
EXPFM2
PWM2
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
WHT NZ
PNK NZ
RED NZ
OSC 1
Selects the mod source: white (high frequency) noise, pink (mid frequency) noise, red (low frequency) noise or
OSC 1
.
Note that all five of the available destinations, described next, can be modulated at the same time by the selected source.
0 ··· 100 This parameter sets the amount of linear modulation to the frequency of
OSC 1
.
0 ··· 100
This parameter sets the amount of exponential modulation to the frequency of
OSC 1
.
0 ··· 100
This parameter sets the amount of linear modulation to the Pulse Width of
OSC 1
. This modulation will only be heard if
SQR
is turned on in
OSC 1
.
0 ··· 100
0 ··· 100
This parameter sets the amount of exponential modulation to the frequency of
OSC 2
.
This parameter sets the amount of linear modulation to the Pulse Width of
OSC 2
. This modulation will only be heard if
SQR
is turned on in
OSC 2
.
MOD 1, MOD 2 and MOD 3 Buttons and MODS Page
The
MOD 1
,
2
and
3
buttons in the VCOs are used to display and edit the three custom mod routes for each VCO. A lighted LED adjacent to a
MOD
button indicates that a custom mod has been created for that VCO. Pressing a mod button shows its current modulation route in the display (if any) and displays the parameters that will allow you to create a custom modulation route.
The display also allows you access these three
MOD
s at once, as well as PWM and FM.
When any of a VCO’s parameter pages are being displayed, pressing the MODS (soft button
8
) button displays a summary table of the current modulation routes for the currently selected VCO. (This grid, however, does not display the settings for
ENV 1
AMOUNT
modulation to the oscillators.) Reading from left to right, the table lists the modulation’s name, the source, the amount, the offset and the destination. This is just a summary table so none of the soft knobs are active.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
111
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
Soft buttons
3
through
7
, however, are active and allow you to display their respective modulations. Soft buttons
3
,
4
and
5
correspond to the
MOD 1
,
MOD 2
and
MOD 3
buttons in the VCO sections and display their respective pages when pressed.
Soft button
6
PWMOD
corresponds to the
PWM
buttons in the VCO sections and soft button
7
FMMOD
corresponds to the
MOD
button on the
OSC 2 FM
knob on
OSC 1
.
Tip
: When using any of these buttons—either the dedicated buttons on the front panel or the soft buttons (mod tabs) under the display—pressing once displays the function’s page and a second press turns the function on (if it’s presently off) or turns it off (if it’s currently on).
DISPLAY
PAGE
MOD1
MOD2
MOD3
PWMOD
FMMOD
PANEL LABEL
—
—
—
—
—
—
MOD 1, 2 or 3
Button + LED
—
PWM
Button + LED
MOD
Button + LED
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
SOURCE
LEVEL
Any of the A6’s
79 modulation sources. See
Appendix B.
-100 ··· +100
Use soft knob
1
to scroll through the list of possible modulation sources.
This parameter sets the amount of modulation that will affect the selected destination using soft knob
3
. Keep in mind that negative values invert the action of the selected source. For example, if Velocity is the source and a negative value for LEVEL is used, playing harder will reduce the level of the destination.
OFFSET
ENABLE
DEST
Mod Destination
-100 ··· +100 Using soft knob
4
, this parameter sets the offset for the selected modulation level.
OFF, ON This parameter is used to turn the selected modulation on or off. Use soft knob
5
or the panel buttons on the right side of the
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
sections.
See table on next page.
Use soft knob
7
to scroll through the list of possible modulation destinations. The destinations are nine of the oscillator parameters described earlier in this Chapter.
Uses same parameters as above with the exception of DEST which is, of course, the selected VCO’s Pulse Width as the only destination. See the following page for more information on
PWMOD
.
Uses same parameters as above with the exception of DEST which provides three destinations only. See the following page for more information on
FMMOD
.
112 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
MODULATION DESTINATIONS: VCOs
PARAMETER DISPLAYED AS
1.
FREQUENCY
2.
SQR WAVE LEVEL
3.
PULSE WIDTH
4.
OSC2 -> PWM (Oscillator 1 only)
5.
OSC2 -> LIN FM (Oscillator 1 only)
6.
OSC2 -> EXP FM (Oscillator 1 only)
7.
EXT -> PWIDTH
8.
EXT -> LINFM (Oscillator 1 only)
9.
EXT -> EXPFM
DEFINITION
The frequency of
OSC 1
or
OSC 2
.
The output level of the selected VCO’s square wave.
The pulse width of the selected VCO’s square wave.
The output of
OSC 2
feeding into the pulse width modulation of
OSC 1
.
The output of
OSC 2
feeding into the linear frequency modulation of
OSC 1
.
The output of
OSC 2
feeding into the exponential frequency modulation of
OSC 1
.
The output of
NZEXT
(white, pink, red, or
OSC 1
) feeding into the pulse width of the selected VCO.
The output of
NZEXT
(white, pink, red, or
OSC 1
) feeding into the linear frequency modulation of the selected VCO.
The output of
NZEXT
(white, pink, red, or
OSC 1
) feeding into the exponential frequency modulation of the selected
VCO.
PWMOD/PWM Parameters
Both VCOs provide for
PWM
or Pulse Width Modulation, shown as PWMOD on the display. This means that the width setting of the pulse wave set by the
PULSE WIDTH
knob can be varied by a modulation source. This mod has been popular for years and has been used to re-create many well-known sounds ranging from lush string ensembles to thick synth pads.
When the
PWM
button is pressed on either VCO, the display shows the pulse width modulation parameters for that VCO. A VCO’s pulse width is most often modulated by an LFO, but it can easily be modulated by an envelope, the keyboard (velocity, aftertouch or key track), the pitch bend and modulation wheels, pedals and ribbon controller, just to name a few of the 79 possible sources in the A6. See Appendix B for a complete list.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
113
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
FMMOD Parameters
This is the page where the
OSC 2 FM
function (see page 109) is modulated. In other words, you can modulate the amount of
OSC 2
modulating
OSC 1
with the parameters on this page. Referring to the table on the previous page, you have the same SOURCE , LEVEL , OFFSET and ENABLE parameters as the other mods. The difference is that
FMMOD
has the following three destinations:
MODULATION DESTINATIONS: FM MOD
PARAMETER DISPLAYED AS
1.
OSC 2 -> LIN FM
2.
OSC 2 -> EXP FM
3.
OSC 2 -> PWIDTH
DEFINITION
The amount of
OSC 2
’s linear FM modulating
OSC 1
.
The amount of
OSC 2
’s exponential FM modulating
OSC 1
.
The amount of
OSC 2
’s linear FM modulating the Pulse Width of
OSC 1
.
114 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
DISPLAY
PAGE
TUNE
SYNC Parameter: OSC 2 Only
Synchronizing OSC 1 with OSC 2
Even with the VCOs’ fine tuning and ultra-fine tuning controls, it is impossible to tune the VCOs to perfect unison, especially across the entire range of the A6’s keyboard or the wider range of MIDI Notes. There may be times when you need the tuning of two VCOs to be locked to each other. This is where
SYNC
is used.
SYNC
forces the frequency of
OSC 2
to match the frequency of
OSC 1
by locking their waves’ phase – when the waves begin their rise and fall during their periodic cycles.
When two sound waves have their phases synchronized, their cycles begin at exactly the same instant and stay locked throughout the cycle.
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
SYNC
SYNC
Button +
Two LEDs
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
OFF Turns the synchronization of
OSC 2
to
OSC 1
off. Both VCOs oscillate independently.
HARD Turns
HARD SYNC
on. See description below.
SOFT Turns
SOFT SYNC
on. See description below.
Pressing the
SYNC
button rotates among three synchronizing possibilities: the first press activates
HARD
sync, the second press activates
SOFT
sync, and the third press turns
SYNC
off. You can also use soft knob
7
when
OSC 2
’s
TUNE
page is displayed.
The choices, in order, are - OFF , SOFT and HARD .
HARD
sync locks the phase relationship of
OSC 2
’s fundamental wave with that of
OSC
1
.
SOFT
sync locks the phase relationships of
OSC 2
’s harmonics with the harmonics of
OSC 1
. The audible difference between these two methods depends on the frequencies of the VCOs before sync is activated.
When tuned to approximately the same frequency, there’s not much (if any) audible difference between hard and soft sync. What you’ll experience is two VCOs tuned to perfect (well, for all intents and purposes) unison. There may be a noticeable increase in loudness – depending on which waveforms are selected – resulting from two waves being “right on top of each other” (more accurately called “in phase” with each other), and any beating from two oscillators in close frequency will disappear.
As the oscillators are tuned to wider intervals, the difference between
HARD
and
SOFT
sync (or no sync, for that matter) becomes more obvious. If you tune
OSC 2
up a fifth from
OSC 1
then turn
HARD
sync on, for example, a new set of harmonics are created resulting from two fundamental waves – with significantly different frequencies – being locked in phase: the waveforms start their cycles at the same time. Another set of harmonics is created when
SOFT
sync is used.
Since
OSC 1
is the reference, try tuning
OSC 1
up from
OSC 2
and listen to the result of the slaved oscillator (
OSC 2
) being tuned below the reference oscillator (
OSC 1
). Listen to the difference between hard and soft sync in this situation. You might also want to experiment with octave intervals and dissonant intervals as well.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
115
Chapter 5: Oscillators and Filters
MOD Parameters
DISPLAY
PAGE
MOD1
MOD2
MOD3
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
MOD 1
MOD 2
MOD 3
—
SOURCE
—
—
—
—
LEVEL
OFFSET
ENABLE
DEST
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
Any of the A6’s
79 modulation sources.
-100 ··· +100
Use soft knob
1
to scroll through the list of possible modulation sources.
This parameter sets the amount of modulation that will affect the selected destination. Keep in mind that negative values invert the action of the selected source. For example, if Velocity is the source and a negative value for LEVEL is used, playing harder will reduce the level of the destination.
-100 ··· +100 This parameter sets the offset for the selected modulation.
OFF, ON This parameter is used to turn the selected
MOD
on or off.
FREQUENCY,
RESONANCE
Use soft knob
7
to select either
FREQUENCY
or
RESONANCE as the modulation destination.
130 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
C
HAPTER
6
P
ROGRAM
F
UNCTIONS
P
ART
2:
M
ODULATION AND
E
NVELOPES
M
ODULATION
Modulation is quite possibly the most-used operation in a synthesizer. It involves more of the routine day-to-day synth functions than most people are aware of. In fact, even the simplest of Programs has some kind of modulation programmed into it. Otherwise, you wouldn’t be able to hear it.
This section will cover modulation principles and define a number of terms.
Understanding the basics as they are laid out here will make a world of difference when you get to other topics that deal with specific modulations. Refer back to these pages if you need a review.
Also, the A6 incorporates what is called a Modulation Matrix. This technology allows you to route virtually any source to any destination, with few exceptions. Because this functionality is fairly wide in scope, we’ve devoted an entire Chapter to it,
Chapter 9. The basics of modulation are covered right here.
B
ACKGROUND
What It Is
The simplest definition of modulation is “to change something by something else”. It is modifying one component of a Program by another. Having said that, why would we want to use modulation?
Why We Use It
As we discovered in Chapter 3, natural sounds go through many subtle but significant changes as we are listening to them. Referring back to our example of vibrating piano strings, all kinds of modulation is going on. A synthesizer provides numerous types modulation to simulate the changes that an acoustic sound goes through. Therefore, it is essential that a synthesizer provide modulation capabilities if we are to approximate the subtleties and nuances of sounds we’re familiar with.
But a synth is also capable of producing modulations above and beyond what is normally experienced with acoustically-produced sounds. Synthesizers have become famous for their ability to emit sounds that have never been heard before.
Modulation has a whole lot to do with that.
M
ODULATION
P
RINCIPLES
Referring back to our definition of modulation as “changing something by something else”, let’s take a look at what this means.
When a musical sound is played, it can start out loud and fade out. It can also fade in and, at the peak of its loudness, end abruptly. It can fade in and then fade out, or just start loud and end loud. This is volume modulation or, more precisely, amplitude modulation. The loudness of the sound (“something”) can be changed by a pedal, an envelope, an LFO, velocity or other sources (“something else”).
Still using this example, as a sound is being played, it can start out bright and full and while it’s fading out in volume it’s also becoming less bright. Or as it fades in, it
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
131
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
gets brighter as it gets louder. This is harmonic modulation or, more precisely, filter
frequency modulation. The brightness of the sound (“something”) can be changed by a pedal, an envelope, an LFO, velocity or other sources (“something else”).
The principle of “something/something else” is the key concept in understanding modulation. The “something” is called the modulation destination (or simply the destination). It is “what’s being modulated”.
The “something else” is called the modulation source (or simply the source). It is
“what’s doing the modulating”.
Throughout the rest of this manual, we’ll be discussing modulation in terms of sources modulating destinations. This is called a modulation path or simply mod path and we’ll use this term in the documentation as well.
Common Modulations
To further illustrate the source/destination concept, this is a good time to take a look at some everyday modulations. Everything that is mentioned here will be covered in detail throughout the manual.
Keyboard, Mod Wheels and Pedals
Used as often as any modulation source, but rarely perceived as one, the keyboard is a legitimate source of modulation. Because a note played on the keyboard changes the frequency of the VCOs (the key word here is “changes”), the keyboard (and received MIDI Notes for that matter) can be counted among the mod sources in the
A6. Another common keyboard mod destination is the Filters, since we often want the Filter to be more open on higher ranges of the keyboard, or even to track the keyboard exactly because it's in self-oscillation.
However, the keyboard is most commonly recognized as a controller – a mechanical component that affects the sound, rather than a mod source that’s electronic or derived in the synth’s operating system. So we will refer to the keyboard in this manual as a controller rather than a modulation source per se as well as the mod wheels, pedals and ribbon controller.
Envelopes
Loudness and harmonic shaping, plus the amplitude-shaping of other sound elements, make the envelopes indispensable modulation sources for every Program in the A6.
Aside from the essential envelope-to-filter (
ENV 2
) and envelope-to-loudness (
ENV 3
) routings, envelopes are often used to affect VCO frequency (
ENV 1
), shape the amplitude of an LFO, or alter the shape of a VCO’s waveform.
LFOs
Low Frequency Oscillators are similar in design to the VCOs that are used as the primary sound source of an analog synthesizer. They utilize periodic waveforms like the VCOs (sine, triangle, sawtooth and pulse) and aperiodic waves (random and noise) but that’s where the similarity ends. An LFO is not intended to be used as an audio source but a modulation source and, as such, its output is not routed to any of the A6’s audio paths. Rather, an LFO is routed to other elements of the sound as a mod source, so while you can’t hear it directly, you can hear the effect of it on other elements of the sound.
The most common use of an LFO is for vibrato. In fact, the modulation wheel on the
A6 controls the amplitude (amount) of an LFO that is routed to the frequency of the
VCOs and often to the VCFs. Similarly, one or more LFOs are typically used in string ensemble Programs to simulate the animation of many stringed instruments playing
132 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
together.
The LFO section of the A6 also contains an aperiodic mod source called sample-andhold (
S & H
on the front panel). This classic analog mod, discussed in detail later, provides yet another random modulation typically based on a noise source rather than a periodic waveform.
Hardware and Software Modulation
What goes on under the A6’s hood may not be of much interest or importance to most users, but we’d like to take a moment to talk about modulations that are hardware-based and mods that are generated by the A6’s operating system, the software mods.
Hardware Mods
Some of the A6’s modulation sources and modulation destinations exist as physical
modulations. For example, Envelope 3 is connected to the output Voltage Controlled
Amplifier; you don't have to program that.
Software Mods
In contrast to the hardware modulations, the remaining modulation sources and modulation destinations are generated by the A6’s operating system. By nature, this makes them... digital. But not to worry: these mods in their raw form are output to a digital-to-analog converter so, in essence, they are analog modulations at the time they are put to use.
Appendix B: Table of Software Modulation Sources
summarizes the software mod sources in the A6. The software mod destinations in the A6 are listed per function throughout this manual, as they are different for each type of function. For example, the mod destinations for the oscillators are completely different than those for the envelopes. We will provide destination lists wherever appropriate.
Default Modulation Paths
A key concept to understand when using modulation in the A6 is that many of the modulation paths in the A6 are already routed in the instrument’s design. These are called default modulation paths. One of the reasons for including default mod paths is because these particular mods are used so often, pre-routing makes setting them up much easier: they’re already “connected” so all you need to do is adjust values.
Those of you familiar with mixing consoles and patchbays can think of default mod paths as being “normalled”.
But you don’t have to use them if you don’t want to, and you can route any of the default modulation sources to a whole slew of other destinations. By the same token, default modulation destinations can be modulation by a host of other sources.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
133
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
E
NVELOPES
An envelope is used when you want to make changes in the level or the frequency of a destination over a period of time which can be mere fractions of a second – .001
seconds (or one thousandth of a second) – to several minutes or longer.
For level modulation, the changes an envelope makes to the destination is by
modifying its amplitude
(its amount or signal level) during a time period that you can set.
ENV 3
, which defaults to the A6’s audio output amplitude (
AMP
), is a good example of this.*
For frequency modulation, an envelope’s varying output levels can be used to change the current pitch of the VCOs (
ENV 1
defaults to the frequency of
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
) or the Program’s harmonic content, also referred to as the “frequency” of the filters (
ENV 2
defaults to
FILTER 1 FREQ
and
FILTER 2 FREQ
).
E
NVELOPE
P
ROPERTIES
An envelope’s output is often described as a contour or shape. The envelope’s shape is determined by its level settings and time it takes to go from one level to the next. The rising and falling of an envelope’s output levels during the time the envelope is running forms a “shape” so to speak which is then applied to a destination. The destination modulated by the envelope conforms to this shape: the envelope instructs it when to increase or decrease in level or frequency, by how much and for how long.
In Chapter 3 when we introduced the concept of the envelope, we used the example of sound dynamics when we described how an envelope shapes its destination. In our example, we used a synthesized sound’s loudness (the destination) as the thing to be shaped by the envelope.
Using a sound’s loudness again as our example, the envelope controlling it takes a certain amount of time for the sound to achieve maximum volume (or amplitude, which is set in the
ATTACK
time parameter), a certain amount of time for the sound to begin its initial fade (decreasing amplitude, set in the
DECAY 1
time parameter) to a second loudness level (
DECAY 2
level) and so forth until the sound has completely faded to silence.
On the other hand, the very same envelope can be used to shape an LFO: the amplitude in this case is the intensity of the LFO, where the envelope is used to fade the LFO in and out of the sound. Also, the very same envelope can be used to shape the waveforms in the VCOs: applied to a pulse wave, it can vary the wave’s width from wide to narrow or narrow to wide, providing some interesting textures. The flexibility of the A6 becomes obvious when you know you can route an envelope to a long list of destinations. And also keep in mind that an envelope – or any of its parameters, for that matter – can be a destination: try modulating an envelope by an
LFO, for example.
_________________________
* Please note that
ENV 3
is hardwired (physically connected) to the voice’s output stage and cannot be disconnected. While you can use
ENV 3
to modulate many other destinations, it is always routed to its voice’s output.
134 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
E
NVELOPE
P
ARAMETER
D
ESCRIPTIONS
The A6 has three 7-stage loop-able envelope generators per voice. The parameters of the envelopes are described on the following pages. Pressing a button or turning a knob on any of the three envelope areas displays that parameter. You can also press the
VIEW
button on the desired envelope and then use any of the display’s soft knobs and buttons to work with a specific parameter as well as its dedicated panel controls.
SOFT KNOB
PAGE TAB
TIME
LEVEL
TRIG and
RETRIG
2
DYN
LOOP
MOD1
MOD2
MOD3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
DELAY
OFFSET
SOURCE
SOURCE
RESET
START
SOURCE
SOURCE
SOURCE
ATTACK
LEVEL
SUSPDL
END
D1TIME
LEVEL
LEVEL
KEYTRK
COUNT
LEVEL
LEVEL
LEVEL
D2TIME
D2LEVL
POLAR
POLAR
KTBASE
TYPE
OFFSET
OFFSET
OFFSET
R1TIME
SUSTAIN
R2TIME
STAGE
LVLTRK
SMOOTH
ENABLE
ENABLE
ENABLE
ENABLE
ENABLE
VELMOD
SSHAPE
SHAPE
R2LEVL
MODE
MODE
RELMOD
BEAT
DEST
DEST
DEST
POLAR
1
<PAGE>
1
2
The
POLAR
parameter does not appear for
ENV3
.
The
TRIG
and
RETRIG
parameters (except
MODE
) are only effective if
MODE
is set to
MOD TRIG or MOD TRIG/GATE .
Normally, each of the A6’s three envelope generators has a start level of 0, an end level of 0 and four target levels in between. Each target level is achieved by a time parameter as depicted in the illustration below.
Note the stages in the envelope’s cycle that are marked
KEY PRESSED
,
KEY HELD DOWN
, and
KEY LET GO
. Normally, these actions “cue” the envelope: Key Pressed tells the envelope that a “Note On” has occurred: a key on the A6’s keyboard has been played, a note has been played from the A6’s Sequencer or Arpeggiator, or a MIDI
Note has been received. This message starts the Delay, Attack, Decay1 and Decay2 stages will complete in succession as long as a Key is Held Down. Since in this
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
135
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
example the Trigger Mode is set to NORM, the envelope’s Sustain Level will also be maintained as long as the Key is Held Down. As soon as the Key is Let Go – a “Note
Off” – the envelope continues according to the settings of the Release1 and Release2 parameters. This “normal” envelope cycle can be modified extensively, but we’ll use this basic example as a good place to start.
ENV1
and
ENV2
are bi-polar envelopes meaning that each stage level setting has a user range of - 100 through +100 .
ENV3
is positive only because it is hardwired to the final output of the voice. Its stage level ranges, therefore, are
0
through
+100
.
ENV1
and
ENV2
being bi-polar can create unusual envelope shapes as shown in the following graphs. Note that the stage times are identical; only the levels have been changed.
136
Decay 1, Decay 2, and Release 1
TIME
stages can be bypassed by setting their
TIME page parameters –
D1TIME
,
D2TIME
and
R1TIME
– to
0
. Sustain Level is bypassed by setting its level on the LEVEL page to 0 .
There are other ways to bypass stages, or go from one to another depending on when the note or sustain pedal is released using the
TRIG MODE
which we’ll cover starting on page 144. But for now, let’s continue with envelope basics assuming that the envelope mode is set to NORM1 .
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
TIME Page Parameters
The TIME page is where the selected envelope’s stage duration ( TIME ) and stage slope (
SHAPE
) parameters are adjusted.
DISPLAY
PAGE
TIME
PANEL LABEL
➟
DELAY
➟
➟
➟
Tip
: Although you can select any parameter simply by turning its corresponding soft knob, this action also changes the parameter’s value which isn’t always desirable. Sometimes you just want to review the current settings of the parameters on a page without changing anything.
On Envelope pages, you can select a parameter without changing its value by pressing its page’s soft button. For these pages pressing a soft button once selects the page, pressing it again selects the parameter to the right of the active parameter in the Parameter Row. Repeated pressings cycle though all parameters from left to right. We call this handy little feature tabbing.
Parameters in the table below marked with a ➟ are also mod destinations – they can be modulated by another source.
ATTACK
DECAY 1
DECAY 2
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
DELAY
Delay Time
ATTACK
Attack Time
D1TIME
Decay 1 Time
D2TIME
Decay 2 Time
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
OFF ···
131.05 S
From the moment a Note On occurs, this parameters sets the amount of time that elapses before the envelope begins its
ATTACK
stage.
2 M ···
131.05 S
The amount of time it takes the envelope to rise from minimum to maximum amplitude, from 2 milliseconds to 131.05 seconds. Note that Attack
(and Release 2, next page) differs from the other envelope times in that a 2ms time minimum is required.
OFF ···
131.05 S
The amount of time it takes the envelope to decrease from its maximum amplitude to the
D2
LEVEL
.
OFF ···
131.05 S
The amount of time it takes the envelope to decrease from the
D2 LEVEL
to
SUSTAIN
level. The
SUSTAIN
level is the target level whether a note is being held or not.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
137
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
DISPLAY
PAGE
TIME
TIME
Parameters
(continued)
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
— SHAPE
➟
➟
RELEASE 1
RELEASE 2
R1TIME
Release 1 Time
R2TIME
Release 2 Time
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
LINEAR
EXP 1, 2
&
3
LOG 1, 2
&
3
SCURV1
&
2
Designed after the CURVE function of the
PORTA
function,
SHAPE
refers to the slope (acceleration or deceleration attributes) of the envelope’s
Attack, Decay 1, Decay 2, Release 1 and Release
2 stages.
This parameter is active at all times for all time parameters except DELAY . To select a particular slope for a time parameter, select the parameter by tabbing with soft button
1
, then use soft knob
5
to select the desired slope. The display will show an envelope graphic that will depict the slope selected for each stage.
See the
SHAPE
topic on the following page for a detailed description of the A6’s stage slopes.
OFF ···
131.05 S
2 M ···
131.05 S
The amount of time it takes the envelope to decrease from the
SUSTAIN LEVEL
to the
RELEASE
2 LEVEL
; this is the envelope stage entered when a Note Off occurs.
The amount of time it takes the envelope to decrease from the
RELEASE 2 LEVEL
to zero, from
2 milliseconds to 131.05 seconds. Note that
Release 2 (and also Attack, previous page) differs from the other envelope times in that a
2ms time minimum is required.
Important Note
: If
R2TIME
is set to its maximum value, the envelope will enter into “infinite release”. This means that when the envelope reaches this stage, it will hold at its R2LEVL (see page 141) indefinitely until you change to another Program or Mix, or turn the A6 off.
To alert you that
R2TIME
has been set to its maximum, the
HOLD
LED on the front panel for that envelope will light.
138 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
SHAPE: Selecting the Stage Slope
Each time parameter of an envelope (except Delay) has a user-selectable property called slope. This term refers to how the attack, decay and release stages accelerate
(speed up) or decelerate (slow down) as each stage approaches its target level.
When a time stage parameter is selected, its current slope appears in the far right side of the display. Use Soft Knob
7
to make your selection:
• A
LINEAR
slope means that the time settings do not accelerate (or decelerate) as the stage progresses towards its target level. In the illustration above, notice that the linear slope is depicted as a straight line (from where we get the term
“linear”). The stage doesn’t speed up or slow down in its duration but keeps an even rate of change.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
139
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
• An
EXP
(exponential) slope, however, accelerates towards the target level: it starts out slow then speeds up as it gets closer to its target level. Rather than a straight line, it is represented by a curve. One of three exponential curves can be selected:
EXP 1
EXP 2
EXP 3 less steep than EXP 2 standard exponential curve steeper than EXP 2
• In contrast, the LOG (logarithmic) slope decelerates towards the target level: it starts out fast then slows down as it reaches its target level. It is represented by a curve that is the opposite of the exponent. One of three logarithmic curves can be selected:
LOG 1
LOG 2
LOG 3 less steep than
LOG 2 standard logarithmic curve, pictured above steeper than
LOG 2
• The
SCURV
(“S”-Curve) combines the slopes of
EXP 2
and
LOG 2
. One of two Scurves can be selected:
SCURV1
The rising-amplitude of S-Curve 1 is characterized by acceleration during the first half of its stage using EXP 2 , then decelerates during the last half using
LOG 2
. This is commonly known as a forward progression s-curve.
The falling-amplitude of S-Curve 1 is the opposite of its risingamp: the stage decelerates during the first half using LOG 2 , then accelerates during the last half using
EXP 2
.
SCURV2 The opposite of S-Curve 1 – commonly referred to as a reverse
progression s-curve – the rising-amplitude of S-Curve 2 decelerates during the first half using
LOG 2
, then accelerates during the last half using EXP 2 .
The falling-amplitude of S-Curve 2 accelerates during the first half using
EXP 2
, then decelerates during the last half using
LOG 2
.
Tip
: The Attack, Decay and Release stages can have different slopes. You can mix and match slopes any way you want within the same envelope.
140 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
LEVEL Page Parameters
This page of parameters is where the four levels of the envelope are set. Notice that you can use a negative value for any or all of the levels in Envelopes 1 and 2.
DISPLAY
PAGE
LEVEL
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
— OFFSET
—
D2 LEVEL
SUSTAIN
R2 LEVEL
—
LEVEL
Output Level
D2LEVL
Decay 2 Level
SUSTAIN
Sustain Level
R2LEVL
Release 2 Level
POLAR
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
-100 ··· +100 This parameter sets the fine adjustment of the output LEVEL parameter, described next.
0 ··· 100 This parameter sets the overall output level of the envelope. This is also the target level of the
ATTACK
stage.
-100 ··· +100 The target level for the
DECAY 1
slope; at this point the
DECAY 2
time begins.
ENV1 & ENV2 only
0 ··· 100
ENV3 only
-100 ··· +100
ENV1 & ENV2 only
0 ··· 100
ENV3 only
The target level for the
DECAY 2
slope; in typical cases this is the “hold” level during a
sustain situation: a key on the A6’s keyboard is being held down, the A6 is waiting for a MIDI
Note Off command or the end of the GATE from the built-in Sequencer or Arpeggiator.
-100 ··· +100
The target level for the
RELEASE 1
slope; at this point the
RELEASE 2
time begins.
ENV1 & ENV2 only
0 ··· 100
ENV3 only
POSWAV
NEGWAV
This parameter allows you to select between a normal or “positive” (
POSWAV
) or inverted
(
NEGWAV
) envelope. When inverted, the envelope is turned “upside down”: the envelope begins at maximum level and the
Attack stage transitions to zero. The Release 2 stage transitions the level back to maximum.
This parameter is available for Envelopes 1 and 2 only. Envelope 3 is positive only: inverting
ENV 3
would cause it to release indefinitely at maximum level, with nothing to stop it.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
141
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
DISPLAY
PAGE
TRIG
TRIG and RETRIG Pages Parameters
The envelope’s Time and Level parameters determine its shape or contour. As important as an envelope’s shape is when it begins its cycle and how it plays through the cycle. This is where the
TRIG
and
RETRIG
pages come in.
An envelope starts its cycle when it receives a trigger. The most typical and oftenused trigger source is the keyboard: a key or keys played on the keyboard instruct the envelopes to start their cycles. By the same token, incoming MIDI notes are also used to trigger the envelopes, the A6’s Sequencer and Arpeggiator, and a slew of other trig sources we’ll get into shortly.
The
TRIG
and
RETRIG
pages let you determine:
•
where the trigger comes from – the keyboard/MIDI, another envelope, an
LFO, the Sequencer and so forth
•
under what conditions an envelope responds to a received trigger
•
how an envelope proceeds through its cycle once a trigger is received
•
if an envelope is re-triggered and how responds
So this page not only lets you determine if and when an envelope gets a trigger but also what is does after the trigger starts the envelope. Looping would normally fall into this category but because it has a rather large set of parameters, LOOP has its own page of parameters described on page 160.
The following table provides a summary overview of the
TRIG
page parameters. A detailed discussion of the MODE types starts right after the table.
PANEL LABEL
TRIGGER
—
—
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
ENABLE
SOURCE
OFF, ON The
TRIGGER
button on each envelope, or soft knob
6
under each envelope page display, turns the trigger for the selected envelope on or off.
Any of the A6’s 71 modulation sources. See
Appendix B.
This parameter allows you to select an “input” that triggers the envelope. Any of the A6’s 71 modulation sources can be used to trigger the envelope.
The selected trigger source is activated when certain conditions exist. Specifically, when the selected trigger’s Input Level and Polarity characteristics (described below) are detected, the trigger is activated.
Note that this is a one shot input: once the envelope starts its cycle, subsequent triggers are ignored until the envelope stops.
The A6 gets its signal to generate a trigger when the
SOURCE
reaches a certain
LEVEL that you set (next) and when the source “moving” in a positive or negative direction, or both (next page under
POLAR
- polarity).
LEVEL
-100 ··· +100
This sets the level of the SOURCE (selected above) where triggering will take place.
Note that if the POLAR setting (below) is set to one of the absolute (
ABS
) options, negative
settings are treated as is they were positive
.
142 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
DISPLAY
PAGE
TRIG
Continued
PANEL
LABEL
—
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
—
—
POLAR
*
MODE
<PAGE>
NEGATIVE The trigger will occur only when the source is
“moving in a negative direction.” This means that a trigger is generated when the
LEVEL setting is reached, but only if the source is
decreasing in amplitude
.
BIPOLAR
The trigger occurs when the
LEVEL
is reached but the source can be either increasing or decreasing in amplitude.
POSITIVE
The trigger will occur only when the source is
“moving in a positive direction.” This means that a trigger is generated when the
LEVEL setting is reached, but only if the source is
increasing in amplitude
.
ABS
: Absolute – the following polarities treat positive and negative LEVEL settings as if they were all positive.
ABS NEGATIVE
Absolute Negative: a trigger is generated when the source is moving in a negative direction and reaches the absolute value of the
LEVEL
.
ABS BIPOLAR
Absolute Bi-Polar: a trigger is generated when the source is moving in a either direction and reaches the absolute value of the LEVEL .
ABS POSITIVE
Absolute Positive: a trigger is generated when the source is moving in a positive direction and reaches the absolute value of the
LEVEL
.
NORM 1
NORM 2
FRERUN
FR-SUS
SUSREL
MODTRG
MOD-TG
TRIG
RETRIG
Once the envelope is triggered or re-triggered, this parameter instructs the envelope how to execute its Attack, Decay, Sustain and Release stages.
These seven modes are fairly elaborate, so an extended discussion with examples are presented starting on the next page.
Not only are envelopes triggered, they can also be configured to be re-triggered. Use soft knob
8
to toggle between the
TRIG
page and the RETRIG pages of parameters.
*
For an in-depth study of these polarities, see our discussion on
How Modulation Triggering Works
using an LFO source as the example. This topic starts on page 155.
An interesting attribute of the envelopes is that while they rely on a trigger source to start (an envelope is a trigger destination), they themselves can also be trigger
sources
. One of the more interesting properties of envelopes is the triggering capabilities of the envelopes’ parameters. As an example, an envelope can be configured so that a trigger is generated by an envelope when its attack stage reaches a certain level. This trigger can be used to start another envelope or an LFO as just a few possibilities.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
143
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
Envelope Modes
The envelope
MODE
parameter on the
TRIG
page determines how an envelope is
triggered
(started) and how it progresses through its stages under various circumstances. There are seven envelope modes: Normal 1, Normal 2, Freerun,
Freerun-Sustain, Sustain-Release 1, Mod-Trigger, Mod-Trig/Gate.
Here are some terms used in the following descriptions of the envelope modes. The descriptions get a little technical in breaking down the modes into their basic parts, but this will be valuable in understanding the intricate functions of the envelopes.
Note On
Note Off
Sustain Pedal On
Sustain Pedal Off
A note is played from the A6’s keyboard, Arpeggiator, or
Sequencer, or a received MIDI Note. This term also includes the amount of time (the “duration”) from the moment a note is played – a Note On event – until the key is let go – the Note Off event.
The manual will sometimes refer to a Note On as a “key being played” or words to that effect. For simplicity, we’ll use this phrase to mean any note played, whether it comes from the keyboard, the Sequencer or Arpeggiator, or a received MIDI Note.
The corresponding Note Off event for a previous Note On.
Like the Note On term, the manual will sometimes refer to a Note Off as a “key being let go” or words to that effect.
We’ll use this phrase to mean any note off message, whether it comes from the keyboard, the Sequencer or
Arpeggiator, or a received MIDI Note.
the SUSPDL envelope parameter is ON ( DYN parameter page) and the actual sustain pedal is depressed.
the SUSPDL envelope parameter is OFF or the actual sustain pedal is not depressed or has been released.
Modulation Source On
when using the
MOD-TRIG
or
MOD-TRIG/GATE
modes, this phrase indicates any amount of time (duration) from the
Key Note On event to the Key Note Off event .
The following pages detail the behavior of the six envelope modes. Keep in mind that during any stage of an envelope, the envelope may also be affected by any modulation, re-triggering, looping, etc.
144 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
NORM 1
A
NORM 1
envelope will proceed through its cycle to the Sustain stage as long as a key is being held down (Note On). The Release 1 stage starts when the key is let go
(Note Off). But if the key is let go before the Sustain stage is reached, the envelope
“jumps” to the Release 1 stage. Also, if the key is let go then immediately played again, the envelope will resume from its current level.
Start
:
Progress
:
The envelope is started by the beginning of a Note On event.
During the Note On, the envelope proceeds normally through Delay,
Attack, Decay 1, and Decay 2 stages to the Sustain stage.
Sustain
: 1. If the Note On is held until the Sustain stage is reached, the Note
On or a Sustain Pedal On will hold the envelope at the Sustain level until a Key Off and a Sustain Pedal off occur. The envelope will then proceed to Release 1 and continue through to the end of the envelope. See
EXAMPLE 1
.
2. If the Note Off occurs before the Sustain stage is reached, a Sustain
Pedal On will “jump” and hold the envelope in the Sustain stage at the current level until a Sustain Pedal Off occurs. The envelope will then proceed to Release 1 and continue through to the end of the envelope. See
EXAMPLE 2b
.
Key Release
: 1. If a Note Off event (assuming the Sustain Pedal is off) occurs while the envelope is in the Sustain stage, the envelope will proceed to
Release 1 stage and progress normally through the envelope to the end. See
EXAMPLE 1
again.
2. If a Note Off event (assuming Sustain Pedal is off) occurs before the envelope reaches the Sustain stage, the envelope will jump immediately to the Release 1 stage, at the current level, and proceed to the Release 2 level according to the time setting of the Release 1 stage. When the Release 2 stage is reached the envelope will proceed normally through to the end. See
EXAMPLE 2a
.
NORM 1, EXAMPLE 1
This is a
NORM 1
envelope with the
Note Off occurring after the
SUSTAIN
stage was reached.
Note that a Sustain Pedal On will also hold the envelope at the
SUSTAIN
level.
When a Note Off or Sustain Pedal Off occurs, the envelope will proceed into the
RELEASE 1
stage.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
145
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
NORM 1, EXAMPLE 2
This is a NORM 1 envelope with the
Note Off occurring during the
ATTACK
stage.
The envelope “jumps” to the
RELEASE
1
stage and proceeds into the
RELEASE
2
level.
EXAMPLE 2a
The gray lines in the illustration above indicate the envelope stages that are bypassed when a Note Off occurs before the
ATTACK
stage is complete.
After removing the bypassed stages from the graph, the envelope shape looks more like the one here on the right.
When a sustain pedal is used, a
Sustain Pedal On will “jump” to the
SUSTAIN
stage and hold at the Note Off level. When the Sustain Pedal is let go, the envelope will proceed into
RELEASE 1
.
As with Example 2a, the gray lines in the illustration above indicate the envelope stages that are bypassed.
After removing the bypassed stages from the graph, the envelope shape looks more like the one here on the left.
The duration of the
SUSTAIN
stage is as long as the sustain pedal is down.
EXAMPLE 2b
146 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
NORM 2
A
NORM 2
envelope is very similar to a
NORM 1
. The main difference is that a
NORM 2 envelope jumps to the Release 2 stage (instead of the Release 1 stage in NORM 1 ) if the key is let go before the Sustain stage is reached.
Start
:
Progress
:
The envelope is started by the beginning of a Note On event.
During the Note On, the envelope proceeds normally through Delay,
Attack, Decay 1, and Decay 2 stages to the Sustain stage.
Sustain
: 1. If the Note On is held until the Sustain stage is reached, the Note
On or a Sustain Pedal On will hold the envelope at the Sustain level until a Key Off and a Sustain Pedal off occur. The envelope will then proceed to Release 1 and continue through to the end of the envelope. (This is the same as NORM1 mode.) See
EXAMPLE 1
.
2. If the Note Off occurs before the Sustain stage is reached, a Sustain
Pedal On will “jump” and hold the envelope in the Sustain stage at the current level until a Sustain Pedal Off occurs. The envelope will then proceed to Release 2 and continue through to the end of the envelope. See
EXAMPLE 2b
(Note Off during ATTACK ) and
3b
(Note
Off during the
D1TIME
).
Key Release
: 1. If a Note Off event (assuming the Sustain Pedal is off) occurs while the envelope is in the Sustain stage, the envelope will proceed to
Release 1 stage and progress normally through the envelope to the end. See
EXAMPLE 1
again.
2. If a Note Off event (assuming Sustain Pedal is off) occurs before the envelope reaches the Sustain stage, the envelope will jump immediately to the Release 2 stage, at the current level, and proceed to 0 according to the its time setting.
See
EXAMPLE 2a
(Note Off during ATTACK ) and
3a
(Note Off during
D1TIME ).
NORM 2, EXAMPLE 1
This is a NORM 2 envelope with the
Note Off occurring after the
SUSTAIN
stage was reached.
Note that a Sustain Pedal On will also hold the envelope at the
SUSTAIN
level.
When a Note Off or Sustain Pedal Off occurs, the envelope will proceed into the
RELEASE 1
stage.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
147
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
NORM 2, EXAMPLE 2
This is a NORM 2 envelope with the
Note Off occurring during the
ATTACK
stage.
The envelope “jumps” directly to the
RELEASE 2
stage and proceeds to
0
.
EXAMPLE 2a
The gray lines in the illustration above indicate the envelope stages that are bypassed when a Note Off occurs before the
ATTACK
stage is complete.
After removing the bypassed stages from the graph, the envelope shape looks more like the one here on the right.
When a sustain pedal is used, a
Sustain Pedal On will “jump” to the
SUSTAIN
stage and hold at the Note Off level. When the Sustain Pedal is let go, the envelope will proceed into the
RELEASE 2
stage and proceed to
0
.
As with Example 2a, the gray lines in the illustration above indicate the envelope stages that are bypassed.
After removing the bypassed stages from the graph, the envelope shape looks more like the one here on the left.
The duration of the Sustain stage is as long as the sustain pedal is down.
EXAMPLE 2b
148 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
NORM 2, EXAMPLE 3
This is a
NORM 2
envelope with the
Note Off occurring during the
DECAY 1
stage.
The envelope “jumps” directly to the
RELEASE 2
stage and proceeds to 0 .
EXAMPLE 3a
The gray lines in the illustration above indicate the envelope stages that are bypassed when a Note Off occurs before the
DECAY 1
stage is complete.
After removing the bypassed stages from the graph, the envelope shape looks more like the one here on the right.
When a sustain pedal is used, a
Sustain Pedal On will “jump” to the
SUSTAIN
stage and hold at the Note Off level. When the Sustain Pedal is let go, the envelope will proceed into the
RELEASE 2
stage and proceed to 0 .
As with Example 3a, the gray lines in the illustration above indicate the envelope stages that are bypassed.
After removing the bypassed stages from the graph, the envelope shape looks more like the one here on the left.
The duration of the Sustain stage is as long as the sustain pedal is down.
EXAMPLE 3b
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
149
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
FRERUN
The
FRERUN
(“free-run”) envelope plays through its cycle even if the key or pedal is released before reaching the Sustain stage.
Start
:
Progress
Sustain
:
:
The envelope is started by the beginning of a Note On event.
Once the envelope has started, regardless of Note On or Sustain status, the envelope proceeds normally through Delay, Attack, Decay 1, and
Decay 2 stages to the Sustain stage.
If a Note On and/or a Sustain Pedal On is held when the Sustain stage is reached, the Note On and/or the Sustain Pedal On will hold at the
Sustain level until a Note Off and a Sustain Pedal Off occurs.
The envelope will then proceed to Release 1 and continue through to the end of the envelope.
Key Release
: 1. If a Note Off event (assuming the Sustain Pedal is Off) occurs while the envelope is in the Sustain stage, the envelope will proceed to
Release1 stage and progress normally through the envelope to the end.
2. If a Note Off event occurs before the envelope reaches the Sustain stage (and the Sustain Pedal is off), the envelope will proceed through all remaining stages just as if the key was still being pressed. The only difference in this situation is that the envelope will pass through the Sustain stage without stopping.
FRERUN EXAMPLE
In a
FRERUN
envelope, the envelope will proceed through all stages no matter when the Note Off occurs.
A Sustain Pedal On will hold the envelope at the
SUSTAIN
level as long as the pedal is down.
When a Sustain Pedal Off occurs, the envelope will proceed into the
RELEASE 1
stage.
SUSREL
The
SUSREL
(Sustain-Release) envelope mode merges Sustain and Release 1 stages.
Start
:
Progress
:
Sustain
:
The envelope is started by the beginning of a Note On event.
During the Note On, the envelope proceeds normally through Delay,
Attack, Decay 1, and Decay 2 stages to the Sustain stage.
While the envelope is “sustaining”, it will actually be transitioning from the Sustain level to the Release 2 level – the Sustain stage is effectively bypassed. When the Release 2 level is reached, the envelope will hold (“sustain”) at the Release 2 level if the Note On and/or
Sustain Pedal are still On. When a Note Off or Sustain Pedal Off occur, the envelope will then proceed to the Release 2 stage through to the end of the envelope.
1. If the Note On is held until the Sustain level is reached, the Note On or Sustain Pedal On will allow the envelope to transition to the
150 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
Release 2 level via the Sustain/Release 1 stage: a. if the Note On or Sustain Pedal On are held until the Release 2
Level is reached, the envelope will hold at that level until a Note
Off and/or a Sustain Pedal Off occur. The envelope will then proceed to the Release 2 stage and continue through to the end.
See
EXAMPLE 1
.
b. if the Note On and Sustain Pedal On are released before the
Release 2 Level is reached, the envelope will jump to the Release
2 stage (at the current level) and proceed to 0 within the time of the Release 2 Stage. See
EXAMPLE 2
.
2. If a Note Off occurs before the Sustain stage is reached, a Sustain
Pedal On will cause the envelope to jump to the Sustain/Release 1
Stage and begin the transition to the Release 2 level until a Sustain
Pedal Off occurs. The envelope will then transition to (if not already at) the Release 2 stage time (at the current level) and proceed to 0 within the time of the Release 2 Stage. See
EXAMPLE 3b
(Note
Off/Pedal On during D2TIME ) and
EXAMPLE 4
(Note Off/Pedal On during
D1TIME
, Pedal Off during
SUSREL
).
Key Release
: 1. If a Note Off event (assuming that Sustain Pedal is Off) occurs
while
the envelope is in the Sustain/Release 1 stage, the envelope will jump to the Release 2 stage and continue through to the end.
See
EXAMPLE 2
again.
2. If a Note Off event (assuming that Sustain Pedal is Off) occurs
before
the envelope reaches the Sustain/Release1 stage, the envelope will jump immediately to the Release 2 stage (at current level) and proceed to 0 according to the time setting of the Release 2
Stage. See
EXAMPLE 3a
(Note Off during
D2TIME
).
SUSREL, EXAMPLE 1
This is a
SUSREL
envelope with the
Note Off occurring after the
RELEASE 2
stage was reached.
Note that a Sustain Pedal On will also maintain the transition through the
SUSREL stage and remain at the
RELEASE 2
level until a Note Off or
Pedal Off occurs.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
151
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
SUSREL, EXAMPLE 2
This is a
SUSREL
envelope with the
Note Off occurring during the SUSREL stage, but before the
RELEASE 2
stage was reached.
The key concept to note here is that a
Note Off or Pedal Off occurring during the
SUSREL
stage causes the envelope to jump directly to the
RELEASE 2
stage.
SUSREL, EXAMPLE 3
EXAMPLE 3a
This is a
SUSREL
envelope with the
Note Off occurring during the
DECAY 2
stage. The envelope jumps directly to the
RELEASE 2
stage and proceeds to 0 .
The gray lines in the illustration above indicate the envelope stages that are bypassed when a Note Off occurs before the
DECAY 2
stage is complete.
After removing the bypassed stages from the graph, the envelope shape looks more like the one here on the right.
EXAMPLE 3b
If a Sustain Pedal On occurs during
DECAY 2
, the envelope will jump to the
SUSREL
stage and begin the transition into the
RELEASE 2
stage.
152 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
SUSREL, EXAMPLE 4
This is a SUSREL envelope with the
Note Off occurring during the
DECAY 1
stage.
If a Sustain Pedal On occurs, the envelope “jumps” to the SUSREL stage and proceeds into
RELEASE 2
. If the
Sustain Pedal Off occurs during the
SUSREL
stage, the envelope will jump to
RELEASE 2
for its final decay to 0 .
The gray lines in the illustration above indicate the envelope stages that are bypassed when a Note Off occurs before the
DECAY 1
stage is complete.
After removing the bypassed stages from the graph, the envelope shape looks more like the one here on the right.
MODTRG
The MODTRG (“modulation trigger”) envelope mode is very similar in function to
FRERUN
, except that the envelope is triggered by a user selectable modulation
source
instead of the keyboard or other “note source” (the A6’s Sequencer,
Arpeggiator, or a received MIDI Note).
Start
:
Progress
Sustain
:
:
The envelope is started by an On level from the selected modulation source.
once the envelope is started, regardless of Modulation Input or Sustain status (key held down or the Sustain Pedal is down), the envelope will proceed normally through Delay, Attack, Decay 1, and Decay 2 stages
(subject to modulation, Retriggering, Looping, etc… ) to the
SUSTAIN
Stage.
If the Sustain Pedal is down when the
SUSTAIN
Stage is reached, the pedal will hold at the SUSTAIN Level until the pedal is let go.
Afterwards, the envelope will proceed to
RELEASE 1
and continue through to the end of the envelope.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
153
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
MOD-TG
The
MOD-TG
(“modulation trigger-gate”) envelope mode is very similar in function to the NORM 1 mode, except that the envelope is triggered by a user selectable modulation input instead of the keyboard.
Start
:
Progress
:
The envelope is started by an On level from the selected modulation source.
During the Modulation Source On, the envelope proceeds normally through Delay, Attack, Decay1, and Decay2 stages to the Sustain stage.
Sustain
: 1. If the Modulation Source On signal continues until the Sustain stage is reached, the Modulation Source On or SUSTAIN PEDAL
ON will HOLD at the SUSTAIN Level until Modulation Input
OFF and SUSTAIN PEDAL OFF, afterwards, the envelope will proceed to RELEASE1 and continue through to the end of the envelope.
2. If Modulation Input OFF occurs before the SUSTAIN Stage is reached, SUSTAIN PEDAL ON will "jump" and HOLD the envelope in the Sustain Stage at the Current Level until SUSTAIN
PEDAL OFF, afterwards, the envelope will proceed to RELEASE1 and continue through to the end.
Gate
(Release): 1. If a Modulation Input OFF (assuming Sustain Pedal is OFF) event occurs while the envelope is in the SUSTAIN stage, the envelope will proceed to RELEASE1 Stage and progress normally through the envelope to the end.
2. If a Modulation Input OFF (assuming Sustain Pedal is OFF) event occurs before the envelope reaches the SUSTAIN stage, the envelope will "jump" immediately to the RELEASE1 stage time
(at current level) and proceed to the Release2 Level within the time of the Release1 Stage. When the RELEASE2 stage is reached the envelope will proceed normally through to the end.
Envelope Trigger Examples
When a MOD-TRIG or MOD-TRIG/GATE is selected in the MODE parameter, the three
Trigger and four Re-Trigger parameters become available. These parameters are used to configure the triggering (and re-triggering) of the envelope.
In the following seven examples, we illustrate the interaction among the trigger
SOURCE
,
LEVEL
, and
POLAR
parameters. When using the Re-Trigger function, know that these parameters are identical to their Trigger counterparts. The Re-Trigger function contains a fourth parameter,
STAGE
(Re-Trigger Stage) which simply tells the envelope at what stage to start when re-triggered.
For simplicity, we’ll use a TRIGGER/SOURCE of LFO1 for all seven examples. LFO1 will be producing a simple sine wave with a frequency of about 20Hz. We’ll also use a
LEVEL
value of
+75
for the examples, with the exception of
EXAMPLE 4
that assigns a
LEVEL
value of
-45
, just so you can see how a negative Level value affects the point at which a trigger is generated.
The main differences among the examples exist in the TRIGGER/POLAR setting so that you can see the effect of the six Polarity types. Each of the examples has a different Polarity selected, with the exception of
EXAMPLE 4
that has a positive polarity like
EXAMPLE 1
but has a negative Level setting.
154 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
How Modulation Triggering Works
When a modulation source is selected to trigger an envelope, the envelope ignores
Note On messages (the keyboard, MIDI Notes, and so forth) and instead looks at the selected mod source for its trigger signal. In the examples below, we chose LFO 1 but the trig source can be another envelope, the Pitch Wheel, a foot switch and so on.
Before triggering takes place, the envelope “looks” at the mod source – in this case
LFO 1 – for certain conditions that generate the trigger. When these conditions have been met, the trigger occurs and the envelope plays.
In
EXAMPLE 1
, the “conditions to be met” are: 1. the LFO must reach a level on its cycle of 75 (
LEVEL
value of
75
) and 2. when this level of 75 is reached, the LFO must be “moving in a positive direction” or rising in level ( POLAR setting of POSITIVE) .
Notice that the trigger is generated on the LFO’s “up slope” when it reaches a level of
75.
In
EXAMPLE 2
, the same LFO and level setting of 75 are used but this time the envelope will look for the LFO to be “moving in a negative direction” or falling in level (
POLAR
setting of
NEGATIVE
). The trigger is generated on the LFO’s “down slope” when it reaches a level of 75.
In
EXAMPLE 3
, polarity is set to BIPOLAR or bi-directional. This means that triggers are generated whenever the LFO’s level = 75 no matter what direction the slope is going.
In the examples, take particular note of the shaded areas of the graphs. The light areas indicate that the trigger is on and the dark areas indicate that the trigger is off.
EXAMPLE 1
User Parameters:
Trigger In Level =
75
Trigger Polarity =
POSITIVE
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
155
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
EXAMPLE 2
User Parameters:
Trigger In Level =
75
Trigger Polarity =
NEGATIVE
EXAMPLE 3
User Parameters:
Trigger In Level =
75
Trigger Polarity =
BIPOLAR
EXAMPLE 4
User Parameters:
Trigger In Level =
-45
Trigger Polarity =
POSITIVE
156 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
In
EXAMPLEs 5
,
6
and
7
, the envelope looks at the LFO for absolute values: positive or negative attributes are ignored – just the level of 75 is used.
EXAMPLE 5
User Parameters:
Trigger In Level =
75
Trigger Polarity =
ABS
BIPOLAR
EXAMPLE 6
User Parameters:
Trigger In Level =
75
Trigger Polarity =
ABS
POSITIVE
EXAMPLE 7
User Parameters:
Trigger In Level =
75
Trigger Polarity =
ABS
NEGATIVE
RETRIG Page
The parameters of the
RETRIG
page are identical to those of the
TRIG
page.
RETRIG
, however, adds an additional parameter called STAGE .
When re-triggering an envelope, you have the added ability to determine at what stage in the envelope’s cycle where re-triggering takes place. By contrast, the first trigger that an envelope receives ( TRIG parameters) always starts at the DELAY stage.
You use soft knob
5
to select the desired stage. When re-triggered, the envelope will start at the beginning of the selected stage:
DEL DELAY stage
ATK ATTACK stage
D1 D1TIME
(
DECAY 1
) stage
D2 D2TIME (
DECAY 2
) stage
SUS SUSTAIN level; note that sustain will be by-passed if the key or sustain
R1 pedal is not down.
R1TIME (
RELEASE
1) stage
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
157
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
DISPLAY
PAGE
DYN
DYN Page Parameters
The DYN or Dynamics functions permit you to modulate certain parameters of an envelope “live” or as you are playing the A6. To use a current computer phrase, we could say that dynamics are performance parameters that happen “in real time.”
Parameters in this page deal with how the envelope is affected by the way notes are played or if a sustain pedal is used. When a parameter is modulated dynamically, we mean that the modulations occur as you are playing and depend, to a large degree, on how you are playing. For example, if the
RESET
parameter is set to
LEGATO
, legato playing will affect the envelope behavior differently than staccato playing.
Employing the VELMOD parameter allows you to control the output level of the envelope by velocity – how hard or soft you’re playing.
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
RESET
DYNAMICS
Button
SUSPDL
Sustain Pedal
Control
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
Each envelope is assigned to a particular voice. Once an envelope begins its cycle, this parameter determines what the envelope should do if its voice plays a new note before
the cycle is completed
.
NORMAL
If the voice plays a new note while the envelope is in progress...
... the envelope will always restart its cycle from the beginning. In other words, the envelope is “reset”.
LEGATO
RE-ASSIGN
... the envelope will continue from its present
stage and level
with the new note. Legato playing is the most common way for this to occur. If, however, you begin playing staccato, the envelope will reset as in NORMAL mode.
…the envelope will behave as in Legato mode, with the exception that if the voice is being reassigned from a different Program in a Mix, it will continue on from the present stage according to the new Program's envelope.
ANALOG …the envelope will retrigger if it's a new note, but won't retrigger if it's the same note.
OFF, ON Turns Sustain Pedal control on and off for the envelope. If the envelope reaches the SUSTAIN stage and this parameter is
ON
, holding the sustain pedal down will hold the envelope in its Sustain stage. When the pedal is let go, the envelope proceeds to the Release stages.
158 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
DISPLAY
PAGE
DYN
Continued
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
KEYTRK
Key Tracking
—
—
—
—
KTBASE
Key Tracking
Base Note
LVLTRK
Level Tracking
VELMOD
Level Velocity
Modulation
RELMOD
Release 2
Modulation
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
-100 ··· +100 Key Tracking allows you to dynamically alter the time settings of the selected envelope’s stages (except Delay and Attack) by the Note
Number that triggered this envelope.
When positive settings are used, the high notes add time to D1, D2, R1 and R2 time settings, making the envelope take longer to complete. Low notes subtract from these time settings. The note that determines the midpoint is the KTBASE parameter, next.
C0 ··· G10 This parameter sets the midpoint between the range of notes where adding time to the envelope and subtracting time occurs.
This parameter spans the entire range of MIDI notes from C0 to G10.
-100 ··· +100
This parameter allows you to dynamically alter the LEVEL setting – the overall output level – of the selected envelope by the Note
Number that triggered this envelope.
A setting of
0%
means no modulation.
-100 ··· +100
This parameter allows you to dynamically alter the LEVEL setting – the overall output level – of the selected envelope by the Velocity of the key that triggered this envelope.
A setting of 0% means no modulation.
-100 ··· +100
This parameter allows you to dynamically alter the Release2 TIME setting of the selected envelope by the Note Number that triggered this envelope. See examples below.
Key Tracking and RELMOD Release 2 Modulation
The TIME and RELMOD parameters modulate the stage time settings (as set in the
TIME
page) by the Note Number that triggered the envelope. If you refer back to page 54 when we covered Keyboard Properties, each key of the A6’s keyboard as well as any received MIDI Note is assigned a number. This number is used by the A6 to determine what musical note or notes to play.
The KEYTRK Key Tracking setting affects Decay 1, Decay 2, Release 1 and Release 2 stage times. The
RELMOD
Release 2 Mod setting affects Release 2 only. For our discussion, let’s use Middle C (C5) as the KTBASE note.
At Middle C, the selected envelope’s stages are not affected and will proceed according to the times as set in the
TIME
page. Consider Middle C (or any other note selected as the KTBASE ) as the “neutral note”.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
159
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
Positive Values
: If
KEYTRK
and
RELMOD
are set to
100
, the envelope stage times will double in speed with each octave above Middle C, and halve in speed with each octave below Middle C.
Negative Values
: If KEYTRK and RELMOD are set to -100 , the envelope will double in speed with each octave below Middle C, and halve in speed with each octave above
Middle C. Negative values have reverse effect of positive settings.
LOOP Page Parameters
Each of the three envelopes has the ability to loop – repeat selected stages over and over. The parameters in the Loop page allow you specify how the loop behaves:
• When it starts: as the envelope proceeds through its stages – according to the settings in the TIME , LEVEL , TRIG and DYN pages – you select the stage of the envelope when looping starts. As an example, you can set the envelope to start looping when the
DECAY 2
stage is complete, as shown in the illustration below.
• Where it starts looping: once the loop is instructed to start, you specify the stage of the envelope where the loop begins. As an example, you can set the loop’s start point to be the
ATTACK
stage, as shown in the illustration below.
• How the looping continues: you can instruct the loop to repeat a specific number of times (from 1 to 240), repeat until you release the key (or a MIDI
Note Off is received), repeat as long as the Sustain Pedal is down, or cycle infinitely.
LOOP
SMOOTH
TIME
SUSTAIN LEVEL
LOOP
START
LOOP
END
MINIMUM
LEVEL
DELAY
TIME
ATTACK
TIME
TIME
LOOP
DECAY 1
TIME
DECAY 2
TIME
SUSTAIN STAGE RELEASE 1 TIME RELEASE 2 TIME
This example shows the loop path for the following parameters:
Loop
END
Loop START
SMOOTH
Time
SSHAPE
=
DECAY 2
= ATTACK
= user selectable, shown above as about 2/3 of the Attack time.
=
LINEAR
Envelope looping simply instructs an envelope to repeat a certain stage or stages.
You can set up a loop to repeat only one stage – for example
DECAY 1
– or up to all available stages –
DELAY
through
RELEASE 1
. The keywords here are available stages:
RELEASE 2
cannot be selected as a loop end stage.
In the following table of loop parameter descriptions, it’s important to understand
160 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
DISPLAY
PAGE
LOOP how we use the the term stage. It refers to the same envelope parameters as before, but when describing the loop start function, the loop starts at the beginning of the selected stage only. For example, you cannot start a loop during the Attack stage’s rise time, only at the point where the Attack stage starts.
By the same token, for a loop’s end functions, the loop finishes at the completion of the last stage before the loop end stage. For example, you cannot end a loop at some point during the Decay 2 stage’s fall time, only at the point where the Decay 2 stage is completed.
PANEL LABEL
LOOP
button
—
—
—
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
As you select and adjust the Loop parameters below, note how the display changes to reflect your settings. The box will change size and position with new
START
and
END
points and will display a representation of the selected curve.
START DEL Delay This parameter is used to select the stage in the envelope where the loop begins.
ATK Attack
D1 Decay 1
D2 Decay 2
SUS Sustain
The loop will cycle through the envelope’s stages that are between what you select as the
START
and
END
stages. For example, if you set the
START
stage to be
ATK
and the
END
stage to be D2 , the envelope will repeat
ATK
→
D1
→
D2
END
COUNT
The number times the loop cycles or repeats is selected by the COUNT parameter, described on the next page.
ATK Attack
D1 Decay 1
This parameter actually performs two functions:
D2 Decay 2
SUS Sustain
1. As its name implies, this is the stage in the envelope where the loop ends. If the loop repeats, this is also the stage where the
loop returns
to the loop’s
START
stage.
R1 Release 1
2. This is also the stage in the envelope where the loop gets its initial instruction
to start looping
and begins a smoothed transition to the Loop Start stage. The transition is an amount of time that is set by the
SMOOTH
and
SSHAPE
parameters.
So when setting this parameter, keep in mind that this is the stage in the envelope where the loop receives both its command to start and its command to return to the first stage in the loop after each loop cycle.
This parameter determines how many times the selected envelope will loop.
1 ··· 240 This selects a specific number of loop cycles up to 240. After the last cycle is completed, the envelope is released.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
161
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
DISPLAY
PAGE
LOOP
Continued
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
—
COUNT
Continued
—
—
TYPE
SMOOTH
Smooth Time
SSHAPE
Smooth Shape
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
SUSTAIN The loop will continue to cycle until the key is let go (or the A6 receives a MIDI Note Off). If you’re using a sustain pedal, the loop will cycle as long as the pedal is down.
INFINITE
The loop will cycle infinitely. There are, however, differences between infinite looping of
ENV 3
and
ENV
s
1
and
2
.
ENV 3
, which is dedicated to the amplitude of the voice, will literally loop forever or until you change to another Program or power the A6 off.
If
ENV 1
and
ENV 2
are set to an infinite loop, they will loop until the Release 2 time of
ENV 3
reaches its 0 level.
This parameter determines how the loop cycles.
FORWARD The loop cycles normally in a forward direction. Smoothing and Count settings will be in effect.
REVERSE The loop cycles backward through the stages.
Smoothing and Count settings will be in effect.
ROKROL “Rock-n-Roll”: The loop cycles backward and forward through the stages. Count settings will be in effect but Smoothing is ignored as it is not needed.
2 M ···
131.05 S
When a loop repeats, it is quite possible that the level of the start stage will be different than the level of end stage. This may cause the envelope to sound uneven or choppy each time the loop cycle starts over.
While this may be desirable in some cases (just set SMOOTH to 0 ), you can adjust the transition into the level of the start stage to be gradual, accomplished by a function called smoothing.
This parameter sets the amount of time smoothing will take where
0
is instantly and
65535 is maximum, approximately 32 seconds.
LINEAR
EXP 1, 2
&
3
Selects the slope that the Smooth Time will follow during the smoothing transition.
LOG 1, 2
&
3
These curves are the same as the envelopes’
Stage Slopes – see page 139.
SCURV1
&
2
162 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
Some Important Notes About Envelope Looping
• You can think of the Smooth parameter as another envelope “stage”. It has Time
(the
SMOOTH
parameter) and Slope (the
SSHAPE
parameter) properties just like the other stages. Just keep in mind that smoothing is used strictly for the purpose of linking two of the standard stages in order to form a loop. If SMOOTH is set to 2 M , the Smoothing “stage” executes so quickly, it has the effect of linking the selected
START
and
END
stages to each other directly.
But you should keep in mind that if the levels of the
START
and
END
stages are different – as they are likely to be – you may hear a jump in levels every time the loop cycles back to the
START
stage.
• When adjusting loop points, if a loop END value is selected that would be equal to
or before
the loop START , the loop START will continue to step back to accommodate the new loop end. The same would be true of adjusting the loop
START to be equal or greater than the END point.
• An envelope will start looping at the beginning of the stage you select for the END parameter. As an example, if
D2
is selected in the
END
parameter, the envelope starts looping the moment D2 starts. Another way of looking at this is that the envelope starts looping the moment
D1
ends. Either way, once the envelope starts looping, the remaining stages will not be available until looping is completed as set by the COUNT parameter.
So when selecting
START
and
END
stages, the setting of the envelope’s
MODE
on the
TRIG page (see the description on page 144) must be taken into consideration.
Using the example above, if NORM 1 is the mode, the envelope will transition to
RELEASE 1
when the loop ends, bypassing the
D2
and
SUSTAIN
. This is identical to the response of
NORM 1
mode when playing the keyboard: if a key is released prior to the SUSTAIN stage, the envelope transitions immediately to R1 .
If the mode is set to FRERUN , the envelope proceeds through the remaining stages when looping ends. This is identical to the response of
FRERUN
mode when playing the keyboard: if a key is released prior to the SUSTAIN stage, the envelope proceeds through the remaining stages.
• If you select
R1
to be the Loop
END
stage, the envelope will not begin looping
until the Sustain portion of the envelope is complete
. Since an envelope’s Sustain stage ends when a Note Off occurs, the envelope will not start looping until it gets a Note Off.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
163
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
MOD Pages
In addition to the modifications offered by the TRIG and DYN pages, each envelope can be modulated by any of the A6’s 71 mod sources. In fact, three separate mod paths can be created per envelope from the three MOD 1 , MOD 2 and MOD 3 pages. This provides outstanding versatility in customizing the envelopes to a particular need.
MOD 1
,
MOD 2
and
MOD 3
are identical, so the following table applies to all three:
PAGE
MOD 1
MOD 2
MOD 3
PARAMETER
SOURCE
LEVEL
OFFSET
ENABLE
DEST
Destination
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
Any of the A6’s 71 modulation sources.
See Appendix B.
Use soft knob
1
to scroll through the list of possible modulation sources.
-100 ··· +100 This parameter sets the amount of modulation that will affect the selected destination. Keep in mind that negative values invert the action of the selected source. For example, if Velocity is the source and a negative value for
LEVEL
is used, playing harder will reduce the level of the destination.
-100 ··· +100 This parameter sets the offset or fine adjustment for the selected modulation level.
OFF, ON
This parameter is used to turn the selected modulation on or off. Use soft knob
5
or the panel buttons along the upper edge of the
ENV 1
,
ENV 2
and
ENV 3
sections.
DELAY TIME
ATTACK TIME
DECAY 1 TIME
DECAY 2 TIME
REL 1 TIME
REL 2 TIME
ENV LEVEL
SUS LEVEL
Use soft knob
2
to scroll through the list of possible modulation destinations. These destinations are eight envelope parameters described earlier in this Chapter.
164 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
E
NVELOPE
E
XAMPLES
Now that we’ve covered envelope functions in detail, let’s take a look at a few envelopes that can be created in the A6. The envelope depicted on page 135 represents the most basic envelope contour: all stages are used, they’re all linear and all levels have positive values.
The following five examples are just a few of the endless variations that can be accomplished on the A6, but illustrate the flexibility of these powerful modulations.
EXAMPLE 1: BI-POLAR
DELAY Time
ATTACK
Time
Attack SHAPE
D1TIME
Decay1
SHAPE
D2LEVL
D2TIME
Decay2
SHAPE
SUSTAIN Level
R1TIME
Release1
SHAPE
R2LEVL
R2TIME
Release2
SHAPE
Envelope OFFSET 0
Envelope LEVEL 100
Envelope
POLAR
POSWAV
5.99 S
16.50 S
EXP `1
15.90 S
LINEAR
-45
7.95 S
LOG 2
25
12.50 S
LINEAR
9
16.06 S
EXP 1
Bi-Polar envelopes like this one are only available for
ENV1
and
ENV2
. Also, this envelope can be inverted by switching
POLAR
from
POSWAV
to
NEGWAV
.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
165
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
EXAMPLE 2: BI-POLAR with OFFSET plus LEVEL Changes
166
DELAY
Time
ATTACK
Time
Attack SHAPE
D1TIME
Decay1
SHAPE
D2LEVL
D2TIME
Decay2
SHAPE
SUSTAIN Level
R1TIME
Release1
SHAPE
R2LEVL
R2TIME
Release2
SHAPE
Envelope OFFSET
Envelope
LEVEL
Envelope
POLAR
OFF
(no Delay stage)
4.82 S
LOG 1
2.34 S
EXP 2
Set to
79 but is effectively
60 after adjusting for Offset
4.50 S
EXP 1
23
2.92 S
LINEAR
Set to
72 but is effectively
50 after adjusting for Offset
3.92 S
LOG 1
-35
100
POSWAV
This example shows the relationship between the Offset and the envelope’s Attack and Release2 stages. Notice that the envelope will always begin from the “0-plus-
Offset” level. Likewise, Release 2 will always end at the same level where the
envelope started
. In this example, Offset is -35, shifting the envelope downward.
Thus the envelope starts below 0 and rises from there during Attack.
This example also shows how the envelope’s Level is used to increase the amplitude of the envelope when Offset is used. Since the Offset is set to -35 and the envelope
Level is set to
100
, the Attack Stage actually reaches its maximum point at
+65
, and no stages above the 0 line can exceed that value.
The stage Levels do not behave exactly as they appear in the illustration. This is because the envelope Level is set to 100 and the Offset to -35 . For example, Decay 2
Level is set to
79
(more than 3/4 between 0 and the maximum). But because it is
Offset by
-35
and amplified by
100
the the resulting level (internally calculated) is about 60 where it appears in the illustration.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
EXAMPLE 3: BI-POLAR with Output LEVEL Clipping and RELEASE HOLD
DELAY Time
ATTACK Time
Attack SHAPE
D1TIME
Decay1 SHAPE
D2LEVL
D2TIME
Decay2 SHAPE
SUSTAIN Level
R1TIME
Release1 SHAPE
R2LEVL
R2TIME
Release2 SHAPE
Envelope OFFSET +50
Envelope LEVEL 100
Envelope POLAR POSWAV
OFF
(no Delay stage)
8.67 S
LINEAR
7.58 S
LOG 1
Set to
0 but is effectively
60 after adjusting for Offset
3.70 S
LINEAR
Set to
-59 but is effectively
-9 after adjusting for Offset
2.92 S
EXPO 2
Set to
-100 but is effectively
-50 after adjusting for Offset
131.07 S
(Maximum, causing the
HOLD
LED to light.)
Can be set to anything but is ignored
This example shows another relationship between the Offset and the envelope Level.
Since the envelope Level is set to
100
, the level from the start of the envelope to the maximum Output Level is 100 . After the Offset is adjusted to +50 , this pushes the top half of the Attack segment beyond the maximum Output Level. The envelope levels are calculated beyond the maximum, but are clipped at the maximum.
The HOLD function for the Release stage is also shown here. When the R2TIME is set to its maximum value, it is set to
HOLD
mode. In this mode, when the envelope reaches the Release2 Level, it holds at that Level infinitely until the Voice is released.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
167
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
EXAMPLE 4: Classic “ADSR” – Positive Amplitude Envelope with Bypassed Stages
168
DELAY
Time
ATTACK
Time
Attack SHAPE
D1TIME
Decay1
SHAPE
D2LEVL
D2TIME
Decay2
SHAPE
SUSTAIN Level
R1TIME
Release1
SHAPE
R2LEVL
R2TIME
Release2
SHAPE
Envelope OFFSET
Envelope
LEVEL
Envelope
POLAR
OFF
(no Delay stage)
2.60 S
LOG 3
Set to
0 which bypasses this stage
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
1.46 S
LOG 1
Set to 75 but is effectively -9 after scaling
Set to
0 which bypasses this stage
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
3.29 S
LOG 2
0
100
POSWAV
This example illustrates bypassing stages to create new envelope functionality.
Notice that Decay2 Level and Release2 Level are ignored. This is because Attack always rises to the maximum Output Level – set by the
LEVEL
parameter in the
LEVEL page – at which time the envelope decays (via Decay2 Time) to the next stage level Sustain.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
EXAMPLE 5: A(S)R – Positive Amplitude Envelope with Additional Bypassed Stages
DELAY Time
ATTACK
Time
Attack SHAPE
D1TIME
Decay1
SHAPE
D2LEVL
D2TIME
Decay2
SHAPE
SUSTAIN Level
R1TIME
Release1
SHAPE
R2LEVL
R2TIME
Release2
SHAPE
Envelope OFFSET
Envelope LEVEL
Envelope
POLAR
OFF (no Delay stage)
3.20 S
LOG 3
Set to 0 which bypasses this stage
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
Set to 0 which bypasses this stage
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
Bypassed: superceded by the ATTACK stage
Set to 0 which bypasses this stage
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
Bypassed: can be set to anything but is ignored
2.50 S
LOG 2
0
100
POSWAV
This example shows the functionality of an A(S)R envelope. As always, the Attack stage rises to maximum, and proceeds to the next available Decay stage. In this case, since
D1TIME
and
D2TIME
are set to
0
, the “next available Decay stage” does not exist, and the envelope proceeds to the Sustain stage.
As the Sustain stage is encountered, maximum level is held if a key is being held down or a sustain pedal is depressed. When the key or pedal is let go, the envelope proceeds from its current level (maximum, in this case) to Release2. Because Release2 is our exit stage and always decays to zero (plus Offset, if any), this functions exactly as an A(S)R envelope.
With this same method, a simple Attack/HOLD envelope could be created by setting the Release2 Time to
HOLD
(maximum).
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
169
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
170 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
C
HAPTER
7
P
ROGRAM
F
UNCTIONS
P
ART
3:
LFO
S
, S
AMPLE
& H
OLD AND
P
ROCESS
L
OW
F
REQUENCY
O
SCILLATORS
As mentioned earlier in this manual, a Low Frequency
Oscillator (LFO) primarily provides periodic (repeating pattern) modulation to its assigned destination. But an
LFO can also produce aperiodic (non-repeating) modulation based on a randomly-generated waveform and a noise source.
Although they are somewhat similar in design to the
VCOs, LFOs are not intended to be used as audio sources.
Therefore, their outputs are not routed to any of the A6’s audio paths. Instead, LFOs are routed to other elements of the sound as a mod source, so while you can’t hear them directly, you can hear their effect on other elements of the sound in a modulation path.
In addition, the description of LFO waves bear a striking resemblance to VCO waves. So you may notice that you’ve seen many of this chapter's diagrams in previous parts of the manual. This is not a deja vú, and we’ll try to keep the confusion to a minimum.
The most common use of an LFO is for vibrato (VCO frequency or pitch modulation). The mod wheel on the A6 is a perfect example of this as it controls the amplitude
(amount) of an LFO that is routed to the frequency of the
VCOs. An LFO is often routed to modulate the filter frequency (harmonic modulation) or the any of the amplifiers in the audio path (amplitude modulation, or tremolo): the
PRE FILTER MIX
,
POST FILTER MIX
or the
VOICE
MIX
stages.
The LFO section of the A6 also contains a special aperiodic mod source called sample-and-hold –
S & H
on the front panel – which we’ll get into shortly.
LFO P
ARAMETER
D
ESCRIPTIONS
The parameters of the LFOs are described below.
Parameters marked with a
✿
are also mod destinations – they can be modulated by another source. You can experiment with any of the parameters by pressing the
VIEW
button or turning the
RATE
knob on any of the three
LFOs. Then use the soft knobs and buttons below the display to select a specific parameter.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
171
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
Tip
: Tabbing feature: You can select any parameter simply by turning its corresponding soft knob, but this action also changes the parameter’s value which isn’t always desirable. If you just want to review the current settings of the LFO parameters without changing anything, you can select a parameter without changing its value by pressing its page’s soft button. For LFO pages (like the
Envelopes) pressing a soft button once selects the page, pressing it again selects the parameter to the right of the active parameter in the Parameter Row.
Repeated pressings cycle though all parameters from left to right.
WAVE Page
➠ RATE
Frequency Select
The speed of the LFO is set with this parameter. This is another LFO parameter that you will use often.
Range: .0076Hz – 25 Hz (131.6 seconds per cycle – 40 milliseconds per cycle)
BASIC LFO WAVESHAPES
SHAPE
Shape Select
Of the nine LFO parameters, the Shape select is one of the parameters you’ll use most often when editing an LFO. You have the option of selecting from among four periodic waves (sine, triangle, square/pulse and sawtooth) and two aperiodic waves (random and noise).
When depicted graphically, these waveforms appear very much like their names imply, and you select a particular waveform based on the type of modulation required.
SINE and TRI
The sine wave produces a smooth rise and fall which is well-suited for most vibrato applications. The triangle has a similar smooth rise and fall but with a sharp ”peak” (on the positive side of the wave) and sharp “trough” (on the negative side). Triangle waves are also adequate for vibrato, especially at low amplitude settings where the effect of sharp peaks and troughs aren’t as noticeable.
SAW
The sawtooth wave combines the characteristics of the triangle and pulse waves. An "up" or positive sawtooth wave has a smooth rise with a sharp peak that immediately drops and starts its rise cycle again. A "down" or negative sawtooth falls, then immediately rises up to the start level. Unlike the oscillators which have positive/negative sawtooth waves to select from, in the LFOs the up/down characteristic of the wave is set by the PWIDTH parameter explained on the next page.
PULSE
In contrast, the pulse wave is characterized by abrupt or instantaneous rise and fall, producing a “push-pull” or “high-low” effect. When its width is set to a square wave (50%) and routed to the VCOs, for example, it is well-suited for trills. Careful adjustments to its amplitude actually allow you to “tune” the wave’s high-low movement to specific musical intervals.
RANDOM
or
NOISE
The random wave can be characterized as a wave that sounds like it’s jumping all over the place, especially at high amplitude levels. The noise wave is an “ultra-random” wave that has a much higher frequency than the random wave, sounding like hiss.
172 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
0º
➠ DELAY
Delay Time
This parameter sets time that elapses before the LFO begins its oscillation. During this time delay, the LFO is inactive.
Range: 0 – 131.075 seconds, adjustable in increments of 2 to 10 milliseconds.
➠ PHASE
Initial Phase
This parameter sets the initial phase portion where the LFO waveform starts. Here’s how an LFO’s wave phase is described and adjusted:
One cycle of an LFO’s wave equals a 360º “phase” (cycle). Under normal circumstances, an LFO’s wave will rise at the start of its oscillation (the initial phase) at the neutral point of 0º. This parameter allows you to instruct the A6 to start the LFO – its initial phase – at later points of the waveform. For example, if you wanted to start at the peak of the wave, set this to 90 degrees.
Range: 0.00 – 360.00 degrees in increments of .01.
SINE WAVE
Initial Phase = 0º Initial Phase = 60º Initial Phase = 90º Initial Phase = 270º
45º
90º
180º
270º
359º
➠ PWIDTH
Wave Width
You can alter the width of the triangle and pulse waves which allows for variations in the way these waveshape rise and fall. A width adjustment alters the duty cycle – the positive portion of the wave – relative to the negative side and gives the wave a significantly different property when modulating a destination.
Range: 0.00 – 100.00% in increments of .01%
Pulse wave with adjustment range:
50% duty cycle (square wave) to 5% (narrow pulse)
Triangle wave width adjustment range:
100% duty cycle produces an UpSaw wave, 50% duty cycle produces a symmetric or triangle wave, 0% duty cycle produces an DownSaw wave.
If the wave type is SAW , below 50% produces a DownSaw, above 50% an UpSaw.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
173
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
➠ OFFSET
DC Offset
This parameter allows you to shift (“offset”) the zero amplitude reference for the
LFO wave. This means that, as depicted in the graphs below, you can move the zero line – the point of a wave where it is neither positive or negative – up or down. This is the equivalent of adding a fixed direct current voltage to an alternating wave.
This parameter gives you the ability to add a pitch bend to a vibrato (if the LFO is modulating an oscillator) or add a volume increase to a tremolo (if the LFO is modulating a VCA).
Range: -100.00 – +100.00 in increments of .01
➠ LEVEL
Amplitude Select
This is the initial amplitude of the LFO. The term
initial is used because this parameter can be modulated by another mod source. Therefore, this parameter sets the LFO’s amplitude before modulation occurs, if any. If no mod source is routed to this parameter, its initial level is also its final level. (Note in the illustration at right that levels above 50 produce clipping.)
Range: 0 – 100.00 in increments of .01.
Note that the LEVEL of the LFO itself and the LEVEL on a receiver's MOD page are separate, and interact with each other. Think of this as the "send" and the level on the oscillator or filter as the "receive".
➠ POLAR
Polarity
Where the DC Offset parameter (OFFSET, above) allows you to shift the zero amplitude reference for the LFO wave, this parameter defines which side of zero the wave will stay on. It simply sets the LFO's polarity – does it produce a positive voltage, a negative one or both?
BI-POL
-POS-
-NEG-
= center zero: this is a standard “bi-polar” wave – the LFO’s voltage oscillates both positively and negatively around the zero reference
= positive: LFO voltage oscillates above the zero reference only
= negative: LFO voltage oscillates below the zero reference only
174 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
TRIG Page
As important as how an LFO operates is when it begins to oscillate. It is usually assumed that an LFO starts when a key is played or MIDI Note is received, or at the end of the Delay stage. All three of these scenarios are correct, but more accurately, it is the trigger that originates from the keyboard or MIDI that starts the LFOs’ oscillation. This page allows you to do more than that.
The
TRIG
page in the LFO section is mostly about allowing you to start the
LFO's oscillation from something other than a key hit. None of the variables on this page will take effect until the VOXTRG parameter is set to ON TRIG . Its default setting is
ON VOX
which initiates the LFO when a voice is activated from the keyboard or MIDI, as is customary.
SOURCE
Trigger Source
This menu is probably familiar to you by now—it contains the 79 Mod Sources covered in Appendix B.
Depending on the source, you may set an LFO to start only above or below certain key ranges, or when a particular envelope stage is set, or in response to a MIDI message. The possibilities are huge.
LEVEL
Trigger Input Level
This sets the threshold level for the trigger, up or down. A setting of zero is in the middle. For many trigger sources, the level must be positive to achieve a trigger.
But for others, you may need to reduce it so that the LFO is triggered only when you want it to be.
Range: ±100.00 in increments of .01.
TYPE
Trigger Type
This sets the conditions or rules under which a trigger will occur as the input source crosses the threshold level. See page 143, the
POLAR
parameter, for explanations of the values for Trigger Type.
The illustrations on pages 155-157 in the Modulation section will also help you understand the meaning of NEGATIVE,
POSITIVE, BIPOLAR, ABS NEGATIVE, ABS BIPOLAR, and
ABS
POSITIVE .
ENABLE
Trigger Enable (ON or OFF)
Soft Knob #6 of this page turns the whole Trigger source for the LFO on or off.
When it is ON, the
TRIG
LED on the top panel (next to the LFO's
VIEW
button) will light.
Even if TRIG ENABLE is ON, the LFO will not be triggered from the selected trigger
SOURCE unless VOXTRG is set to ON TRG . The TRIG LED doesn't have to be on for the LFO to be triggered by the standard voice/key on trigger path.
VOXTRG
LFO Trigger from Voice (
ON VOX
or
ON TRG
)
Soft Knob #7 of this page determines whether the LFO will start from its default source (
ON VOX
, meaning when a key or MIDI input triggers the voice) or from the trigger source chosen by Soft Knob #1 on this page.
FREERN
LFO Freerun (ON or OFF)
Soft Knob #8 of this page determines whether the LFO will always start at the beginning of its cycle when it receives a trigger (Freerun OFF), or simply keep oscillating and not restart when it receives a trigger.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
175
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
176
SYNC Page
This page allows you to synchronize the LFO’s frequency with the A6’s Master
Clock, or with an external MIDI clock. This is a very useful function when you need the LFO to be in sync with the arpeggiator, the sequencer or received MIDI
Timing Clock signals.
SYNSRC
Synchronization Source
LOCAL
CLOCK
MIDI the selected LFO runs independently of the Master Clock at a speed determined by its
RATE
control.
the selected LFO is slaved to the A6’s Master Clock, at a multiple determined by the
TIXPRD
parameter (see below) the selected LFO is slaved to the incoming MIDI Clock, also at a multiple determined by the
TIXPRD
parameter
TIXPRD
Clock Ticks per Period
In order to compensate for significant differences in clocks, especially external clock sources, and allow different LFOs to run at different multiples of the incoming clock,
TIXPRD allows you to designate the number of clock ticks per period of the LFO. Higher values of this will make the LFO run slower (to the point where you may not notice the LFO moving at all); low values are common for most applications.
Note
: The A6’s internal clock and MIDI are both based on a 24 ticks-per-beat cycle. So, if you select 24 TIXPRD, the LFO will repeat once per cycle.
Range: 2 – 65535.
MOD Page
This page and its parameters should be very familiar to you by now. You choose a
SOURCE
from the list of 71 possibilities, set its
LEVEL
and
OFFSET
if desired,
ENABLE it (which can be done from the LFO's top-panel MOD button or from Soft
Knob # 5) and send it to its destination:
FREQUENCY if you want to change the LFO's speed or rate
DELAY if you want to change the delay before the LFO starts
AMPLITUDE if you want to change the LFO's level
PHASE if you want to change the place in the wave where the LFO will start
PULSE WIDTH if the LFO's WAVE is a square or triangle want to change its width (this variable will do nothing if the
WAVE
is set to Sine,
OFFSET
Sawtooth, Random or Noise).
if you want to change the DC offset of the LFO.
Tip:
To have an LFO send controlled by the Mod Wheel, note that it's usually better to assign the Mod Wheel to the receiver (for example, MOD 1 of OSC 1) than it is to assign it to control the
AMPLITUDE
of the LFO on this MOD page. This is because the CROUTES section pre-routes certain controllers to certain modulation destinations. See Chapter 9 for more details.
U
SING
LFO
S AS A
T
RIGGER
S
OURCE
While LFOs rely on a trigger source to start (unless they're in Freerun mode), they themselves can also be trigger sources. Chapter 6 on envelopes covered some of the triggering capabilities of the LFOs’ parameters. As an example, an LFO can be configured so that a trigger is generated every time its wave reaches a certain
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
level. This can be used to trigger an envelope, another LFO, the sequencer or arpeggiator, and many more. We’ll cover more about this in Chapter 9,
The A6
Modulation Matrix.
S
AMPLE AND
H
OLD
Sample and Hold is a specialty mod source that generates its modulation by “sampling an input”. This means that a sine wave, as an example of the input, is sampled – a reading of the sine wave’s current amplitude is taken at regular intervals, the amplitude is held for a period of time – and the result is output as a mod source. So, the output of the S & H module, instead of a sine wave, would be a series of "steps". The amplitude of those steps at any given time depends on the relationship between the sampling clock speed and the rate of change of the wave being sampled.
The sampling is usually accomplished by an
LFO whose speed is controlled by the
S & H
RATE
knob. This LFO only produces a pulse that is used to sample the waveform or other input you select as a source in the display.
Each sample represents an amplitude value that the
RATE
LFO will hold until the next sample is taken. Depending on the
RATE
setting, this “hold time” could be just a few milliseconds to several seconds in duration.
In the following illustrations, the same sample rate is used to sample two different inputs, a periodic sine wave and an aperiodic noise source. Notice that the resulting output from the sine wave is symmetrical: it has an even or regular rise and fall pattern that imitates the uniform shape of the sine wave. The noise input, on the other hand, is a random input and produces a corresponding random output. The latter is what most people think of as a classic sample and hold modulation source.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
177
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
178
In both examples, the
RESULT
is the output of the Sample and Hold generator and will modulate the selected destination when
S & H LEVEL
is used as a mod source.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
PROCESS M
ODULE
The
PROCESS
module contains advanced specialty functions of the A6 that are used to process an input in very specific, mathematically-defined ways. Since this module is software-based, features may be added in the future. Check our website at:
http://www.alesis.com/downloads
to see if features have been added since your unit's software version.
T
RACKING
G
ENERATOR
(TGEN)
The Tracking Generator is used to scale a modulation source. It allows you to
"redraw" any modulation source to your own custom curves. For example, normally you could modulate the level of a sound using velocity; the harder you play, the louder the sound gets. If the amount of change in volume is equal to the change in velocity, this would be called linear control (and you wouldn't need the Tracking
Generator). However, if you set the Tracking Generator's input to VOX KEY ON
VELOCITY
, and then routed the output of the Tracking generator to Envelope 3's
LEVEL , you can make your own customized "map" of the control velocity has over the sound level. You could even make it turn back on itself—for example, make it loud at both very high and very low velocities, and softest at average velocities.
When you look at the TGEN display, you're looking at a classic "X-Y" axis. The input is on the X axis, from left to right, low values to high values. The output of
TGEN
will be according to the Y axis, from up to down. The Tracking Generator divides the range of the input into a maximum of 16 points or stages, each of which can be set to a value between +120 and –120. If you boost the value of one of the lower points, you can make the input more sensitive in its lower register. By creating a non-linear curve, or using one of the preset curves available in the Tracking Generator, you can scale the velocity's control over the sound's volume just the way you want.
Track Gen Level and Track Gen Step
TRACK GEN LEVEL
appears as one of the modulation sources in every MOD menu.
As the input to the tracking generator rises and falls, it scales its output linearly between stages according to the level you set for each stage. For example, if the Pitch
Bend wheel is the TrackGen source, and stage 15 is set to +90 and stage 16 is set to
+120, at the top 1/16 th
of the Pitch Bend range the output of the Tracking Generator will rise smoothly, from 90 to 120.
When
TRACK GEN STEP
is chosen as a mod source, the Tracking Generator's output is stepped. This means that instead of scaling the input linearly from stage to stage, the input is kept at each stage's value setting until it goes beyond the following stage's value setting, at which point it jumps to that setting. In the example above, as you raise the Pitch Bend wheel to the top, it would jump suddenly from 90 to 120 with no interpolations in-between as it would with TRACK GEN LEVEL . This feature is useful in creating "mini-sequences" if the modulation destination is an oscillator frequency and the Tracking Generator's input is an LFO using an "up sawtooth" as its waveform.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
179
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
SOFT KNOB
PAGE TAB
OUTPUT
INPUT
Tip
: The Tracking Generator can be used to turn a variable control, such as the Mod
Wheel or velocity, into a switch by setting all of the points to 0 except the highest one. Only near the maximum input will anything other than 0 come out of the Tracking Generator. Note that this doesn't keep you from using the Mod
Wheel directly at the same time for more gradual functions. For example, the
Mod Wheel could be used to gradually bring in vibrato from an LFO, and at the very top of its travel the Analog Distortion could suddenly be switched on.
T
RACKING
G
ENERATOR
P
ARAMETER
D
ESCRIPTIONS
The A6 has a 16-stage (maximum) Tracking Generator for each voice. The parameters are described in detail below.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
INLVL
SOURCE
STAGE QUANTZ
LEVEL
SIZE
OFFSET
ENABLE
ENABLE
CURVE OUTLVL --
DISPLAY
PAGE
OUTPUT
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
INLVL
Input Level
STAGE
Stage selection
QUANTZ
Quantize
SIZE
TGen Size
ENABLE
CURVE
OUTLVL
TGen Output
Level
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
-100 ···
+100
This "sets the X point" of the Tracking Generator. It defines what input level will be affected by the current STAGE (see below). Note that the bar in the display moves from left to right as this is changed, but an Input Level of a stage cannot be moved lower than the stage below it or higher than the stage above.
1 ··· 16
This is effectively the "cursor" of the display, allowing you to select any of the 16 stages for editing. The number of the currently-selected stage will be shown above
STAGE and its bar will blink on and off.
OFF ··· ON
This determines whether the output of the tracking generator will be quantized to a specific multiple or fraction of the input (-120 S to +120 S), or output a particular value
(–100.00 to +100.00)
2 ··· 16
Sets the number of stages in the Tracking Generator. More stages give more detail, but are also more complex to program.
OFF ··· ON
Turns the output of TGEN on or off.
LINEAR
EXP 1,2,3
LOG 1,2,3
SCURV1,2
-120S -
+120S
(if quantized)
-100 ···+100
(if not)
This recalls several preset curves for you to use as starting points for editing.
Sets the output level of the currently-selected stage of the tracking generator.
180 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
DISPLAY
PAGE
INPUT
PANEL LABEL
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
—
MOD SOURCE
LIST
—
—
—
LEVEL
OFFSET
ENABLE
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
Any of the A6’s
79 modulation sources.
Use soft knob
1
to scroll through the list of possible sources as input for the Tracking
Generator.
-100 ··· +100 This parameter sets the amount of input that will go into the Tracking Generator. Keep in mind that negative values invert the action of the selected source. For example, if Velocity is the source and a negative value for
LEVEL
is used, playing harder will send to lower stages
of the Tracking Generator.
-100 ··· +100
This parameter sets the offset for the selected modulation.
OFF, ON This parameter is used to turn the Tracking
Generator outputs on or off.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
181
Chapter 7: LFOs, S&H and Process
182 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 8: Pre Filter, Post Filter and Voice Mixes
C
HAPTER
8
P
ROGRAM
F
UNCTIONS
P
ART
4:
T
HE
A
NDROMEDA
’
S
M
IXING
S
YSTEM
One of the most useful and exciting features of the A6 is its ability to mix sound signals in a multitude of ways. Having a wide choice of audio paths – routes that the oscillators and other sound sources can take as they make their way through the A6 – provides another set of power tools that you can use to create sounds.
The
PRE FILTER MIX
,
POST FILTER MIX
and
VOICE MIX
are modules used to blend the A6’s sound for the Programs.
VOICE MIX
is also important when setting the levels of different Mix Channels in Mix Mode. But for now, we’ll focus our efforts on Program functions.
P
RE
F
ILTER
M
IX
/P
OST
F
ILTER
M
IX
The
PRE FILTER MIX
and
POST FILTER MIX
modules are used in conjunction to mix the levels of the A6’s sound sources, the Ring Modulator of each voice, and the two
Filters.
PRE FILTER MIX
controls the A6’s sound sources going into the Filters and
POST
FILTER MIX
handles the Filter outputs plus several unfiltered signals going into the
VCA controlled by Envelope 3.
PRE FILTER MIX O
VERVIEW
The
PRE FILTER MIX
module contains six knobs that control the initial output levels of their respective sound sources before they are processed by the Filters and then have their final output levels set in
VOICE MIX
. It is the
PRE FILTER MIX
module that you use to mix the relative output levels of the VCOs (and add in their sub-oscillators if desired), select and mix in a noise source or external audio (but not both), mix in
Filter Feedback, and set the level of the Ring Modulator. All of these sound elements can be mixed into a Program at the same time.
You can route the “output” of
PRE FILTER MIX
– any combination of the VCOs (
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
) plus their sub-oscillators (
SUB OSC
), the Ring Modulator (
RING MOD
),
Noise/External Audio (
NOISE EXT
) and
FILTER FEEDBACK
from the
POST FILTER MIX
– in a number of different ways:
• into
FILTER 1
only
• into
FILTER 2
only
• into both Filters in parallel – each Filter processes the
PRE FILTER MIX
signal independently and at the same time
• into both Filters in series – the output of
PRE FILTER MIX
goes first into
FILTER 1
, then into
FILTER 2
, effectively permitting the “filtering of a filter”
The Ring Modulator is especially interesting in that you can route it into the Filters as above, bypass the Filters altogether (it has a direct route into
POST FILTER MIX
) or have both the Filtered and unfiltered signals at once. See the topic on the following page for the complete story.
Note that all audio sources are available at the same time, with the exception of
Noise or External audio – you must select one or the other.
In addition, each level control in the
PRE FILTER MIX
has its own
MOD
button for controlling levels from any of the modulation sources. You can modulate the levels of the VCOs and their sub-oscillators, the level of the Ring Modulator and the level of the Noise Generator/External Inputs.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
183
Chapter 8: Pre Filter, Post Filter and Voice Mixes
PRE FILTER MIX O
PERATION
OSC and SUB OSC Controls
The output levels of both VCOs going to the Filters are controlled by their respective
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
knobs. Each VCO also provides a sub-oscillator output and its level is controlled by the
SUB OSC
knob. Each sub-oscillator outputs a square wave from its respective VCO, tuned one octave below its
SEMITONE
setting.
RING MOD Control
Each voice’s Ring Modulator is simple in its operation but provides a wealth of new timbres and textures that can be used on their own or mixed in with the VCOs’ unmodified waves.
The
RING MOD
knob controls the output level of the
Ring Modulator into
FILTER 1
,
FILTER 2
or both. The
Ring Modulator’s output is also routed directly to the
POST FILTER MIX
, bypassing the Filters. This dual audio path allows you to filter the Ring Modulator’s output, feed it directly to the outputs with no filtering, or both.
We’ll detail how to use this feature of the A6 on the following page.
RING MOD Operation
The A6’s Ring Modulator takes the waveforms of the two VCOs and multiplies them by each other. The keyword here is multiplies: notice that we didn’t say
modulate
. The A6 does allow you to FM-modulate one
VCO by the other – covered on page 109 – which produces different results.
When two waveforms are multiplied together, the result is a new waveform that is composed of two frequencies: the sum of the two original waveforms’ frequencies and the difference of their frequencies. In the following illustration, we start with two sine waves, one at 300Hz and one at 1,200Hz. When multiplied, the resultant waveform is composed of a 1,500Hz wave
(300 + 1,200) and a 900Hz wave (1,200 - 300).
184 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 8: Pre Filter, Post Filter and Voice Mixes
Note that this example uses two sine waves. When experimenting with the Ring
Modulator, using the sine waves of
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
is a good place to start because sine waves have no harmonics. This will allow you to hear the Ring Modulator produce a waveform with the least complexity.
Different results are obtained by using two square waves or two sawtooth waves as these waveforms contain numerous harmonics which are also multiplied together.
Next try multiple waveforms in each VCO:
SAW
plus
TRI
,
SQR
plus
TRI
,
SQR
plus
SAW
or two square waves with different pulse widths. While you’re testing out different pulse widths, you may also want to add pulse width modulation (press the
PWM
button and make changes to the assigned LFO’s square wave) to hear what happens.
You may also want to experiment with different VCO tunings – experiment with the
SEMITONE
,
CENTS
and
FINE
knobs. Try modulating the frequency of a VCO (or both of them) with a slow LFO or
ENV 1 (PITCH)
.
NOISE/EXTERNAL Control
The
NOISE/EXTERNAL
knob controls the initial level of three varieties of
NOISE
, the level of the external
FILTER AUDIO INPUTS
and the internal
FILTER FEEDBACK
. Each of the four audio sources are selected in turn (or turned off) by repeatedly pressing the input button; the current Noise/External source is shown by LEDs on the top panel and in the display. Only one source can be selected at a time. But Filter Feedback is on its own switch, and when this switch is on Feedback is added at a fixed amount to the
NOISE/EXTERNAL
input amplifier controlled by the
NOISE/EXT
knob.
NOISE
The A6 provides a single noise generator that is available to all voices. Noise is produced by circuit that outputs nearly all audible frequencies at once, called
wideband audio. The result is an unpitched signal that sounds similar to the “static” you hear on a radio when it’s tuned between two stations.
Noise is often used to simulate wind, thunder and explosions. When used subtly, noise can embellish musical sounds created with the VCOs by adding breath effects to brass and woodwinds, for example.
Noise is generated in three “colors”: white, pink and red. These are names that refer to the frequency range of the noise signal. White noise (indicated by the
W
LED on the front panel) selects the entire range of noise at identical levels regardless of frequency. White noise sounds the brightest and fullest of the three. Pink noise
(indicated by the
P
LED) reduces the high frequencies and sounds less bright than white noise. Red noise (the
R
LED) has even more high end removed and sounds the least bright of the three noise sources.
Pressing the button to the left of these LEDs switches among the three noise sources plus
AUDIO EXT IN
, described next.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
185
Chapter 8: Pre Filter, Post Filter and Voice Mixes
AUDIO EXT IN
You can process external audio sources through the A6.
Examples of audio sources you can use include an electric guitar, a high-impedance microphone, a digital sampler, an audio CD player or cassette player, just to name a few.
You may want to process your external audio by the A6’s
Filters. And since the Filters can be modulated, you can also shape the external source by an envelope and add a host of other mod sources if needed.
EXT FILTER INPUTS/ V 1-16
Jack
V 1-16
Button
The
V 1-16
jack on the Andromeda’s back panel is a high-impedance input that routes a mono or single-channel external audio source to all 16 of the A6’s Voices.
This means that you can process a mono signal polyphonically through the A6’s filters, complete with all of the modulation normally available to the Filters: envelope shaping, LFOs and the rest of the A6’s 79 mod sources.
To activate this function, press the
V 1-16
button on the
EXTERNAL INPUTS
module and make sure that
AUDIO EXT IN
is selected in
PRE FILTER MIX
. Use the
NOISE/EXTERNAL
knob to adjust the level of this signal.
EXT FILTER INPUTS/VOICE 15
and
VOICE 16
Jacks
VOICE 15
and
VOICE 16
Buttons
The
VOICE 15
and
VOICE 16
jacks are high-impedance inputs that route a stereo or two single-channel external audio sources to Voice 15 and Voice 16. These inputs differ from the
V 1–16
jack in that, when activated, the Voice 15 and Voice 16 circuitry inside the A6 are reserved for external audio processing and are not affected by the keyboard, received MIDI Notes or any other trigger sources.
To activate this function press the
VOICE 15
and/or the
VOICE 16
buttons on the
EXTERNAL INPUTS
module and make sure that the
AUDIO EXT IN
LED is lit in
PRE
FILTER MIX
(shown in the display as EXTERNL noise source). Use the
NOISE/EXTERNAL
knob to adjust the level of these signals.
FILTER FEEDBACK
A little trick that was used in the days of modular synthesizers to achieve a gritty, nasty sound was to connect the output of the filter module back into the mix module.
Since the mix module is normally routed to the filters to begin with, a feedback loop was created. (MiniMoog users might remember this capability by connecting the
Mini’s headphone output to the auxiliary audio input).
The A6 pre-wires this circuit for you internally: no patch cords required. Press the
FILTER FEEDBACK
button to enable this function and use the
NOISE EXT
knob to control the feedback level. Please note that the level settings of the Filters –
FILT1 LP
,
FILT1 HP
,
FILT1 BP
and
FILT2 LP
– also affect the feedback. Use these five knobs in conjunction to obtain the feedback you want.
186 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 8: Pre Filter, Post Filter and Voice Mixes
Signal Routing through the Filters
The
PRE FILTER MIX
outputs of
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
(along with their respective
SUB OSC
signals), the
RING MOD
and
NOISE EXT
can be routed through the A6 using the following procedures.
Please note that the
PRE FILTER MIX
output always goes to
FILTER 1
unless, of course,
FILTER BYPASS
is on. The following procedures will inform you how to turn the
Filters on or off using their respective level knobs, as well as other Filter “mixing” methods you’ll find useful.
Tip
: For these examples, you can experiment with any of the components in
PRE
FILTER MIX
: the procedures are applicable for any of them or all of them, should you need to mix in levels of all four knobs.
For the component you select, turn its knob to its 2 o’clock position. This will give you a moderate output level to work with. If you are trying out the VCOs, you can also mix in their
SUB OSC
s if you like by turning the knobs clockwise.
Check that the
LEVEL
knob in
VOICE MIX
is turned up and adjusted to provide a comfortable listening level.
Last, turn down all the knobs in
POST FILTER MIX
as a starting point. The examples that follow will tell you what knob to use when appropriate.
• To process external audio through
FILTER 1
only, turn up the
FILT1 LP
knob.
This causes
FILTER 1
to output its lowpass-filtered signal. To have the Filter output other filtered signals – highpass, bandpass or notch – turn up their respective knobs. (We’ll provide details on these controls under the
Filter
Output Controls
topic on the following page.)
To be certain that you’re only hearing
FILTER 1
, make sure that the
FILT2 LP
knob is turned fully counter-clockwise. This shuts off the output of
FILTER 2
.
• To process external audio through
FILTER 2
only, press the
F2 INPUT
button located on the front panel between the two Filters until the
MIX
LED lights.
This routes the output of
PRE FILTER MIX
into
FILTER 2
. Then turn up the
FILT2
LP
knob and make sure that all the other knobs in this module are turned down.
• To process external audio through filters in parallel, use the first two methods together: when the
MIX
function is active, the output of
PRE FILTER MIX
flows into
FILTER 2
independently of
FILTER 1
. Use the
FILT2 LP
knob to control the level. And since the output of
PRE FILTER MIX
is normally routed to
FILTER 1
, use any (or all) of the
FILT1
knobs to mix in the output of
FILTER 1
.
This functionality of the A6 mixing system provides enormous flexibility: you can independently mix the levels of two Filters complete with their own
RESONANCE
levels,
KEY TRACK
amounts and modulation. You can even assign a different envelope to one of the Filters for independent harmonic shaping.
• To process external audio through filters in series, press the
F2 INPUT
button until either the
NOTCH
LED lights or the
BP
(bandpass) LED lights. When either of these two LEDs are on, that means that the respective output of
FILTER 1
will flow into
FILTER 2
. Here are the details:
When using
NOTCH
as the input, remember from Chapter 5 that the notch in the
FILTER 1
’s harmonic spectrum is created by using both lowpass and highpass filtering together (page 118). The input to Filter 2 is post-fader, meaning that you can turn up the
FILT1 LP
and turn down the
FILT1 HP
knob which effectively gives you a “
LOWPASS
” input instead of
NOTCH
as it is labeled on the front panel. Conversely, you can turn down
FILT1 LP
and
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
187
Chapter 8: Pre Filter, Post Filter and Voice Mixes
turn up
FILT 1 HP
, effectively giving you a “
HIGHPASS
” input to
FILTER 2
instead of a notch.
When using
BP
as the input to
FILTER 2
, you can invert the bandpass filtering by pressing the
BP INVERT
button in the
POST FILTER MIX
module.
RING MOD Signal Routing
The signal routing of the Ring Modulator has a unique feature that allows you to bypass the Filters while still routing the
RING MOD
signal as in the above examples.
This allows you to hear the filtered and unfiltered Ring Modulator simultaneously.
You can’t do that with the other components of
PRE FILTER MIX
.
• To hear the Ring Modulator in its purest form, turn all four knobs in
PRE
FILTER MIX
fully counter-clockwise. This turns off all of the
PRE FILTER MIX
components going to the Filters.
In
POST FILTER MIX
, press the
RING MOD
button located near the bottom of this module until the LED is off. (If the
OSC 1 SINE
or
OSC 2 SINE
LEDs are lit, press those buttons to turn them off.) This connects the Ring Modulator’s output to the
PRE FILTER
knob, bypassing the Filters. Use this knob to control the level of the unfiltered Ring Modulator signal.
Try pressing the
MOD
button and assigning
ENV 1 (PITCH)
to shape the loudness of the Ring Modulator’s signal, especially if the Filter Envelope is being used to control the other signals.
• To hear this unfiltered Ring Modulator signal along with filtering, raise the
RING MOD
control in the
PRE FILTER MIX
. Then follow one of the procedures on the previous page to route the
RING MOD
signal, in parallel, through one or both of the Filters.
188 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 8: Pre Filter, Post Filter and Voice Mixes
POST FILTER MIX O
VERVIEW
The
POST FILTER MIX
module contains five knobs that control the output of the Filters going to the
VOICE MIX
plus the unfiltered signal levels of
OSC 1
and
OSC 2 SINE
waves and the
RING MOD
signal.
POST FILTER MIX
, like the
PRE FILTER MIX
module, includes a number of
MOD
buttons that are used to route mod sources to their respective destinations. You can modulate the levels of the
FILTER 1
’s lowpass, highpass and bandpass (as well as the inverted bandpass) outputs, and the level of
FILTER 2
’s lowpass output. The
PRE FILTER
knob, which controls the unfiltered levels of
OSC 1
/
OSC 2 SINE
waves and
RING MOD
outputs, can also be modulated.
POST FILTER MIX O
PERATION
The first four knobs in
POST FILTER MIX
are all level controls for the Filters’ outputs routed to the
VOICE MIX
as shaped by
ENV 3 (AMP)
. We’ve already covered the principles of these Filter functions earlier in Chapter 5 under the topics
How Filters Are Designed
(refer to page
117 if you need a review) and
Signal Routing
(see the previous page). We’re providing a summary here.
FILTER 1 Controls
The
FILT1 LP
knob controls the level of
FILTER 1
’s low pass filtered signal while the
FILT2 HP
knob controls the level of
FILTER 1
’s high pass filtered signal. Both of these knobs can be used at the same time. When they are, a
NOTCH
filter is produced.
The
FILT1 BP
knob controls the level of
FILTER 1
’s band pass filtered signal. The band of frequencies can be inverted by pressing the
BP INVERT
button.
FILTER 2 Control
The
FILT2 LP
knob controls the level of
FILTER 2
’s low pass filtered signal.
PRE FILTER Output Control
This knob controls the level of three signals –
OSC 1 SINE
(the sine wave output of
OSC 1
),
OSC 2 SINE
(the sine wave output of
OSC 2
) and
RING
MOD
(the output of the Ring Modulator) – that are routed directly from the sources to the
POST FILTER MIX
, bypassing the Filters. This direct signal flow provides several distinct advantages when editing Programs, covered in detail earlier in this manual on page 126.
To select any or all of these signals, press the respective button or buttons – all three signals can be selected at the same time. Use the
PRE FILTER
knob to set the initial level. If you want independent envelope shaping of the loudness of these
PRE FILTER
signals, press the
MOD
button and assign an envelope at this point in the mix.
FILTER BYPASS Button
Normally, all audio flowing through the A6 is routed to
FILTER 1
. And depending on the settings of the
LP INPUT
button and the
POST FILTER MIX
level knobs,
FILTER 2
becomes part of the mix as well. You can, however, bypass both Filters if necessary.
Pressing the
FILTER BYPASS
button disconnects both Filters from the audio path: any sound going through the A6 is untouched. You must, however, shape the signal’s loudness by
ENV 3 (AMP)
as all audio is hardwired to this envelope.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
189
Chapter 8: Pre Filter, Post Filter and Voice Mixes
V
OICE
M
IX
The
VOICE MIX
module contains the final mixing stages of the A6. The mixed output of this module feeds the instrument’s
MASTER VOLUME
knob on the left of the instrument that controls the final output of the A6.
VOICE MIX
is where the relative levels and panning – the placement of voices left-to-right in the stereo image – are set as part of a Program or Mix. You have a
LEVEL
knob and a
PAN
knob for the back panel outputs:
MAIN (LEFT
and
RIGHT
stereo pair), and alternatively an
AUX 1-2
pair. The important concept to understand here is that you are panning the final outputs of the
A6’s 16 voices.
MAIN and AUX outputs
The
LEVEL
knob controls the level of the A6’s stereo mix sent to either the
MAIN RIGHT
and
LEFT
(via the Master Volume control) or
AUX
back panel jacks. An
OUTPUT
switch toggles the output of the current Program or Mix
Channel between the
MAIN
and
AUX
jacks. The most important difference between the Main and Aux jacks is that the
EFFECTS
outputs are only routed to the
MAIN
outputs, and the headphones only monitor the
MAIN
outputs. Aux jacks can serve as a separate "dry" stereo output in case you need them. Examples include a send to a stereo monitor mix, a stereo send to an external effects device (EQ, compressor and so forth) or outputs to additional tape tracks, just to name a few.
Note that you can pan the voices hard left or hard right in
MAIN
,
AUX
or
OFF
and use the corresponding jack for a mono signal output.
These settings are programmable for each Program and Mix. Just remember that the
MASTER VOLUME
control (on the far left side of the front panel) affects only the Main Output, and it is NOT programmable.
Last, the
MOD
button is used to route a mod source to modulate the PAN of the Main and Aux outputs. Any of the A6’s 79 modulation sources can be assigned.
Setting Levels in Mix Mode
The ability to set different output assignments, pans, and levels is most useful when the Andromeda is in Mix Mode. For example, you can send Mix Channels with bass programs to the
AUX
outputs, and layer different Mix Channels’ outputs in stereo for dramatic effects.
The settings for each Mix Channel’s
VOICE MIX
can be set either directly on the Voice
Mix controls, or on the
PROG
page in Mix Edit mode using the soft knobs. Level, Pan, and Main/Aux selections made on either display will be shown automatically on the other.
To set the Voice Mix parameters for different Mix Channels, simply use the
MIX
CHANNEL SELECT 1/9-8/16
buttons to select the channels you want.
Individual VOICE OUTPUT
The
VOICE OUTPUT
button at the top of the module turns the feed to the individual
VOICE OUTPUT
jacks on and off. It has no effect on the feed to the Main or Aux outputs. Although it may not be obvious from the display, the
VOICE OUTPUT
jacks are affected by the
LEVEL
knob, though not by the
PAN
, since they are monophonic.
They are the direct outputs of each of the sixteen hardware voices.
190 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
C
HAPTER
9:
C
USTOM
M
ODULATIONS
Chapter 5: Program Functions
just presented us with a detailed look at the main programmable functions of the A6’s modules that comprise a Program:
OSC 1
and
OSC 2
,
FILTER 1
and
FILTER 2
, the
PRE FILTER MIX
,
POST FILTER MIX
and
VOICE MIX
audio mixing modules, plus the modulation source modules of the
LFOs
,
ENV 1
,
ENV 2
and
ENV 3
.
Referring back to
Chapter 2: Playing the A6
, we also covered the performance functions of the A6: how to use the Display, the
CLOCK
module (
SEQUENCER
and
ARPEGGIATOR
), the
MASTER
module (
VOLUME
and
TUNE
), the
KBD MODE
and
PORTA
modules, and the performance wheels, ribbon controller and pedals.
As far as modulation is concerned,
Chapter 6: Modulation and Envelopes
, and
Chapter 7: LFOs, Sample and Hold and Process
covered the most important modulation sources.
So looking at the A6’s front panel, it would be easy to conclude that we’ve covered just about all there is to know about the A6.
Well, not quite. Now we’ll explain how the modulation sources can be routed and controlled within a program.
MOD F
UNCTIONS
O
VERVIEW
We’ve already covered much in the way of modulation when we presented the LFOs and Envelopes topics in Chapter 6. There were also many instances where a
MOD
button was mentioned, if only briefly, as a way to route additional mod sources to the function being discussed. In this Chapter, we’ll detail one of the most flexible features of the A6 called the Modulation Matrix. This technology expands the modulation capabilities of the A6 by leaps and bounds.
Where the default and hardwired modulations in the A6 provide the standard, mostused modulations, you can think of the Mod Matrix as a “system of custom mod paths”. There will be times that the default mod paths won’t be able to offer the kind of modulation you really need to do the job. The Modulation Matrix, which is the engine underneath the
MOD
buttons, permits taking any one of the A6’s 79 modulation sources and routing it to any one of 175 destinations. That’s 13,825 possible new mod paths. In addition to the standard “hardwired” modulations, there’s almost no route you can imagine that can’t be implemented if you’re creative about it.
Between the many “hardwired” and the 45 custom mod paths available, you have thousands of potential modulations per Program – and they’re all programmable.
A
VOID DUPLICATION WITH HARD
-
WIRED MODS
The
MOD
functions are so flexible, they may fool you into using them when one of the pre-wired modulations would be a wiser choice. For example, in Oscillator 1’s
MOD
buttons, you can choose PITCH WHEEL as the source and FREQUENCY as the destination…but you don’t need to do that to get pitch bend, because that’s already handled by the
PITCH ASSIGN
system above the wheel itself. Similarly, the Mod
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
191
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
Wheel is assigned by default to control the level of
MOD 1
in each oscillator; you don’t have to program that. In both cases, you can turn the hard-wired routes off if you wish, but why use up a custom MOD for something that’s already there?
P
ERFORMANCE CONTROL OF MODS
Once you’ve set up a modulation, you have two options:
1.
Have the modulation exist constantly (for example, if you always want vibrato on) or
2.
Control the modulation from a performance controller, such as the Mod
Wheel, the Ribbon, or a footswitch.
You need to know which option you will use in order to set the parameters correctly.
If you choose Option 2, you’ll need to learn about the Control Routes section, on page 198.
U
SING THE
M
ODULATION
M
ATRIX
Conceptually, you can think of the Mod Matrix as a rather large table with the sources listed down the left-hand column and the destinations listed across the top row. This table forms a “matrix” (sometimes called an array) of the available sources and destinations. Any source can be paired with any destination, or with multiple destinations. The following illustration shows just a small representation of the entire table of sources and destinations:
Env 1 Level
192
The bullets indicate the intersection of the source/destination pairs that form the mod paths:
• LFO 1 modulates the OSC 2 Linear FM of OSC 1
• LFO 2 modulates the Frequency of OSC 1
• LFO 3 modulates the Level of OSC 1’s Square Wave
• Envelope 1 modulates the Pulse Width of OSC 1
Note that this Matrix doesn’t appear directly in the display; instead, you have a
target-based system that shows an individual matrix element when you press a
MOD
button within a module. The MOD displays are all similar to this:
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
What the MOD display means
The upper right hand corner shows that this is a mod page for Filter 1. By looking at the page tabs and the legend above it, we know we’re looking at Mod 1 of that filter.
Moving from left to right, we can see:
• the
SOURCE
is
VOX KEY NUMBER
, which means the modulation will rise and fall as you play higher and lower on the keyboard.
• the LEVEL is +46.00
. If it were 0.00
, there would be no modulation unless some other modulator has this level as its target. If
LEVEL
were a negative value, it would invert the modulation (in this case, higher key values would give LESS modulation).
•
OFFSET
is
-31.06
. The programmer wanted the “home value” of the modulation to start lower on the keyboard in this case.
• the
MOD
path is ON ; you can enable and disable this path by pressing the
MOD
key in the module, or by turning soft knob
5
.
• the destination (
DEST
) is
RESONANCE
.
Looking at these elements, you can see that in this program, Mod 1 of Filter 1 is designed to increase the resonance of the filter the higher you play on the keyboard, and decrease it on lower notes. Since the level is positive, this mod path is probably intended to be on constantly…but it’s still possible that the amount of resonance could be increased or decreased by still another modulator via
MOD2
or
MOD 3
. You’ll find out when you check them. The flexibility of the Modulation Matrix may lead to some confusion when you’re editing a complicated program, but when you’re writing your own program you’ll be very glad it’s there.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
193
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
The different ways to modulate a parameter
There are four “levels” of operation that are used to control mod paths in the A6’s
Mod Matrix system:
Hardware Mods:
The first level uses dedicated front panel controls to control the level of a particular modulation source and is the most visible of the three. First level mods such as PWM and OSC2 FM are commonly used and are easily accessed from the front panel. Other “hardwired” mods include:
ENV 1 AMOUNT
which can modulate the frequency of either or both oscillators,
PITCH WHEEL
, also sending to the frequency of either or both oscillators, and
ENV 2 AMOUNT
which can modulate the frequency of either or both filters.
While hardware modulators can be turned off or changed at any time, you don’t have to use a custom mod path for these functions.
Custom Mods (Mod Matrix):
Second-level mod paths are the custom paths found in the display only after a
MOD
button is pressed and are not related to a particular source. Instead they can draw on up to 79 Mod Sources which are listed in Appendix
B. These “hidden” mod paths involve a large number of sources and destinations that are not that common but are quite useful nonetheless. Examples include using the parameters of a mod source as a mod destination. You can modulate an envelope
– typically a mod source – by selecting many of its parameters as destinations:
LEVEL
,
DELAY
time,
ATTACK
time,
DECAY 1
time, and so on. Another example would be
EFFECTS
parameters: Distortion SEND or reverb SEND .
Fixed software Mods:
Third-level mod paths are also found in the display only.
These mods involve triggers that are generated by a wide variety of sources including the keyboard, sequencer, arpeggiator and MIDI triggers. Certain other mod sources, such as
CV IN
in the Filter displays, go from a fixed source to a fixed destination, and have no top-panel control.
Control of Custom Mods: “Control Routes” (CROUTES)
In addition, control of certain modulation paths can be established in the background using the CROUTES
(control routes) screen, which essentially “reaches in” to the mod path to modulate its level from a controller or another modulation source. For example, you can control the amount of
MOD 1
modulating Oscillator 2 from the Mod Wheel and/or the
Ribbon simultaneously. But if the Ribbon was in the mod route and the Wheel was in the control route, the Wheel would control how much the Ribbon controlled the modulation of VCO 2.
About the custom MOD paths
A quick look at the A6’s front panel reveals 45
MOD
buttons strategically placed around the modules. The important concept to understand here is that the function that each
MOD
button is linked to is a destination. So when you press a
MOD
button, the function or module where the button is located will be the destination (“what’s being modulated”).
Pressing a
MOD
button causes the screen to display the current mod path along with its current values, as shown on the previous page. If a modulation has not been assigned to this destination, the display will inform you of that (the
SOURCE
will say
OFFSET ONLY
). Either way, use the soft controls to edit the source and adjust the modulation level.
The
MOD
buttons fall into two categories: those linked to a single parameter and those linked to a particular module with several destination parameters to choose from.
The following tables will clarify this distinction:
194 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
MODULE BUTTON TITLE
ARPEGGIATOR SYNC/MOD
SEQUENCER SYNC/MOD
PORTA
S&H
MOD
MOD
OSC 1
OSC 2
PRE FILTER
MIX
EFFECTS
POST FILTER
MIX
PWM (Pulse
Width
Modulation)
PWM (Pulse
Width
Modulation)
MOD
MOD
MOD
MOD
MOD
MOD
MOD (Analog
Distortion)
MOD
MOD
MOD
MOD
MOD
MOD BUTTONS WITH SINGLE DESTINATIONS
DESTINATION
PARAMETER
TEMPO
TEMPO
PORTA RATE
SAMPHOLD
RATE
OSC 1 Pulse
Width
OSC 2 Pulse
Width
OSC 1 LVL
SUB OSC 1 LVL
RING MOD LVL
NOISE/EXT LVL
OSC 2 LVL
SUB OSC 2 LVL
DISTORT SEND
FILT1 LP LVL
FILT1 HP LVL
FILT1 BP LVL
FILT2 LP LVL
SIN/RING VOL
DESCRIPTION
modulates the clock rate of the arpeggiator modulates the clock rate of the sequencer modulates the portamento rate modulates the RATE of the Sample & Hold modulates the pulse width of OSC 1’s square wave modulates the pulse width of OSC 2’s square wave modulates the output level of OSC 1 modulates the output level of OSC 1’s sub oscillator modulates the output level of the Ring Modulator modulates the output level of the noise module and external input modulates the output level of OSC 2 modulates the output level of OSC 2’s sub oscillator modulates the level of the Analog Distortion SEND control modulates the level of FILTER 1’s low pass output modulates the level of FILTER 1’s high pass output modulates the level of FILTER 1’s band pass or inverted band pass output modulates the level of FILTER 2’s low pass output modulates the level of the unfiltered signals from
OSC 1 and OSC 2’s sine waves plus the RIng Mod
MODULE
LFO1
LFO2 and 3
EFFECTS
OSC 1
MOD BUTTONS WITH MULTIPLE DESTINATIONS
BUTTON TITLE
MOD
MOD
MOD (Digital
Effects)
DESTINATION
PARAMETER
PHASE
PULSE WIDTH
OFFSET
FREQUENCY
DELAY
AMPLITUDE
PHASE
PULSE WIDTH
OFFSET
DFX SEND LEFT,
RIGHT, L&R,
PAN
MOD 1, 2
and
3
FREQUENCY
SQR WAVE LVL
PULSE WIDTH
OSC2->PWM
DESCRIPTION
modulates the PHASE, PULSE WIDTH or OFFSET of LFO
1 modulates the FREQUENCY, DELAY, AMPLITUDE,
PHASE, PULSE WIDTH or OFFSET of each LFO modulates the level of the Sends to the left and right side of the Digital Effects module modulates the input pan of any Digital Effect that has a Pan control (parallel configurations) modulates the frequency of the oscillator modulates the level of the square wave output from the oscillator modulates the pulse width of the oscillator modulates the amount of pulse width modulation from Oscillator 2
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
195
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
OSC 1 (cont.)
OSC 2
FILTER 1 and
FILTER 2
MOD
MOD BUTTONS WITH MULTIPLE DESTINATIONS (continued)
OSC2->LIN FM
(OSC 2 FM)
OSC2->EXP FM
EXT->PWIDTH
EXT->LIN FM
EXT->EXP FM
LIN FM
modulates the amount of linear FM modulation from Oscillator 2 modulates the amount of exponential FM
modulation from Oscillator 2 modulates the amount of pulse width modulation from the Noise/External module modulates the amount of linear FM modulation from the Noise/External module modulates the amount of exponential FM
modulation from the Noise/External module modulates the level of OSC 2 modulating OSC 1’s frequency in two different ways
EXP FM
MOD 1, 2
MOD 1, 2
and and
3
3
Pulse Width
FREQUENCY
SQR WAVE LVL
PULSE WIDTH
EXT->PWIDTH
EXT->EXP FM
FREQUENCY
modulates the level of OSC 2 modulating OSC 1’s square wave pulse width modulates the frequency of the oscillator modulates the level of the square wave output from the oscillator modulates the pulse width of the oscillator modulates the amount of pulse width modulation from the Noise/External module modulates the amount of exponential FM
modulation from the Noise/External module modulates the frequency of the filter
RESONANCE
modulates the resonance of the filter
ENV 1
ENV 2 and
ENV 3
VOICE MIX
MOD 1, 2
and
3
TRIGGER
DELAY,
ATTACK, DECAY
1, DECAY 2,
RELEASE 1,
RELEASE 2
ENVELOPE
LEVEL, SUSTAIN
LEVEL
TRIGGER and
RETRIGGER
modulates the time of these filter segments modulates the level of the entire envelope, or the sustain segment triggers the envelope in response to the modulation source
MOD MAIN OUT PAN
AUX OUT PAN
modulates the pan of the Main or Aux stereo outputs
196 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
A F
EW
G
ROUND
R
ULES
• The mod paths created from the Mod Matrix are programmable per Program.
This means that each of the A6’s 128 Programs can have a unique set of custom mod paths, or none at all.
• Therefore, all Mod Routes routings must be written into memory with the
STORE
button, just like any other Program or Mix parameter.
• When there are multiple
MOD
buttons in a module, you can actually assign multiple sources to the same destination. You can also take the same source and route it to different destinations simultaneously.
When a destination is being modulated by two or more sources, their effects on the destination are summed together. This means that the effect of one source used alone may be added to, subtracted from or even interfered with by the introduction of another source. This situation may be further enhanced
(or aggravated) when positive amounts are used on some of the sources and negative amounts are used on the others. Keep experimenting!
• The range of a modulation may not be enough to do the job in some cases. No problem. Since mod sources assigned to the same destination are summed, just add the same Source again in another Mod path and adjust LEVEL until the required range is achieved. If you still need more just do it again. Also, since the same Source can be used several times, each
LEVEL
can be used for
“fine tuning”: a Source can be used to provide very fine increments of change if necessary. Try it.
• When modulating a destination that already has a high initial value (above 50 or so) by a positive source value, it is recommended that the initial value be set to a lower amount. This is suggested so that the modulation has enough
“headroom” to be effective.
If, for example, the destination’s initial setting is near its maximum, in many cases the effect of positive modulation may not be heard because the destination’s amount is already near maximum to begin with. Envelope 3
Level is a good example of this—if the VCA is already wide open, adding positive modulation from another source will have no effect. Some experimentation is required depending greatly on the nature of the
Modulation Page you’ve created.
• Conversely, when modulating a Destination that has an initial setting of a lower (below 20 or so) value by a negative
LEVEL
value, it is recommended that this initial setting be set to a higher amount. If, for example, the
Destination’s initial LEVEL is 10, in many cases the effect of negative modulation may not be heard because the Destination’s amount is already near its minimum to begin with. Again, some experimentation is required.
• As you audition new MODs you’ve created, you may experience some results that you didn’t expect. This may be due to the fact that many of the modulations are inter-related and editing one parameter could possibly affect another indirectly.
Infinite feedback loops
: It is possible to program sources and destinations that result in infinite loops. For example, the frequency of LFO 1 can be modulated by LFO 1 itself. Sometimes this is useful, other times you may need to turn the
MOD off to get the program to work correctly.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
197
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
T
HE
C
ONTROL
R
OUTES
S
ECTION
As we said earlier in this chapter, modulators can be constant at the level set on the
Mod page, or they can be controlled from still more modulation sources. This
“modulating the modulator” control panel is called the Control Routes display. The
CRoutes are Mod Route scaling control assignments. Think of them as a sort of “behind the scenes” modulation route. For example, if you’ve ever wondered why the MW appears to be hardwired to control LFO 1 modulation for both Osc 1 and 2 when you enable their respective Mod 1’s, the CRoutes are the reason why. And the CRoutes are what you would use to undo that, as well.
You reach the Control Routes display by pressing the
MOD ASSIGN, PITCH WHEEL
or
RIBBON
buttons twice. The first press of the button shows you the variables of the controller itself, but a second displays the Control Routes section, or
CROUTES
for short. There are two pages in the Control Routes display:
CROUTE
and
GRID
.
Unlike the custom modulators, in the CRoutes display a Mod Route can be assigned only one controller at any time (in the CRoutes screen, mod sources are assigned to
Mod Routes). Also, only 35 of the Mod Routes can be controlled from here.
T
O CHANGE MODULATION AMOUNTS USING THE
CROUTES
PAGE
:
The easiest way to understand this section is to use it to change the most common modulation route in a program.
1.
Call up a program for which the Mod Wheel brings in vibrato.
2.
Double-press the Mod Assign button. This will take you to the Control Routes section and call up the Grid page showing a list of the mods that are being controlled by the Mod Wheel.
Note that the Mod Wheel is highlighted in the box to the left of the LCD. That means the destinations listed in the Grid to the right belong to the Mod Wheel.
3.
Turn soft knob
1
(
SOURCE
) and watch the list in the box on the left. If it looks suspiciously like the Source list for every other modulation path on the A6, you’re right! That’s because it is the same list. Any modulation source can be used as a source for a Control Route.
As you change sources, you’ll see what destinations they control, if any. Any destinations that aren’t controlled by a modulator will be displayed when the source is set to
OFFSET
.
4.
Double-press the Mod Assign button again to return to the Mod Wheel’s Grid page. Notice the list in the Grid on the right. Depending on the program, it probably has Osc 1 Mod 1 and Osc 2 Mod 1 listed in the farthest column on the right. The next column over to the left has the words ON or OFF , and the leftmost column shows numbers. These numbers show the amount of control the Mod
Wheel currently exerts over the Mod 1 paths of each oscillator.
5.
Move the Mod Wheel up and down while playing a note. You should hear vibrato on the note. Now turn soft knob
4
, which is directly under the word
ENABLE in the display. You should see the word ON change to OFF in the first row of the Grid.
6.
Carefully turn soft knob
6
, the one under the word SCROLL , until you have selected the next row of the Grid and highlighted the words Osc 2 Mod 1. Now turn soft knob
4
again until you see the word
ON
change to
OFF
in the second row of the Grid.
198 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
If you’ve done this, try the Mod Wheel again. You’ll notice that it didn’t bring in the vibrato this time. But notice that the LEDs for each Oscillator’s Mod 1 are still on.
This means the mod route itself is still active; it’s just that the Mod Wheel is no longer available to increase the level of the mod.
Note that Control Sources only affect mod routes which are linked to hardware destinations such as Oscillators, Pulse Width, Filters, Pre Filter Mix, Post Filter
Mix, FX sends, and the Voice Mix Pan mod. They do not control softwaregenerated destinations like Envelope stages or LFOs.
T
O CHANGE THE SOURCE OF A
C
ONTROL
R
OUTE
:
The next thing to do might be to assign some other Control Source (like Aftertouch) to control vibrato via Osc 1 Mod 1 and Osc 2 Mod 1. Or we could add some other mods to be controlled by the Mod Wheel.
MOD ASSIGN
button next to the Mod Wheel twice.
2.
Press soft button
1
(
CROUTE
).
You’ll now see a list of SOURCES on the left, going through a LEVEL and ENABLE control, to a list of ROUTEs.
3.
Turn soft knob
5
(
ROUTE
), (or press the up or down keys when
ROUTE
is highlighted), to display the destination OSC1 MOD1 .
As you go through the list, the SOURCE being aimed at that destination will show in the display, as will its level and whether it’s enabled. If the ENABLE parameter reads
HARD
instead of
ON
or
OFF
, that particular pathway is hard-wired and cannot be disabled.
4.
Turn soft knob
1
( SOURCE ) to select the source you want (for example, KEY
AFTERTOUCH ).
Note that the Mod Wheel no longer controls OSC1’s vibrato; aftertouch will. Since there can be only one Control Route per destination, aftertouch has replaced the mod wheel.
Sometimes when programming, you may hear a modulation you want to eliminate, but you’re not sure of the source. The CROUTE page offers you a way to find out what’s going where and eliminate or change the level of these modulators. Simply go through steps 1-3 above to display the route you think you want to eliminate or edit.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
199
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
A
BOUT
S
IGNAL
F
LOW IN A
MOD P
ATH
When you’re programming a modulation, keep in mind that there are many possible level controls between the mod source and its destination. As in a mixing console, there are many places in the MOD signal path where the signal may be turned up, turned down, or switched off. In the Andromeda, this flexibility allows you to do things that are difficult or impossible on other synths.
There is no “right” way to control the levels; they simply have different consequences depending on what you want to achieve.
Below is a sample drawing/flow chart of the controls typical in the path from LFO 1 to Osc 1. At any one of these points, the amount of modulation can be affected.
ENABLE
LFO 1 OSC 1
FREQUENCY
WAVE/LEVEL
ENABLE
MOD 1/LEVEL
MOD 1
ENABLE
MOD
MOD of LFO
DEST =
AMPLITUDE
CROUTE = OSC1
MOD1
LEVEL
The top part of this diagram represents the basic modulation path: LFO through
MOD
1
of Oscillator 1, aimed at its frequency. To get a basic, constant vibrato, the level of the LFO module itself must be up, LFO 1 must be the source of MOD 1, the level of
MOD 1 must be up, MOD 1 must be enabled, and Frequency must be the mod’s destination.
The lower blocks of the diagram show the “modulators of the modulators”: LFO 1 has its own
MOD
button, which may be set to control the amplitude of the LFO itself from any of the 79 Modulation Sources. If this is enabled (the LED next to the button is on), the output of LFO 1 (to all destinations, not just Oscillator 1) will be affected.
Another potential level control comes from the Control Route section, which affects how much of Mod 1 will be sent on to the frequency of the oscillator. In many programs, the source of this route is the Mod Wheel; other programs may not enable this route at all.
So why have two different ways of doing the same thing? What’s the difference between controlling the level of the source and controlling the level at the destination? The difference is that the diagram above doesn’t show the many other possible modules that may be using LFO 1 for some purpose. It’s perfectly OK to use
LFO 1’s
MOD
button to raise and lower the output level, but if you do, keep in mind that every other
MOD
in the Andromeda that may be using LFO 1 for some purpose will be affected at the same time.
200 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
A
BOUT
M
ODULATION
S
OURCES
The Mod Sources list in Appendix B near the end of the manual carries a description of each source, although they’re fairly self-explanatory. But there are three categories that you should consider:
• Sources with a
VOX
prefix are per Voice, and are per-note functions.
• Sources with a
PGM
prefix, later in the list, are per Program, or are ‘global’ and will affect all voices at once in the same way.
• At the end of the list are Clock and Gate Sources. The clocks should be selfexplanatory in name; they can be used to fire or reset modules which accomodate such (Envelopes, Seq/Arp, S/H, LFOs, etc.) The Envelope stage names at the end of the list are Gates that go high when the indicated stage is reached during the associated Envelope’s cycle. You can start the Sequencer when Envelope 2 reaches Release 2, for example, or start the S/H running upon reaching the
Sustain of Env 3. The End stage is provided to allow cascading Envelopes or to fire modules when an Envelope reaches zero at the end of its cycle.
Obviously, certain modulation sources are more appropriate for some destinations than others. In most cases, you won’t assign a gate source to control the frequency of the oscillator. But you may get some interesting results by going beyond the standard concepts.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
201
Chapter 9: The A6 Modulation Matrix
202 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
C
HAPTER
10:
U
SING
E
FFECTS
I
NTRODUCTION
The A6 features two complete systems of effects: one that produces a variety of
analog-generated
distortions (overdrive, classic fuzz box and more) and the other for producing an array of studio-quality digital effects (reverbs, delays, chorus, flanging, pitch-shifting and rotating speaker). This entire arsenal is fully programmable for
each
Program and Mix.
The digital effects contain a number of single effects plus some very useful multieffects where two or more single effect generators are linked. In addition, the output of the analog system can be input to the digital effects for further processing, or fed directly to the
VOICE MIX
(in parallel to the digital effects) for a “dry” distorted output.
S
IGNAL
F
LOW
In the Andromeda, the effects processors receive signal from the
VOICE MIX LEVEL
control (on the far right hand side of the unit). This is after the post-filter mix and the
VCA controlled by
ENV 3.
The Digital Effects section can also receive signal from the
Analog Distortion section if desired. The effects processors send their output directly to the
MAIN OUT
jacks only—not to the
AUX OUTS
or the individual
VOICE OUTS
.
Think of the effects section as a dedicated signal processor attached in stereo to the main stereo outputs, whose effects program changes every time you select another
Program or Mix. You set the balance between the “wet” (effected) and “dry”
(uneffected) sounds using the output levels of the effects pages in the display—unlike most other controls in the A6 there are no dedicated top-panel controls for effects besides the buttons shown above.
B
ASIC
C
ONTROLS
The
EFFECTS
area above the display is a simple set of five buttons. The LED below each button informs you of that function’s current status. When selecting Programs or Mixes, if an LED in this section is lighted, you know that the current Program has that function enabled. By the same token, if any one of these LEDs is off, you know that its associated function is not part of the current program.
EFFECTS ON/OFF –
Both the Analog Distortion and the Digital Effects systems are turned on or off by pressing this button. Although fully programmable for each
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
203
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Program and each Mix, any and all distortions/effects stored with a Program or Mix can be disabled with this button. The on/off status is programmable.
CONFIG
– There are two Configuration buttons, one for the Analog Distortion system and one for the Digital Effects system. A configuration is an arrangement of one or more effects. Each Analog Distortion and each Digital Effect in the A6 use one configuration at a time. Pressing either
CONFIG
button enters either Analog Distortion
Edit or Digital Effects Edit mode and displays the current Distortion or Effects settings for the selected Program or Mix.
MOD
– Like many other functions in the A6, several parameters in the Distortion and
Effects systems may be modulated by envelopes, LFO’s and many other sources.
Pressing either
MOD
button enters Modulation Edit mode for that system. The A6 displays the available mod destinations and allows the user to select any of the 79 modulation sources.
A
NALOG
D
ISTORTION
Analog Distortion has one simple configuration, with four different types of distortion available: EASY , LIGHT , HEAVY , and KILLER . It has three outputs, any or all of which can be switched on or off:
MAIN
,
DFX1
and
DFX2
. The latter are two separate inputs to the digital effects section, which are useful in multieffect (stereoinput) configurations only. For example, you can have the left side of a chorus distorted, while the right side is clean.
To Main output
To Digital Effects 1
To Digital Effects 2
There’s only one page when you press Analog Distortion’s
CONFIG
button: the ANAFX page which allows you to set the SEND (input) level, select the TYPE of effect, the
OUTPUT
level, and turn the three outputs on and off.
Digital Effects
The CONFIG page
Soft button
1
is always the
CONFIG
page, which is the “home page” of the digital effect in use. Here’s where you set the input and output levels, and if it’s a multieffect of any kind, the mix between them. But most importantly, this page lets you select the Digital Effects Type. There are 28 different configuration types available, each of which fall into one of four categories: Single, Dual Stereo, Dual
Mono and Multi Chain.
The Configuration page displays a graphic of the effect block or blocks being used. If a multi-effect is used, the display will also show you the order of the multi-effects that the audio will pass through and whether this is a Stereo or Dual configuration
(more about specific configurations later in this Chapter).
Parameter pages
Soft buttons
2
through
6
are reserved for selecting the current configuration’s Edit
Pages: each configuration can have up to five pages of editable parameters. Here’s where you make the effects sound different—long or short decays, fast or slow speed, etc. The parameter pages are labeled differently depending on the type of effect.
204 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
MOD page
Soft button
8
brings you to the
MOD
page. As with any of the other modulation options on the A6, you can use any of the 79 modulation sources to increase or decrease the level of the destinations, which are the inputs to the digital effects:
DFX SEND LEFT
DFX SEND RIGHT
DFX SEND L&R
DFX PAN
Note that modulating these will have no effect if that parameter doesn’t exist in the particular configuration. For example, there is no PAN in the Large Hall configuration. Single Configurations are fed by a mix of the Left and Right digital effects busses, so their input level may be controlled by modulating DFX SEND L&R; there will be little effect if you modulate only the Left or Right send.
Note that if you’ve edited an effect, changing to a new Program or Mix without first pressing the
STORE
button will result in the loss of changes.
If you want to hear what the effect sounded like before your changes, the
COMPARE
button will work for
Distortions and Effects as well.
E
DITING
D
IGITAL
E
FFECTS
A Configuration is made up of one or more effects. Each of the Programs and Mixes of the Andromeda contains it own Digital Effects Configuration. When you want to create your own effect from scratch, the first thing you must decide is which
Configuration Type you wish to use.
T
O SELECT A
D
IGITAL
E
FFECTS
C
ONFIGURATION
T
YPE
:
1. Enter Digital Effects Edit mode by pressing the
DIGITAL EFFECTS CONFIG
button on the top panel. The CONFIG page will be displayed.
2.
Turn soft knob
8
to select one of the 28 types with the
TYPE
parameter.
The abbreviated name of the effects will show in the display above the knob; when you stop on one for a moment, the entire configuration will be displayed with its full name.
After you’ve adjusted the send and output levels of the effect, you can then change the parameters of each effect block, just as you can on any external effect processor.
That’s all there is to it. Now you can start editing the effect’s parameters, and having some real fun!
For information on the individual configurations, see page 211.
Remember: If you decide you want to select a different Program, you can always do so by pressing one of the Program keys. However, if you select another Program after making changes and without storing the Program back into memory, the changes you have made will be lost.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
205
Chapter 10: Using Effects
E
DITING
E
FFECT
P
ARAMETERS
C
HOOSING A
P
ARAMETER
P
AGE
To select an effects edit page, press a soft button under the page “tab” on the bottom row of the display. In single effects, these pages are named
PARAM1, PARAM2,
etc.
In a multieffect each parameter page is named after the effect “block” it controls:
PLATE1 PLATE2
etc. The total number of Parameter pages depends on which Effect
Type the Program uses. The currently-selected page tab will have a box around it like this:
PARAM1
Once you’ve entered a parameter page, the display shows up to six parameters at once. Each parameter is displayed as a bar graph of its current value, relative to its minimum and maximum values. The current value of a parameter is shown numerically just under the bar graph. If the parameter is turned off,
OFF
will display in that section instead. Below the Parameter Value Row is the Parameter Name Row, with the abbreviated names of the parameter (which are explained individually later in this chapter). The complete name of the currently-selected parameter is shown on the right side of the display, under the effect type.
C
HANGING AN
I
NDIVIDUAL
P
ARAMETER
Selection of a parameter (such as DECAY , BOOST or LPF on the middle row of the display) happens automatically when you touch the soft knob for that parameter. As you adjust a parameter, both its numerical value and bargraph will change in relation to the slider’s position.
Tip: To make a small change to a parameter, you can repeatedly press the page’s soft button, and each parameter on the page will be selected in turn. Its name will be displayed in reverse type like this:
DECAY
Then, you can use the
▲ or
▼ buttons to change the value by small amounts.
206 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
MOD: M
ODULATING
E
FFECTS
S
END
/O
UTPUT
Pressing an effect’s
MOD
button on the top panel, or pressing soft button
8
( MOD ) while on any Effects Edit page displays a Modulation page for the Analog Distortion or
Digital Effects systems. Here you are able to select up to two sources that can be used to modulate output levels of the Analog Distortion or Digital Effects sections.
The Modulation page will display the modulation destination(s) and its sources, along with LEVEL , OFFSET and ENABLE controls. Pressing the
MOD
key on the top panel of the Analog Distortion or Digital Effects section has the same effect as turning ENABLE on and off on the display. Turn soft knob
1
to set the SOURCE for the mod from among the 79 possible choices.
When a mod source is selected, its effect on the destination is heard instantly while scrolling through the list. Any changes made will remain active so long as you do not switch Programs or Mixes. They will only be saved when you press the
STORE
button and save the entire Program or Mix.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
207
Chapter 10: Using Effects
T
UTORIAL
: H
OW TO
E
DIT A
R
EVERB
The best way to learn a new piece of gear is to start using it in your studio. This section is designed to teach you how to edit your own effects using normal day-today examples. Remember that programs are subjective and these are just guidelines.
If the program sounds weird when you’re all done, change it - that’s what the soft knobs are for!
You can use the following section to edit any Program or Mix in the Andromeda.
But to get started, use a basic bass or pad patch that doesn’t have many effects to begin with. Whatever its effect type is, we’re going to change it to a simple reverb.
This will be a typical large, warm hall program, with a lot of space to swim around.
S
ET THE
T
YPE AND
A
UDIO
L
EVELS
1. If it’s not on already, press the
EFFECTS ON/OFF
switch to turn the LED on.
2.
Enter Digital Effects Edit mode by pressing the
DIGITAL EFFECTS CONFIG
button on the top panel. The CONFIG page will be displayed.
3.
Turn soft knob
8
(the TYPE parameter) fully counter-clockwise to select LG HALL
(Large Hall).
4. Increase the
SEND
level to about
80
using soft knob
1
, and the
OUT
level to
80 using soft knob
7
.
At this point, you will probably be able to hear reverb when you play the keyboard.
5.
Press soft button
2
( PARAM1 ).
You’ll now see six different parameters in the display.
S
ET THE
R
EVERB
’
S
D
ECAY AND
T
ONE
The quickest way to change the sound of any reverb program is to change the Decay and LPF (Low Pass Filter) parameters. The Decay time (soft knob
1
on this page) dictates the size of the room, and the LPF (soft knob
4
) emulates the wall surfaces. To simulate a large castle chamber with a few tapestries and other soft surfaces, we’ll set the decay fairly long and the LPF relatively low. Don’t worry if the decay time seems long, we can do other things to trim it down later.
6.
Set the
DECAY
to around 4.638 (seconds) using soft knob
1
.
7.
Set the LPF to 5.650 (kHz) using soft knob
4
.
Our next step is editing the Density (
DENS
) and Diffusion (
DIFF
) parameters. These are less obvious to hear, but can make a big difference on your sound. Density (soft knob
5
) affects how smooth the attack will be, and can approximate different surface textures. A very high density would be good for simulating a polished marble room, for example, and lower densities would simulate a rougher surface with more discrete echoes. A Program with a very fast Attack and Decay can be a big help when programming Density and Diffusion; it’s much easier to hear than on a sustained sound—but don’t change Programs now or you’ll lose your changes so far! Play the keyboard while moving the Density up and down with soft knob
5
to hear its effect on the hall.
8.
Set the Density ( DENS ) to 74% for this room - not too rough, but not too glassy either.
208 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
The Diffusion parameter (soft knob
6
) sets how smooth the decay will be. Used in conjunction with the Density parameter, it can be used to approximate hundreds of room textures. Again, use the keyboard to check if the room is getting too ripply or too glassy.
9.
Set the Diffusion ( DIFF ) to 78%.
S
ET THE
R
EVERB
P
REDELAY
Our next step is editing the Pre-delay parameters on
PARAM2
. (We’ll come back to the
Bass Boost parameters once the program is structured better.)
10. Press soft button
3
( PARAM2 )
Pre-delay was originally used to simulate the delay before hearing reverberation in a large hall. However, in modern reverb program it is used more for effect. You can use predelay on a bass sound to make the initial attack clearer. You can also leak some non-predelayed reverb using the Pre-delay Mix (
PDMIX
) if you want. For this program, let’s try a Pre-delay Time ( PDTIME ) of 32ms with 100% mix for a splash of reverb.
11. Turn soft knob
1
until the value of
PDTIME
is 32.
12. Turn soft knob
2
(
PDMIX
) all the way up (100).
C
HANGE THE
T
ONE OF THE
R
EVERB
D
ECAY
The Low and High Frequency Damping parameters are controlled by soft knobs
4
and
5
on this page (
LDAMP
and
HDAMP
). The damping parameters interact with the
Decay time according to frequency. In a hall with no high frequency damping, the high frequencies will “sizzle” with a long decay. With no low frequency damping, the low frequencies will boom with a long decay, as in a large cement parking garage. Raising the frequency of the Low damping will cut the decays below that frequency (like adding bass traps to the hall), and lowering the frequency of the High
Damping will cut the decays above the frequency (like adding drapes and couches to the hall).
For this room, leave Low Damping off and set High Damping for 2.14kHz as follows:
13. Turn soft knob
4
all the way off ( LDAMP = OFF ).
14. Turn soft knob
5
to set the High Frequency Damping ( HDAMP = 2.140
).
Remember that if you set the High Damping higher than the input LPF, it will do almost nothing. Notice how the apparent decay drops off when you do this, and that the room starts to sound more natural.
Press soft button
4
( PARAM3 ) to see the last parameters of the Large Hall Reverb program. Swirl (soft knob
1
of this page) is an effect which simulates moving walls.
Set to a low value, it can add subtle movement to your reverb sound. Set high, it adds chorusing to the room. we’ll leave it off in this example. We’re not looking for a gated reverb sound, so we’ll leave Gate set to zero (otherwise, it will “chop off” the reverb sound once it reaches a certain point).
0 60%
SWIRL DEPTH
0 0 0
GATE HOLD RELEAS
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
209
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Now we’re ready to go back to the
PARAM1
page, parameters 2 and 3. Bass Boost can be useful for adding a little warmth to a hall program. By setting the frequency to
237Hz and the Level to 100, we can add a touch of warmth to our hall program.
15. Press soft button
2
(
PARAM1
) to return to that page.
16. Using the soft knobs, set
BOOST
to
100 and
BASSF
to
0.237.
A
DJUST THE
M
IX
Now, you can go back to the CONFIG page and adjust the SEND and OUTPUT levels for whatever balance of “wet and dry” you want.
Setting Input Levels
For quietest operation, it’s best in most cases to leave the input level high, and if you want less reverb, to turn the output level down. The input level should be high enough to be well above the noise floor to get the best dynamic range, but not so high that it clips the digital effects engine itself. If you see the word
CLIP
appear in the lower right side of an effects page, lower the SEND level on the CONFIG page.
Setting Output Levels
On the other hand, it is possible to set the Output so high that it can clip the final summing amps of the Andromeda. If this happens, you’ll hear it. Turn off the
EFFECTS ON/OFF
switch to make sure it’s the effect, and not something in the program.
If it’s the effect, restructure your gain. Sometimes this means going all the way back to the levels of the
PRE FILTER MIX
.
To “SOLO” the Effects
To hear the reverb and only the reverb while you’re listening to the Main Outputs, simply press the
OUTPUT
switch on the far right of the top panel to remove the program audio from the Main Output. The effects will still be feeding the output, without any “dry” signal mixed in.
210 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
D
IGITAL
E
FFECTS
A
RCHITECTURE
This section describes the 28 configuration categories for the Digital Effects system.
T
HE
S
IGNAL
F
LOW
T
HROUGH THE
E
FFECTS
S
ECTION
VCA
(ENV 3)
VOICE MIX
PAN
OUTPUT
AUX/MAIN
SWITCH
VOICE MIX
LEVEL
SEND
MAIN
ANALOG
DISTORTION
OUTPUT
DFX2
DFX1
DIGITAL
EFFECTS
MAIN OUT
MAIN OUT
SEND PAN/BLEND*
(in some configurations)
OUT
As you can see in the flow chart above, the effects section gets its input from the
Voice Mix Level pot. At this point, the signal is mono. This signal appears at the
SEND controls of both effects units. The Digital Effects unit can receive signal from its own
SEND
control, but even if this is all the way down, it can still receive signal from the Analog Distortion section's output. Now that you understand where the input to the Digital Effects comes from, let's look at what goes on inside the Digital Effects system:
S
INGLE
A Single configuration consists of one effect. These configurations utilize complex, processor-intensive effect algorithms providing the best quality possible for each effect type supported.
Effects that use this configuration:
Large Hall Chamber
Hall Reverb
Room Reverb
Ping Pong Delay
Ambience
Plate Reverb
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Large Plate
Mono Delay
Nonlinear Reverb
211
Chapter 10: Using Effects
S
TEREO
The Stereo Room, Quad Pitch Shifter and Quad Chorus configurations are special single algorithms that treat the incoming left and right signals differently, but still create a synthesized stereo image from each side, depending on the setting of the
Width control. If the width is set to 99%, a signal appearing at the left input (as set by the PAN control inside the effect display—NOT the control on the Voice Mix output section) will be processed and sent to only the left output; if the width is set to
00%, the processed signal will appear in stereo at both outputs. Stereo
Chorus/Flanger
has two separate mono signal paths that are controlled by
synchronized parameters
to give a total stereo effect.
Stereo Chorus/Flanger is not always a Stereo Effect, because each side of the chorus feeds only one side of the output. Depending on its input
PAN
setting, it can assign the chorus to either or both channels. Unlike the Dual Mono configurations, however, it doesn't have independent control of the parameters for each side, or left and right output level controls.
PAN
Effects that use this configuration:
Stereo Room
Quad Chorus
Quad Pitch Shifter
Stereo Chorus/Flanger
212 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
D
UAL
E
FFECTS
: P
ARALLEL
Parallel configurations consist of two discrete “side-by-side” mono-in/stereo-out effects. These configurations are identified by the presence of a “+” in their name, and by a BLEND control between the input and the effect. In each case, the left output of the Blend control is routed to one effect, while the right output is routed to the other. The stereo outputs of both effects are then summed together to the outputs.
BLEND
Effects that use this configuration:
Room+Hall
Plate+Hall
Room+Chorus
Room+Plate
Room+Delay
Room+Flange
D
UAL
E
FFECTS
: M
ONO
Dual Mono configurations consist of two discrete “side-by-side” mono-in/mono-out effects. These configurations are identified by the presence of a “:” in their name, and by separate left and right output controls, one for each effect. In each case, a
PAN control allows you to set how much of each effect you want on each side. left input is routed to one effect, while the right input is routed to the other. Unlike the parallel effects, in these mono effects the left signal only feeds the left output, and the right signal only feeds the right output.
Chorus:Chorus
and
Delay:Delay
have
independent control of the two effects
.
PAN
Effects that use this configuration:
Chorus:Chorus
Delay:Delay
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
213
Chapter 10: Using Effects
M
ULTI
C
HAIN
The Multi Chain configurations provide two or three stereo effects, which are connected in series: one feeding the next in the chain. These configurations are identified by a “
>
” symbol in their name, for example CHRS
>
RM (Chorus->Room).
These individual effect types provide excellent sound quality but are less processorintensive than their Single configuration equivalents, since the Digital Signal
Processor is accommodating more than one effect at a time. In other words, the reverb effect in the “Delay
→
Room” configuration is not as “dense” as the Single configuration called “Room Reverb”.
Effects that use this configuration:
Lezlie
→
Room Delay
→
Room
Chorus
→
Room Room
→
Flange
214
Effects that use this configuration:
MULTI 3 (Flange>Delay>Room)
In the case of Multi Chain configurations, the MIX parameter of each effect determines what the following effect receives at its input(s). For example, it is possible to use the “Delay
→
Room” configuration (where Effect 1 is a mono delay and Effect 2 is a reverb), and have only the dry, undelayed signal going to the reverb.
This is done by setting the first effect’s
MIX
parameter to
0.00.
This means that the previous effect chain is bypassed and all the signal is coming directly from the effects
SEND
control. A setting of
100.00
(full up) means that the input comes entirely from the previous effect block—in this case, that the entire signal to the reverb is delayed.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
C
ONFIGURATIONS
& P
ARAMETER
D
ESCRIPTIONS
This section provides detailed descriptions of the available Digital Effects and their related parameters. A comprehensive Table of Parameters is provided at the end of this section.
R
EVERBS
Reverb Configurations
Reverb is made up of a large number of distinct echoes, called reflections. In a natural acoustic space, each reflection’s amplitude and brightness decays over time.
This decaying action is influenced by the room size, the location of the sound source in the room, the hardness of the walls, and other factors. The A6’s Digital Effects system offers the following types of reverberation:
Large Hall
This is a simulation of a large concert hall. Halls tend to be large rooms with lots of reflective surfaces, where sounds can swim around, changing timbre over time. This is a classic reverb which sounds good on just about anything.
Hall Reverb
This algorithm is similar to the one above, but the sound is not as “thick” and there are programmable early reflections. You might use this configuration instead of the
Large Hall to get different hall characters or shapes. This configuration also has twice the predelay time of the Large Hall, 500ms instead of 250ms.
Room Reverb
Room Reverb gives you the sound of a medium-size studio room. It has a quick attack and programmable reflections. It's a good, tight, instrumental sound.
Chamber
Similar to the Room Reverb, this algorithm simulates a polished live reverb chamber.
It differs from the Room in character; the chamber is smoother and more transparent.
It sounds great on many programs, especially if you’re looking for a non-obtrusive sound.
Ambience
This algorithm simulates a very small room. It can be used when just a slight amount of ambient character is needed to augment a sound. This works great for percussive programs or anywhere you want to add space without a lot of long reverb.
Stereo Room
This algorithm is a true stereo room for use with stereo sources. The width is programmable and simulates the space between two microphones in a large room.
The higher the width value gets, the closer the room gets to being two mono rooms with no bleed to each other.
Large Plate
This is a simulation of a classic echo plate, a 4’ by 8’ suspended sheet of metal with transducers at either end used to produce reverb. Popular in the 1970’s, it still prized for its transparent sound. This algorithm uses the most processing available for a truly realistic reverb plate simulation. It works well for a lush , classic rock and roll sound.
Plate
Plate is a variation on Large Plate. This version is not as “thick” and can sound better on shorter, more percussive patches.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
215
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Nonlinear
This reverb effect’s direction can be set either forwards or backwards. Selecting the forward direction provides a classic “Gated” digital reverb sound. Selecting the reverse direction gives you a backwards reverb sound. A popular trick in the 80’s was to record the reverb with the tape flipped over, so it would play backwards in the mix. The reverse reverb is a useful effect for percussive sounds -adding space without washing out the instrument.
Reverb Parameters
Most of the reverb effects in the A6 operate under the same set of control parameters, which are listed and described in this section. However, reverbs which use more processing power (i.e. the Single configuration reverbs) provide more parameters which take advantage of their extra processing power; parameters which are not found in the other, smaller reverb algorithms. For example, Reverberation Swirl is a parameter found only in the Single configuration reverb types. Here is a list of all reverb parameters found in the Digital Effects system:
Decay
The Reverb Decay determines how long the Reverb will sound before it dies away.
When using the Reverse Reverb effect type, the Reverb Decay parameter controls the
Reverse Time. This parameter dictates the size of the space you are emulating: small rooms have a short decay (500ms-2 Sec) while large halls have a long decay (2-6 Sec).
Low Pass Filter (LPF)
The lowpass filter can be set between 029 Hz and 41.3 kHz, and attenuates all frequencies above this value by 6dB per octave. The lower the setting, the less high frequencies are allowed to pass thru to the reverb effect.
The LPF simulates the reflectivity of the space you’re emulating. A tiled room may roll off around 12kHz, where a living room or a warm church might roll off at 6kHz.
An instrument may also dictate how “bright” the reverb should be. If you want to add sustain to a program without cluttering up the mix with reverb from the initial filter attack and initial transients, set the LPF around 2 or 4kHz.
High Pass Filter/Low Shelf (LSHELF/HPF--Plates only)
Classic plate reverbs often have a midrangy twang to them. Since this frequency bump is part of the character of a plate reverb, the A6 allows you to roll off the highs
(see above) and low frequencies on Plate reverbs. The High Pass Filter (HPF) parameter controls the frequency where the low end will begin to roll off (at a rate of
6dB per octave). The Low Shelf controls how deep the cut will be - from barely noticable (high value) to completely cut (low value).
216 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Bass Boost (Halls only)
The Hall reverb type allows you to add bass to the input signal before processing.
This can make the halls sound “warmer”, or even add rumble at extreme settings.
The
BASSF
parameter selects the highest frequency which will be boosted, and the
BOOST
parameter sets the amount of boost, up to 6 dB.
Pre-delay (PDTIME)
All the reverb effects have pre-delay parameters. Pre-delay slightly delays the reverb itself up to 500 ms, so that the dry signal more easily stands out from the reverb. A bit of pre-delay can make certain instruments sound bigger. It is also useful when simulating big spaces, where the echoes may take a moment to build up. You can also use predelay in conjunction with early reflections to dictate various room shapes.
Pre-delay Mix (PDMIX)
This allows you to balance the amount of Pre-delay to Direct Signal as a percentage of each. This gives you the ability to hear a bit of the Reverb before the Pre-Delayed
Reverb sounds, making the delay less apparent.
Density (DENS)
Density controls how smooth the reverb decay and early reflections sound. When set for very low values, the decay is “bumpier” and simulates a large room with lots of distinct echoes. If the density is set high, the reverb will be very smooth, like a chamber or tiled room. Try using lower density settings on sustained sounds, and higher density for percussive sounds.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
217
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Diffusion (DIFF)
Diffusion determines the “thickness” of the reverb sound by adding more reflections to the reverb’s decay. With lower diffusion settings, you may be able to hear the individual echoes that make up the overall reverb sound. With higher diffusion settings, the echoes increase in number and blend together, washing out the reverb’s decay.
Frequency Damping - Low & High (LDAMP and HDAMP)
These two parameters allow you to control the equalization of the reverb’s decay separately for both the low and high frequencies. This means that you have control over the tonal shape of the Reverb itself over time, being able to cut the high frequencies if the effect is too bright, and being able to cut the lows if the effect is too boomy. These parameters allow you to simulate different surfaces of a room or hall, with softer surfaces absorbing high frequencies and harder rooms (parking garages, tiled rooms) diffusing low frequencies. Example: If a room has lots of hanging drapes, the high frequencies will decay faster than the lower frequencies.
Note that the Low Pass Frequency and High Damping parameters are related. If your
LPF is set for 8kHz, and the High Damping parameter is set above 8kHz, you won’t hear much of a change from this parameter. This is because the high frequencies have already been rolled off, so there’s nothing left to dampen. In most cases, make sure that the LPF is set above the high damping frequency to get the most out of this effect. However, since reverb is a random function, some high frequencies can be generated over the course of a long decay which are higher than the LPF. In these cases, setting the High Damping at the same frequency or higher than the LPF will attain audible results. In either case, by using the LPF and High Damping in conjunction, you can yield a more authentic room sound.
ER: Early Reflections – SPREAD, SHAPE and ELEVEL
The Early Reflections of a reverb add attack to the room and dictate the room’s size.
218 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
The Shape parameter controls how the reflections fade out over time. Different shapes will dictate the shape of the room and the intensity of the attack. The Early
Reflection shapes are diagramed below:
These shapes range from 0, which fades immediately and is good for small rooms, to
2, which builds and then falls to approximate a hall, to 4, which builds up slowly for a long “bloom” reverb. These shapes can then be scaled using the Spread parameter, explained below, to better emulate various spaces.
The ELevel parameter controls how loud the early reflections will be compared to the reverb’s “body”. The Spread parameter scales how close the reflections are to each other. If Spread is set for 500ms, the last reflection will be 500ms away from the first and the room will seem larger. Use Spread in conjunction with Shape to define the character of your reverberant spaces.
Depth
The Depth parameter makes the reverb sound wider and deeper. At 0%, the reverb sounds like its coming from the speakers and slightly behind. At settings of 60% and above, the reverb sounds like it’s around you and farther behind the speakers. Use a low setting for better mono or surround encoding compatibility and higher values for a huge stereo sound.
Width (Stereo Room only)
This setting simulates the distance between two microphones in a stereo room. When set to 100%, you get two mono rooms. When set to 0%, you get a mono in, stereo out room. When set anywhere between these values, a sound which starts on one side reverberates there then bleeds over to the other side.
Swirl
This parameter is very useful for adding randomness to the decay of a reverb when set to a low value. When set to a high value, it creates a more dramatic chorusing effect as the reverb decays.
TIME and DIRECTION (Nonlinear only)
Gating is the process which abruptly cuts off the reverb’s decay for a more “choppy” sound. This effect was very popular on drums in the ‘80s because it makes them sound HUGE. It is achieved by dropping the level of the signal very rapidly after the initial attack making a short, sharp sound. The Nonlinear configuration is permanently in a gated mode, with the TIME parameter in place of the more typical
DECAY time; other reverbs may be gated using the GATE parameter (typically on the last parameter page).
The DIR parameter (soft knob 1 of the PARAM2 page) can be set to FORWARD or
REVERSE
. In Forward, it's a classic gated sound; in Reverse, it's reversed as if the reverb were coming from a backwards tape of the input. The Hold Time determines
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
219
Chapter 10: Using Effects
how long the gate will be held open before it begins to turn off; this can be set from
100 to 600 ms.
GATE (Reverb Gate Level Damping)
This parameter creates the effect of plugging an expander/gate on the output of a reverb, giving the famous gated reverb effect. GATE essentially sets the threshold of the expander. When set to zero, there is no cutoff by the gate and the reverb decays normally; higher values of GATE will "chop off" the reverb at earlier and earlier points. The GATE parameter interacts with the following two parameters:
HOLD (Gate Hold Time)
This sets the amount of time the signal will be "held open" after the gate threshold is crossed. If the signal remains below the threshold level and the hold time is completed, the release segment will begin:
RELEAS (Gate Release Time)
When the gate closes, this sets the curve of how abruptly the effect will be closed down: almost immediately, or fading away gradually.
D
ELAYS
Delay Configurations
Delay provides a discrete repetition of a signal. By adding feedback within the effect, the delayed signal can repeat many times, with each successive decay softer than its predecessor. Each of the Delay types allow you to adjust their delay time in milliseconds (1/1000 of a second). The A6 offers the following types of delay:
Mono Delay
This Single configuration provides delay of signal up to 5499 ms (5 1/2 seconds). The delay time can be adjusted separately by 100ms, 10ms and 1 ms increments.
Feedback is also available to increase the complexity of the signal. You also have high and low frequency cutting, which gives you the ability to equalize the effect’s decay.
This can help emulate an old tape-style echo where each succesive echo is darker than the previous one. Also available are Density, Modulation (chorusing), Tremolo and Autopan.
Delay:Delay
This Single configuration provides two separate right and left channel delays which can be individually adjusted for delay time, feedback and high and low cutting. The delay time can be adjusted separately by 100ms, 10ms and 1 ms increments.
Ping Pong Delay
So called because the output bounces from left to right in stereo with the speed determined by the delay time. Again, low and high frequency cut is available. The delay time can be adjusted separately by 100ms, 10ms and 1 ms increments.
MultiTap Delay
This is like having five delays at once. Each of the “taps” have individual delay, level, panning and feedback controls. By adjusting the delay time of each tap, you can create sophisticated rhythms.
220 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Delay Parameters
Some of these parameters (Feedback, etc.) are found in all of the Delay configurations, where others are found only on the single delays. Following is a list of all Delay parameters found in the A6:
Delay Time (100MS, 10MS, and 1MS)
In most cases, the delay time is separated into three parameters for fine-tuning the time: 100mS (milliseconds), 10mS, and 1mS. Maximum delay time depends on the configuration; the Mono Delay offers up to 5499mS of delay while the Ping Pong delay offers only 2499mS.
Feedback (FDBK)
The Feedback parameter controls the regeneration of the delay. If feedback is set for
0, you will only hear one delay. If it is set for 99, the delay will continue to repeat for days. The feedback can also be set for negative values (-1 to -99). Negative values produce out-of-phase delays for a thinner sound.
Low Cut/High Cut (LOCUT/HICUT)
These parameters filter the input and feedback of the delay. They can be used to make a “warmer” or “thinner” delay sound. The filters can each be set for Off or
29Hz to 41.3kHz and they roll off at 6dB per octave.
Density (DENS)
Similar to the Density parameter on the reverb programs, this adds several quick delays to the initial delay time. This effect “smears” the delayed sound, so the result is more like a small room than a discrete echo.
Rate/Depth
These parameters work like the pitch modulation parameters on the Chorus/Flange configurations (see next section). This allows you to add chorusing to a delay for a richer effect. Used in conjunction to the tremolo and autopan parameters, you can even create unique panning chorus effects. To bypass this effect, simply set the Depth to 000.
Tremolo Rate/Depth (TREMR, TREMD)
This effect adds a tremolo effect to the delay return. You can use it as a simple tremolo by setting the delay time to 000mS and the Tremolo depth and Delay Mix to
100%. Or, you can use it in conjunction with the delay to produce delays which fade in and out. Rate controls the speed and Depth controls the intensity of the effect.
Pan Rate/Depth (PANR, PAND)
These parameters control an autopanner which effects the delayed signal. Like the
Tremolo effect, you can set the delay time to 000mS for a simple autopan effect or use it with the delay for panning delays. Rate controls the speed and Depth controls the intensity of the effect. Make sure you have the OUT level set high enough to hear the effect of the pan or tremolo.
Tip: Note that all of the modulation effects have similar Rate scales. By setting the rates to the same values (or multiples of each other; double, quadruple, ...) you can
“sync” them to each other. Use this trick to create swirling, panning choruses, flanges which fade in and out every cycle, or anything else you can come up with.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
221
Chapter 10: Using Effects
P
ITCH
E
FFECTS
Pitch Configurations
The Pitch effects alter the pitch of a signal in various ways to produce “layered” timbres that are more complex than the original signal. Although some of these effects can sound similar to one another depending on the parameter settings, each is achieved differently and can be quite dramatic under the right circumstances. Pitch effects are achieved by splitting the signal into at least two parts, affecting the pitch of one of the parts, then mixing them back together. This eventual mixing is essential since the overall sound of the effect is achieved by the actual difference between the dry, uneffected signal and the effects signal. The various types of Pitch change are:
Chorus/Flange
Chorus and Flange are combined into one configuration, since the only difference between these effects is the time range of delay the effect "scans", so they sound slightly different. A predelay of 0-14 will produce a flanger, and a delay of 15 or more will chorus. Note that on Choruses and Flangers, the “Wet” and “Dry” signals need to be mixed in order to hear the effect—in other words, if the Program/Mix is not assigned to the
MAIN OUTPUT
, you'll hear a vibrato instead of a chorus or flange.
The Chorus/Flange effect is achieved by splitting the signal into three parts with a dry signal and a separate Detuning section for both left and right channels, offset from one another. The detuning is further effected by being modulated by an LFO
(low frequency oscillator) which causes the detuning to vary. Many variables are available in this scheme: the Predelay can be varied, the LFO depth can be varied, the
LFO speed can be varied, and a portion of the detuned signal can be fed back to the input to increase the effect. Finally, the waveform shape of the LFO can be changed from a smooth sinewave, to a more abrupt triangle wave to make the pitch detuning more pronounced.
Flanging is similar to chorusing , but modulates the delayed signal over a much shorter delay range (typically 0-12 ms). This produces a “jet airplane”-like sound because of the high-frequency comb filtering that sweeps across the frequency range as the delay varies. The flange modulation sweep can be triggered by the audio input in order to sync up with the rhythm of your playing. You can adjust the attack and release threshold of this audio triggering function.
222
The A6 has filters on the input and the feedback loop to tailor the frequency sweep of the effect.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Quad Chorus
Quad Chorus modulates four delayed signals, each with independent rate and depth controls. Each of the four signals has a separate Predelay variable, allowing you to change the “rhythm” of the phasing.
Quad Pitch Shifter (4 PITCH)
The Pitch Shifter effect transposes the pitch of the incoming signal by a fixed amount.
It is useful for creating parallel harmonies, detuning, chorusing, and special effects.
The Semi parameter shifts the pitch in increments of one half step, with a range of up or down one octave. The Fine parameter detunes the signal in very fine increments, with a range of up or down one half step. Also available are Delay and Feedback parameters. The Delay parameter delays the shifted signal up to 250 ms, or can be used with the Feedback parameter to produce decaying arpeggio effects. There are also Low Cut and High Cut filters in the feedback loop which can be used to alter the timbre of the sound as it repeats. The Quad Pitch Shift configuration provides two discrete pitch shifters, each with their own Pan and Level control.
Both the Quad Chorus and Quad Pitch Shifter have stereo Input and stereo Output routing. The Left Input feeds Voice 1 and the Right Input feeds Voice 4. Voices 2 and
3 are fed by a mix of the Left and Right Input. These Voices are similarly panned in the Outputs: Voices 1,2,3 and 4 are panned from hard Left to Hard Right.
Chorus:Chorus
This is a dual mono configuration with two independent mono Chorus/Flangers.
Even though the configuration is called Chorus:Chorus, you can use it as a dual
Flanger, or even a Chorus and a Flange. Both the controls and the I/O are separate, so stereo imaging will be maintained. By setting the left and right sides to slightly different settings, you can achieve a wide stereo image.
Chorus
This is a mono, less processor-intensive version of the Stereo Chorus effect, used in
Multi Chain configurations (Chorus
→
Room, Room
→
Flange,
Flange
→
Delay
→
Room) and Dual configurations (Room+Chorus).
Lezlie
With the Lezlie effect (found in the Lezlie
→
Room configuration), the pitch change block becomes a rotating speaker simulator. This effect was extremely popular during the 1960’s and was achieved by mechanically rotating the speakers to produce complex timbral changes. The Lezlie speaker system is most often used with rock organs, but is occasionally used on other kinds of programs as well. Parameters include: Motor on/off, Speed, which can be slow or fast; and High Rotor Level, which lets you attenuate the volume of the high frequencies. When switching the
Lezlie effect on and off, or when changing the speed between fast and slow, the effect will ramp rather than change abruptly, just as a true Lezlie speaker system would do.
By raising the High Rotor Level, you can really make this effect scream.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
223
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Pitch Parameters
Rate
This is the rate that the delay time is modulated. It is adjustable from 0.00 to 6.47Hz.
Depth
This controls how deep the flange or chorusing will be. It affects how wide a range of delay time is swept, and is adjustable from 0-250.
Feedback (FDBK)
This is the amount of regeneration (output fed back to the input) in the
Chorus/Flanger, from -99 to 99%. Negative values produce out-of-phase feedback, which has a thinner, hollow sound.
Rate, Depth and Feedback are always related
, and you will probably find yourself adjusting all of them at the same time. In general, slower rates sound better with high depth settings than faster ones, and lots of feedback will sound better with lower depth settings.
THRU0 ("Thru Zero")
This control delays the input signal to better simulate tape flanging. When flanging was done using two tape machines, it was possible for one to be behind the other, catch up and then go past the other. This is called passing “through zero”. The
“zero” point is when both signals were in perfect synchronization.
Since the A6 is digitally simulating the flanging effect, it normally cannot provide the through zero effect. The “Thru0” parameter found in the A6’s flanging effects lets you create the appearance of the effected signal passing through the zero point. It does this by actually delaying the uneffected signal by as much as 12 milliseconds
(an amount virtually undetectable to the human ear). This allows the wet signal to move “behind” the dry signal as it cycles. To hear this effect properly, the
MAIN OUT
of the program must be off.
Low Pass Filter (LPF)
This filter allows you to roll off any high frequencies going into the Chorus/Flanger.
This allows you to get a “warmer” flanger sound, or to simulate vintage effects.
Feedback Highpass and Lowpass Filters (FBHPF and FBLPF)
These controls filter out the high and low frequencies in the feedback loop only. By rolling off the lowest and highest frequencies, you can add lots of feedback without getting a metallic ring or low frequency thump to the sound.
Predelay
Depending on the type of effect, predelays may appear on the Parameter Strip as
1PDTIM
(first predelay time of the 4-element Quad Chorus),
LPDLY
or
RPDLY
(left and right predelay in a stereo chorus), and similar variables. In any case, this controls the amount of delay before the modulation effect. If you set it below 15mS, you get a
Flanger. If you set it for 15 mS or more, you get a Chorus. The Predelay range is typically up to 250mS.
224 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Wave
The Wave parameter sets the waveform of the Chorus/Flanger’s sweep, either Sine or Triangle.
Triggered Flange
The Flanger effects can be Triggered by the input audio signal. This allows you to start the flanger at the top of the measure and other rhythmic effects. It starts the
“sweep” of a flanger from the same point whenever it is triggered, and then runs until the next time you trigger it.
FLANGER SHAPE
TRIGGER TRIGGER
INPUT SIGNAL
ATTACK THRESHOLD
RELEASE THRESHOLD
This function is controlled by three parameters:
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
225
Chapter 10: Using Effects
TRIG
This selects which input to monitor to begin triggering. The choices are
OFF, Left, Right, or L&R.
ATTACK This parameter sets the level where the flange will “trigger” or reset.
When the audio goes above this level, the flanger will begin its sweep.
RELEAS
This is the level where the flanger stops listening to the input. When the flanger is triggered, it won’t trigger again until the input signal falls below the Release level then goes above the Attack level.
Width (Quad Chorus only)
The Width parameter adjusts the stereo width of the Quad Chorus output. A setting of 99% is full stereo, 0% is mono, and -99% is reverse stereo (The left input feeding voice 1 will be panned right).
Level (2LEVEL and 3LEVEL, Quad Chorus only)
The level of Voices 2 and 3. 1 and 4 are always set to 100%.
Motor, Speed, High Rotor Level (Lezlie only)
These three parameters control the sound of the rotary speaker simulation. Motor turns the spinning effect on or off, but does not bypass the effect - it will still be phased and filtered with the rotor on, frozen in its pan position. Speed toggles between Fast and Slow. On true rotary speakers, an organ player often switches between these speeds during a performance. High Rotor Level affects the tone of the effect. A rotary speaker usually has two segments: a spinning horn for high frequencies and a woofer firing into a spinning “scoop” for low frequencies. This parameter simulates moving a microphone closer to the high rotor.
226 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
T
ABLE OF
D
IGITAL
E
FFECTS
P
ARAMETERS
The following chart lists the parameters found on each page of each configuration.
Use this as a road map to locate a specific parameter you want to edit.
CONFIG
NAME
Large Hall
Hall Reverb
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1
PARAM2
PARAM3
DECAY
BOOST
BASSF
LPF
DENS
DIFF
PDTIME
PDMIX
LDAMP
HDAMP
SWIRL
DEPTH
GATE
HOLD
RELEAS
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1
PARAM2
PARAM3
DECAY
BOOST
BASSF
LPF
DENS
DIFF
PDTIME
PDMIX
LDAMP
HDAMP
SWIRL
DEPTH
SPREAD
SHAPE
ELEVEL
GATE
HOLD
RELEAS
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Reverb Decay Time
Bass Boost
Bass Boost Frequency
Input Low Pass Filter
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
Reverb Swirl
Reverb Depth
Gate Level
Gate Hold Time
Gate Release Time
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
1.33 - 229 sec
0 - 255 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29 Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 50
0 - 100%
0 - 100
0 - 500 msec
0 - 500 msec
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Reverb Decay Time
Bass Boost
Bass Boost Frequency
Input Low Pass Filter
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
Reverb Swirl
Reverb Depth
Early Reflection Spread
Early Reflection Shape
Early Reflection Level
Gate Level
Gate Hold Time
Gate Release Time
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
1.33 - 229 sec
0 - 255 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29 Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 50
0 - 100%
0 - 500 msec
0 - 4
0 - 99
0 - 100
0 - 500 msec
0 - 500 msec
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
227
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Stereo Room
Room Reverb
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
PAN
PARAM1
PARAM2
PARAM3
OUT
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
LDAMP
HDAMP
SWIRL
WIDTH
GATE
HOLD
RELEAS
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1
PARAM2
PARAM3
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
LDAMP
HDAMP
SPREAD
SHAPE
ELEVEL
SWIRL
DEPTH
GATE
HOLD
RELEAS
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Pan
Effects Output Level
Reverb Decay Time
Input Low Pass Filter
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
Reverb Swirl
Stereo Image Width
Gate Level
Gate Hold Time
Gate Release Time
0.00-100.00
-100.0- +100.00
0 - 100%
1.33 - 229 sec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 50
0 - 99%
0 - 100
0 - 500 msec
0 - 500 msec
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Reverb Decay Time
Input Low Pass Filter
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
Early Reflection Spread
Early Reflection Shape
Early Reflection Level
Reverb Swirl
Reverb Depth
Gate Level
Gate Hold Time
Gate Release Time
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
1.33 - 229 sec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 500 msec
0 - 4
0 - 99
0 - 50
0 - 100%
0 - 100
0 - 500 msec
0 - 500 msec
228 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
CONFIG
NAME
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
Chamber
AND Ambience
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1
PARAM2
PARAM3
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
LDAMP
HDAMP
SPREAD
SHAPE
ELEVEL
SWIRL
DEPTH
GATE
HOLD
RELEAS
Large Plate
AND Plate
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1
PARAM2
PARAM3
DECAY
LSHELF
HPF
LPF
DENS
DIFF
PDTIME
PDMIX
LDAMP
HDAMP
SWIRL
DEPTH
GATE
HOLD
RELEAS
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Reverb Decay Time
Input Low Pass Filter
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
Early Reflection Spread
Early Reflection Shape
Early Reflection Level
Reverb Swirl
Reverb Depth
Gate Level
Gate Hold Time
Gate Release Time
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
1.33 - 229 sec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 500 msec
0 - 4
0 - 99
0 - 50
0 - 100%
0 - 100
0 - 500 msec
0 - 500 msec
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Reverb Decay Time
Low Frequency Shelf
Input High-Pass Filter
Input Low-Pass Filter
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
Reverb Swirl
Reverb Depth
Reverb Gate
Reverb Gate Hold Time
Reverb Gate Release Time
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
567 msec - 61.6 sec
0 - 255 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 50
0 - 100% off, 1 - 100%
0 - 500 msec
0 - 500 msec
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
229
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Room + Hall
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
BLEND
ROOM1
ROOM2
RM OUT
HL OUT
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
LDAMP
HALL1
HALL2
HDAMP
DECAY
BOOST
BASSF
LPF
DENS
DIFF
PDTIME
PDMIX
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Blend
Room Output Level
Hall Output Level
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Pre-Delay Time
Room Pre-Delay Mix
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Low Frequency
Damping
Room High Frequency
Damping
Hall Reverb Decay Time
Hall Bass Boost
Hall Bass Boost Frequency
Hall Input Low-Pass Filter
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
0.00-100.00
±100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
1.00 - 75.8 sec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
1.97 - 135 sec
0 - 255 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
230 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Room + Plate
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
➟
CONFIG SEND
BLEND
ROOM1
ROOM2
RM OUT
PL OUT
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
LDAMP
PLATE1
PLATE2
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
HDAMP
DECAY
LSHELF
HPF
LPF
DENS
DIFF
PDTIME
PDMIX
LDAMP
HDAMP
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Blend
Room Output Level
Hall Output Level
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Pre-Delay Time
Room Pre-Delay Mix
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Low Frequency
Damping
Room High Frequency
Damping
Plate Reverb Decay Time
Low Frequency Shelf
Input High-Pass Filter
Input Low-Pass Filter
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
0.00-100.00
±100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
1.00 - 75.8 sec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
567 msec - 61.6 sec
0 - 255 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
231
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Plate + Hall
Nonlinear
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
BLEND
PLATE1
PL OUT
HL OUT
DECAY
LSHELF
PLATE2
HALL1
HALL2
HPF
LPF
DENS
DIFF
PDTIME
PDMIX
LDAMP
HDAMP
DECAY
BOOST
BFREQ
LPF
DENS
DIFF
PDTIME
PDMIX
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1
PARAM2
TIME
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DIR
DENS
DIFF
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Blend
Room Output Level
Hall Output Level
Plate Reverb Decay Time
Low Frequency Shelf
Input High-Pass Filter
Input Low-Pass Filter
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
Hall Reverb Decay Time
Hall Bass Boost
Hall Bass Boost Frequency
Hall Input Low-Pass Filter
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
0.00-100.00
±100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
567 msec - 61.6 sec
0 - 255 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
1.97 - 135 sec
0 - 255 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Nonlinear Reverb Time
Input Low Pass Filter
Pre-Delay Time
Pre-Delay Mix
Reverb Direction
Reverb Density
Reverb Diffusion
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
100 - 600 msec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
FORWARD, REVERSE
0 – 100%
0 – 100%
232 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Mono Delay
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1 100MS
10MS
1MS
FDBK
LOCUT
HICUT
PARAM2 DENS
RATE
DEPTH
PARAM3 TREMR
TREMD
PANR
PAND
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Delay Time Hundreds of milliseconds
Delay Time Tens Digit
Delay Time Ones Digit
Deay Feedback
Low Frequency Cutoff
Hi Frequency Cutoff
Reflection Density
Delay Modulation Rate
Delay Modulation Depth
Tremelo Rate
Tremelo Depth
Pan Rate
Pan Depth
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 54
0 - 9
0 - 9
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 100%
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 100%
Ping Pong Delay
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1 100MS
10MS
1MS
FDBK
LDAMP
HDAMP
PARAM2 DENS
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Delay Time Hundreds of milliseconds
Delay Time Tens Digit
Delay Time Ones Digit
Deay Feedback
Low Frequency Damping
High Frequency Damping
Reflection Density
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 54
0 - 9
0 - 9
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
233
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Multi Tap Delay
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
OUT
PARAM1 1TIME
1LEVEL
1PAN
1FDBK
PARAM2 2TIME
2LEVEL
2PAN
2FDBK
PARAM3 3TIME
3LEVEL
3PAN
3FDBK
MFDBK
PARAM4 4TIME
4LEVEL
4PAN
4FDBK
LOCUT
PARAM5 5TIME
5LEVEL
5PAN
5FDBK
HICUT
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Effects Output Level
Delay Time (First tap)
Delay Tap Output Level
Tap Pan
Delay Feedback
Delay Time (2nd tap)
Delay Tap Output Level
Tap Pan
Delay Feedback
Delay Time (3rd tap)
Delay Tap Output Level
Tap Pan
Delay Feedback
Master Feedback Scaler
(controls all)
Delay Time (4th tap)
Delay Tap Output Level
Tap Pan
Delay Feedback
Low Frequency Cutoff
Delay Time (4th tap)
Delay Tap Output Level
Tap Pan
Delay Feedback
Hi Frequency Cutoff
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
0 – 250 ms
0 - 99
± 50
– 99% to + 99%
0 – 250 ms
0 - 99
± 50
– 99% to + 99%
0 – 250 ms
0 - 99
± 50
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 100
0 – 250 ms
0 - 99
± 50
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 – 250 ms
0 - 99
± 50
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
234 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Delay:Delay
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
PAN
OUT L
OUT R
L-DLY1 100MS
10MS
1MS
FDBK
L-DLY2 LOCUT
HICUT
RATE
DEPTH
WAVE
R-DLY1 100MS
10MS
10MS
FDBK
R-DLY2 LOCUT
HICUT
RATE
DEPTH
WAVE
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Pan
Left Delay Output Level
Right Delay Output Level
Delay Time Hundreds (LEFT) milliseconds
Delay Time Tens Digit
Delay Time Ones Digit
Delay Feedback
Low Frequency Cutoff
Hi Frequency Cutoff
Delay Modulation Rate
Delay Modulation Depth
Left Modulation LFO type
Delay Time Hundreds (RIGHT)
Delay Time Tens Digit
Delay Time Ones Digit
Delay Feedback
Low Frequency Cutoff
Hi Frequency Cutoff
Delay Modulation Rate
Delay Modulation Depth
Right Modulation LFO type
0.00-100.00
-100.0- +100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 24
0 - 9
0 - 9
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 250 msec
TRIANGLE or SINE
0 - 24
0 - 9
0 - 9
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 250 msec
TRIANGLE or SINE
Stereo
Chorus/Flanger
➟
CONFIG SEND
PAN
OUT
PARAM1
PARAM2
PARAM3
RATE
DEPTH
FDBK
THRU0
LPF
FBHPF
FBLPF
PDLYL
PDLYR
TRIG
ATTACK
RELEAS
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Pan
Effects Output Level
Chorus/Flange Rate
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Through Zero
Input Low Pass Filter
Feedback High-Pass Filter
Feedback Low-Pass Filter
Pre-Delay Time LEFT
Pre-Delay Time RIGHT
0.00-100.00
-100.0- +100.00
0 - 100%
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
ON/OFF off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 250 msec
Triggered Flange Input Monitor Off, Left, Right, L&R
Trigger Attack Threshold (start) 0 - 255
Trigger Release Threshold 0 - 255
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
235
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Quad Chorus
Chorus:Chorus
DISPLAY
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
MOD
PAGE
➟
CONFIG SEND
PAN
OUT
PARAM1 1RATE
1DEPTH
1FDBK
1WAVE
PARAM2
1PDTIM
2RATE
2DEPTH
2FDBK
2WAVE
PARAM3
PARAM4
PARAM5
2PDTIM
3RATE
3DEPTH
3FDBK
3WAVE
3PDTIM
4RATE
4DEPTH
4FDBK
4WAVE
4PDTIM
WIDTH
2LEVEL
3LEVEL
➟
CONFIG SEND
PAN
OUT L
OUT R
L-CHRS1 RATE
DEPTH
FDBK
PDTIM
L-CHRS2 LPF
FBHPF
FBLPF
WAVE
THRU0
R-CHRS1 RATE
DEPTH
FDBK
PDTIM
R-CHRS2 LPF
FBHPF
FBLPF
WAVE
THRU0
PARAMETER NAME
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Pan
Effects Output Level
Chorus/Flange Rate (1 st
tap)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Modulation LFO type
Pre-Delay Time
Chorus/Flange Rate (2 nd
tap)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Modulation LFO type
Pre-Delay Time
Chorus/Flange Rate (3 rd
tap)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Modulation LFO type
Pre-Delay Time
Chorus/Flange Rate (4 th
tap)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Modulation LFO type
Pre-Delay Time
Quad Chorus Stereo Width
Out Level of 2 nd
Chorus
Out Level of 3 rd
Chorus
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Pan
Left Chorus Output Level
Right Chorus Output Level
Chorus/Flange Rate (Left)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Pre-Delay Time
Input Low Pass Filter
Feedback High-Pass Filter
Feedback Low-Pass Filter
Modulation LFO type
Through Zero
Chorus/Flange Rate (Left)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Pre-Delay Time
Input Low Pass Filter
Feedback High-Pass Filter
Feedback Low-Pass Filter
Modulation LFO type
Through Zero
RANGE
0.00-100.00
-100.0- +100.00
0 - 100%
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
TRIANGLE or SINE
0 - 250 msec
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
TRIANGLE or SINE
0 - 250 msec
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
TRIANGLE or SINE
0 - 250 msec
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
TRIANGLE or SINE
0 - 250 msec
± 99
0 - 99
0 - 99
0.00-100.00
-100.0- +100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 250 msec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
TRIANGLE or SINE
ON/OFF
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 250 msec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
TRIANGLE or SINE
ON/OFF
236 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Quad Pitch
Shifter
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAM2
PARAM3
PARAM4
PARAM5
2FDBK
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
PARAM1
PAN
OUT
1SEMI
1FINE
PARAMETER NAME
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Pan
Effects Output Level
Pitch Shift, Semitones
Pitch Shift, Fine
1LEVEL
1PAN
1PDTIM
2SEMI
Output Level of this element
Output Pan " " "
Pre-Delay Time
Pitch Shift, Semitones
2FINE
Pitch Shift, Fine
2LEVEL
2PAN
2PDTIM
3SEMI
Output Level of this element
Output Pan " " "
Pre-Delay Time
Pitch Shift, Semitones
3FINE
Pitch Shift, Fine
3LEVEL
3PAN
3PDTIM
4SEMI
Output Level of this element
Output Pan " " "
Pre-Delay Time
Pitch Shift, Semitones
4FINE
Pitch Shift, Fine
4LEVEL
4PAN
4PDTIM
1FDBK
Pitch Feedback,
2 nd
element
Output Level of this element
Output Pan " " "
Pre-Delay Time
Pitch Feedback, 1 st
element
– 99% to + 99% HiCut Hi
Frequency Cutoff off, 29Hz -
41.3KHz
RANGE
0.00-100.00
-100.0- +100.00
0 - 100%
± 12 semitones (2 octave range)
± 50 cents (1 semitone range)
0 - 100%
± 50
0 - 250 msec
± 12 semitones (2 octave range)
± 50 cents (1 semitone range)
0 - 100%
± 50
0 - 250 msec
± 12 semitones (2 octave range)
± 50 cents (1 semitone range)
0 - 100%
± 50
0 - 250 msec
± 12 semitones (2 octave range)
± 50 cents (1 semitone range)
0 - 100%
± 50
0 - 250 msec
– 99% to + 99%
0.00-100.00
MIX
OUT
LEZLE1 MOTOR
SPEED
HIROT
ROOM1 DECAY
LPF
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Table of Digital Effects
Parameters (continued)
CONFIG DISPLAY PARAMETER
NAME MOD PAGE
DISPLAY PARAMETER
NAME RANGE Lezlie >
Room fl CONFIG SEND Send
(Input Level from Voice)
Input Mix of Room
Effect Chain Output Level
Rotary Motor On/Off
Motor Speed
High Rotor Level
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
ON - OFF
FAST or SLOW
0 - 250
100 -8153 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
237
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Delay > Room
ROOM2
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
LDAMP
HDAMP
GATE
➟
CONFIG SEND
MIX
OUT
DELAY1 100MS
10MS
1MS
FDBK
DELAY2 LOCUT
HICUT
DENS
RATE
DEPTH
DELAY3 TREMR
TREMD
PANR
PAND
ROOM1
ROOM2
DECAY
LPF
DENS
DIFF
GATE
HOLD
RELEAS
Room Pre-Delay Time
Room Pre-Delay Mix
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Low Frequency
Damping
Room High Frequency
Damping
Room Gate Hold Time
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 500 msec
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Mix of Room
Effect Chain Output Level
Delay Time Hundreds of milliseconds
Delay Time Tens Digit
Delay Time Ones Digit
Delay Feedback
Low Frequency Cutoff
Hi Frequency Cutoff
Reflection Density
Delay Modulation Rate
Delay Modulation Depth
Tremelo Rate
Tremelo Depth
Pan Rate
Pan Depth
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Gate Level
Room Gate Hold Time
Room Gate Release Time
0.00-100.00
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 24
0 - 9
0 - 9
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 100%
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 100%
1.00 - 75.8 sec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100
0 - 500 msec
0 - 500 msec
238 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Chorus > Room
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
MIX
OUT
CHORS1
CHORS2
CHORS3
LRATE
LDEPTH
LFDBK
LPDLY
RRATE
RDEPTH
RFDBK
RPDLY
CLPF
CFBHPF
CFBLPF
ROOM1
ROOM2
DECAY
RLPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
GATE
Room > Flange
➟
CONFIG SEND
MIX
ROOM1
OUT
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
ROOM2
FLANG1
FLANG2
DENS
DIFF
RATE
DEPTH
FDBK
PDTIME
THRU0
LPF
FBHPF
FLANG3
FBLPF
TRIG
ATTACK
RELEAS
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Mix of Room
Effect Chain Output Level
Chorus/Flange Rate (Left)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Pre-Delay Time
Chorus/Flange Rate (Right)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Pre-Delay Time
Chorus Input Low Pass Filter
Chorus Feedback High-Pass
Filter
Chorus Feedback Low-Pass
Filter
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Pre-Delay Time
Room Pre-Delay Mix
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Gate Hold Time
0.00-100.00
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 250 msec
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 250 msec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
100 -8153 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 500 msec
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Mix of Room
Effect Chain Output Level
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Pre-Delay Time
Room Pre-Delay Mix
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
0.00-100.00
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
100 -8153 off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
Chorus/Flange Rate (Left)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
Pre-Delay Time
Through Zero
0 - 250 msec
ON/OFF
Flange Input Low Pass Filter off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Flange Feedback High-Pass
Filter
Chorus Feedback Low-Pass
Filter off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Triggered Flange Input Monitor Off, Left, Right, L&R
Trigger Attack Threshold (start)
Trigger Release Threshold
0 - 255
0 - 255
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
239
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
Flange > Delay >
Room (MULTI 3)
➟
CONFIG SEND
MIX 1
MIX 2
OUT
FLANG1
FLANG2
RATE
DEPTH
FDBK
PDTIME
THRU0
LPF
FBHPF
DELAY
ROOM1
ROOM2
FBLPF
TRIG
ATTACK
RELEAS
DELAY
FDBK
HICUT
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
GATE
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Mix of Delay
Input Mix of Room
Effect Chain Output Level
0.00-100.00
0.00-100.00
0.00-100.00
0 - 100%
Chorus/Flange Rate (Left)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Pre-Delay Time
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 250 msec
Through Zero
Flange Input Low Pass Filter
ON/OFF off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Flange Feedback High-Pass
Filter off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Flange Feedback Low-Pass
Filter off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Triggered Flange Input Monitor Off, Left, Right, L&R
Trigger Attack Threshold (start)
Trigger Release Threshold
0 - 255
0 - 255
Delay Time 0 – 500 ms
Delay Feedback
Hi Frequency Cutoff
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Pre-Delay Time
Room Pre-Delay Mix
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Gate Hold Time
1.00 –81.53 secs.
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 500 msec
240 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Room + Delay
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
BLEND
RM OUT
DL OUT
ROOM1
ROOM2
DECAY
LPF
DENS
DIFF
GATE
HOLD
RELEAS
DELAY1 100MS
10MS
1MS
FDBK
DELAY2 LOCUT
HICUT
DENS
RATE
DEPTH
DELAY3 TREMR
TREMD
PANR
PAND
PARAMETER NAME RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Blend
Room Output Level
Delay Output Level
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Gate Level
Room Gate Hold Time
Room Gate Release Time
Delay Time Hundreds
Delay Time Tens Digit
Delay Time Ones Digit
Delay Feedback
Low Frequency Cutoff
Hi Frequency Cutoff
Reflection Density
Delay Modulation Rate
Delay Modulation Depth
Tremelo Rate
Tremelo Depth
Pan Rate
Pan Depth
0.00-100.00
±100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
1.00 –81.53 secs.
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100
0 - 500 msec
0 - 500 msec
0 - 24
0 - 9
0 - 9
– 99% to + 99% off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 100%
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 100%
0 - 6.47Hz
0 - 100%
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
241
Chapter 10: Using Effects
Table of Digital Effects Parameters (continued)
CONFIG
NAME
Room + Chorus
MOD
DISPLAY
PAGE
PARAMETER
DISPLAY
➟
CONFIG SEND
BLEND
RM OUT
CH OUT
ROOM1
ROOM2
CHORS1
CHORS2
CHORS3
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
DENS
DIFF
HOLD
LRATE
LDEPTH
LFDBK
LPDTIM
RRATE
RDEPTH
RFDBK
RPDTIM
LPF
FBHPF
FBLPF
PARAMETER NAME
Room + Flange
➟
CONFIG SEND
BLEND
ROOM1
RM OUT
FL OUT
DECAY
LPF
PDTIME
PDMIX
ROOM2
FLANG1
FLANG2
DENS
DIFF
HOLD
RATE
DEPTH
FDBK
PDTIM
THRU0
LPF
FBHPF
FBLPF
TRIG
ATTACK
RELEAS
RANGE
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Blend
Room Output Level
Chorus Output Level
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Pre-Delay Time
Room Pre-Delay Mix
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Gate Hold Time
Chorus/Flange Rate (1 st
tap)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Pre-Delay Time
Chorus/Flange Rate (2 nd
tap)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Pre-Delay Time
Chorus Input Low Pass Filter
Chorus Feedback High-Pass
Filter
Chorus Feedback Low-Pass
Filter
0.00-100.00
±100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
1.00 –81.53 secs.
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 500 msec
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 250 msec
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 250 msec off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Send (Input Level from Voice)
Input Blend
Room Output Level
Flange Output Level
Room Reverb Decay Time
Room Input Low-Pass Filter
Room Pre-Delay Time
Room Pre-Delay Mix
Room Reverb Density
Room Reverb Diffusion
Room Gate Hold Time
Chorus/Flange Rate (1 st
tap)
Chorus/Flange Depth
Chorus/Flange Feedback
Pre-Delay Time
Through Zero
Flange Input Low Pass Filter
0.00-100.00
±100.00
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
1.00 –81.53 secs.
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
0 - 250 msec
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 500 msec
0 – 6.477 Hz
0 - 250
– 99% to + 99%
0 - 250 msec
ON/OFF off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Flange Feedback High-Pass
Filter
Flange Feedback Low-Pass
Filter off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
off, 29Hz - 41.3KHz
Triggered Flange Input Monitor Off, Left, Right, L&R
Trigger Attack Threshold (start)
Trigger Release Threshold
0 - 255
0 - 255
242 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 11: Mix Mode
C
HAPTER
11:
M
IX
M
ODE
The basics of Mix Mode operation including how to select a Mix, change a
Program within a Mix, and the complete list of Mix Parameters can be found in Chapter 2, pages 39 through 42. Setting up Splits and
Layers is covered on pages 47 and 48.
W
HAT IS A
M
IX
?
Mix Mode is one of the most powerful features of the Andromeda. Although in
Program Mode you can play only one Program at a time, in Mix Mode you can play up to 16 Programs at once, either from the keyboard (as layers or splits) or from an external sequencer (via 16 MIDI channels) or a combination of both. Keep in mind, however, that since the Andromeda has a total of 16 voices, a full 16-channel Mix would have only one voice per channel.
Having said that, with Mix Mode, you can do the following:
•
Combine (“stack” or “layer”) different Programs so they can be played simultaneously from the keyboard. For example, stack a stabbing synth sound on top of a warm pad, adjusting the volume of each to get the mix you want.
•
Split the keyboard into different zones—for example, the classic bass synth on the left-hand side of the keyboard, and a brass program on the right. You can split the keyboard into as many as 16 zones, which may overlap.
•
Transmit on as many as 16 different MIDI channels simultaneously.
•
Receive up to 16 MIDI channels from an external sequencer, with each channel representing a different instrument.
Or, you can have several different programs on different Mix Channels responding to the same MIDI channel. More on this below.
•
Set the level, panning, transposition, and output assignment of each Program in a
Mix.
•
Enable and disable the major controllers such as Pitch Bend, Mod Wheel, Ribbon
Controller, etc. individually per Channel.
M
IX
C
HANNELS VS
. MIDI C
HANNELS
Most digital synthesizers (including the Alesis QS Series) assign one Program per
MIDI channel in a multitimbral Mix. But while the Andromeda has 16 Mix
Channels, that is not the same as the 16 conventional MIDI channels. Several A6 Mix
Channels may be “played” by only one MIDI channel if desired. This means that if you want to play a layer of several Programs, you don’t have to clog the MIDI sequencer with duplicate tracks and messages.
For example, you could have Mix Channels 1, 2 and 3 layered together, playing to and responding to MIDI channel 8. Mix Channels 4 and 5 could be a bass layer responding to MIDI channel 9.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
243
Chapter 11: Mix Mode
C
OMMON
M
IX
S
ETTINGS FOR
MIDI S
EQUENCERS
The easiest way to use the A6 with a MIDI sequencer is to use one of the preprogrammed Mixes in the Preset or User banks. See the Program/Mix chart for the
Mix set up for multitimbral use that’s appropriate for your situation.
But if you want to start from scratch or edit an existing Mix, here are the steps:
T
O MAKE A CUSTOM MULTITIMBRAL
M
IX
:
1.
Press the
MIX
button.
2.
Select a Mix to start with using the
PROGRAM GROUP/NUMBER
, and
BANK
keys.
Select a Mix Channel
3.
Select Mix Channel 1 by pressing the black
MIX SELECT 1/9
key.
Make sure the right side of the display window has a box that says
MIX CHAN 1
. If it says MIX CHN 9, press the SHIFT key and press MIX SELECT 1/9 again.
4.
If the green LED above the
MIX SELECT
key isn’t flashing, press it again to enable the channel.
A small box in the display should say ON and an arrow appear pointing to the current
Mix Channel. The flashing LED above the switch means the Mix Channel is currently selected for editing and is ON.
Set the Keyboard parameters
5.
Press soft button
5
(
KBD
).
6.
If you want to play this mix channel from the keyboard*, make sure that
ENABLE is set to ON using soft knob
4
. Set the high and low ranges using soft knobs
1
and
2
.
Set the MIDI parameters
7.
Press soft button
6
(
PROG
).
8.
Set the MIDI channel for this Mix Channel by turning soft knob
6
( MIDICH ).
9.
Press soft button
7
( CNTL ). If the first parameter isn’t MID IN , press it again. Set
MID IN to ON using soft knob
1
.
10. If you’re going to be using this Mix Channel to send note messages to the sequencer*, set MIDOUT (soft knob
2
) to ON.
* In most MIDI sequencer applications, you’ll want to send only one MIDI channel from the keyboard, and the sequencer will be set to “echo” the MIDI notes back to the synthesizers. The sequencer will also be able to re-route a
MIDI channel as you’re recording. (For example, most people send only MIDI
Channel 1 messages from their keyboard, and allow the computer to record the data onto other MIDI channels.) The Andromeda’s
GLOBAL
mode can also affect how MIDI is handled; either generating MIDI messages without making a sound until a MIDI message is “echoed” back (local mode) or if it will not generate MIDI messages at all, regardless of the Mix settings. See pages 49 and
50, Using Global Mode/
KEYBD
Page Parameters.
Select a Program for the Mix Channel
11. When you’re on Mix Mode’s
PROG
page, the
PROGRAM GROUP/NUMBER
, and
BANK
keys may be used to change programs. You can also select a different Program by pressing soft button
2
,
DIR
(for “Directory”) and scrolling through it. But be sure the currently-selected page is not
MIX
, or you will lose all your edits!
244 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 11: Mix Mode
Set Controller parameters
At this point, it should be self-explanatory to go on to the
CNTL
page and decide whether you want this program to respond to various controller messages. For example, you can have a lead synth part affected by the pitch bend, while the bass patch on another Mix Channel stays steady.
Repeat on other Mix Channels
To add other Mix Channels, simply repeat steps 3-11 above, selecting different channels in step 3. Don’t forget to press
STORE
along the way… a careless punch of a program button at the wrong time could take you to another Mix altogether, losing the edits you’ve made.
MIDI P
ROGRAM
C
HANGE
M
ESSAGES
Note that if several different Mix Channels are on the same MIDI Channel, a
Program Change message received via MIDI will make all the Mix Channels on that
MIDI Channel go to the same Program…not usually a useful result. To avoid this, if you’re using PgmCh messages, go to the CNTL page where MIDPGM is and turn soft knob
6
so that Mix Channel will ignore the messages.
E
DITING
P
ROGRAMS FROM
M
IX
M
ODE
Especially when you’re combining Programs in a stack to make a single combined sound, you may find that an individual Program needs to be “tweaked” a bit to make it sound right. You don’t need to leave Mix Mode to do that. Programs are live on the front panel upon Mix Channel selection, and can be edited while the other
Channels play. You may edit all Programs in a Mix as there are (of course) 16 edit buffers. You may Store an edited Program back to its Program User Bank location by simply pressing Store twice. Or, you can Store a Mix Channel Program to any location so that the original Program may be preserved.
If you have done editing of Programs in Mix Mode, you must store each Program individually, as well as storing the Mix that calls on them. If you’re not sure which parameters are part of the Mix and which are part of the Programs, see pages 34 -35,
Data Banks: How the A6’s Sounds Are Organized.
M
IX
SOLO
You may solo a Mix Channel by pressing SOLO (soft button
8
) on any screen of Mix
Mode. SOLO mode is indicated by a text box on the screen, and the
SOLO
logo will flash. In this mode, all other Mix Channels are muted, both audio and MIDI Out.
T
O COPY A
M
IX
C
HANNEL FROM ANOTHER
M
IX
:
Mix Channel complete with its effect sends and MIDI channel assignments may be copied to the Mix Edit buffer from any Mix in memory. The procedure is similar to that for copying an effect.
1.
Start with the Mix you’re editing (of course). Press
STORE
.
2.
Press
COPY
(soft button
3
).
3.
Using TYPE (soft knob
1
), select MIX CHAN .
4.
Select the specific Mix you want to copy from using the
SRCBNK
and
SRCNUM knobs (soft knobs
2
and
3
).
The name of the Mix will be shown in the display.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
245
Chapter 11: Mix Mode
5.
Select the source Mix Channel (1–16) using soft knob
4
(
MIXCHN
).
6.
Select the destination Mix Channel (1–16) using soft knob
8
( MIXCHN ).
MIX EDIT MIXCHAN: XX
will be shown in the display.
7. Press soft button
3
( COPY ).
A window will pop up asking you to press STORE to copy the effect.
8.
Press
STORE
.
E
FFECTS IN
M
IX
M
ODE
Effects, both Digital and Analog Distortion, are stored per Mix, and can be copied from Programs or other Mixes. Note that while each individual Program has its own
Effects parameters in Program Mode, these aren’t brought into the Mix since there aren’t 16 separate Digital Effects and Analog Distortion sections. However, you can vary the Effect Send and Pan levels from each Mix Channel.
Effects are selected and created in a Mix in the same manner as in Program, by using the Effects buttons and pages (see Chapter 10).
T
O SET EFFECT SEND LEVELS FOR DIFFERENT
M
IX
C
HANNELS
:
1.
Select different Channels using the
MIX SELECT
and
SHIFT
keys.
2.
Press the
ANALOG DISTORTION CONFIG OR DIGITAL EFFECTS CONFIG
buttons on the top panel.
3.
Notice that soft knob
1
’s parameter title is SEND X , where X is the number of the current Mix Channel. If the Digital Effect has a
PAN
control, it will also show the number of the Channel.
4.
Use the soft knobs to get the values you want. Note that any other changes you make besides SEND and PAN will be to the effect for the entire Mix, not just the current Channel.
T
O COPY AN EFFECT FROM ANOTHER
P
ROGRAM OR
M
IX
:
A Digital Effects and/or Analog Distortion configuration may be copied from any
Program or Mix in memory. These are copied to the Mix Edit Buffer, so you can customize them before storing them along with the current Mix.
1.
Start with the Mix you’re editing (of course). Press
STORE
.
2.
Press
COPY
(soft button
3
).
3.
Select the type of effect you want to copy to the current mix using
TYPE
(soft knob 1):
•
PRG DFX to copy a Digital Effect from a Program.
•
PRG AFX
to copy an Analog Distortion from a Program.
•
MIX DFX to copy a Digital Effect from a Mix.
•
MIX AFX
to copy an Analog Distortion from a Mix.
4.
Select the specific Program or Mix you want to copy from using the
SRCBNK and
SRCNUM knobs (soft knobs
2
and
3
).
The name of the Program or Mix will be shown on the screen.
5.
The display should show MIX EDIT BUFFER . If not, turn soft knob 6 ( DSTBUF ) until it does.
6. Press soft button 3 (
COPY
).
A window will pop up asking you to press STORE to copy the effect.
7.
Press
STORE
.
Remember—even though you pressed
STORE
, the effect is only in the Mix Edit Buffer until you store the Mix itself to either the User Bank or a Card.
246 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
C
HAPTER
12:
MIDI F
UNCTIONS
MIDI B
ASICS
Before we delve into the specific MIDI functions of the A6, we’d like to provide a brief background on MIDI for those who may not be familiar with this technology.
MIDI (pronounced “MID-ee”) is the acronym for Musical Instrument Digital
I
nterface. It was developed and adopted by electronic musical instrument manufacturers in the early 1980s as a common system of connecting electronic musical instruments and devices so that they could share music data as well as other digital information.
Just about any device that has a microprocessor (synthesizers, samplers, sequencers and drum machines, analog and digital recorders and mixers, effects devices and computers) can share music data (notes and chords) and various digital information such as pitch bend and vibrato, sustain and volume pedal, keyboard velocity, pressure and aftertouch, patch change commands, timing data (called “MIDI Clock”) and a wide variety other types of data.
Thus, virtually any musical expression that is generated by an electronic musical device could be shared in a system of MIDI devices. But we are not limited to musical applications alone. With the addition of MIDI Time Code for example, the ability to interface a music system with video production was realized. There are even stage lighting systems that use MIDI for programming light control and data storage.
A document called the MIDI Specification describes all possible MIDI functions and how they should work. Manufacturers use this spec when designing products so that a fairly high level of compatibility among different brands can be reasonably expected.
Generally, a manufacturer will also include a MIDI Implementation chart with each product so that you can know how MIDI was designed into that particular model.
This is usually helpful to know because not every MIDI function needs to be included in every musical product. For example, certain MIDI functions that are unique to keyboard instruments are unnecessary on, say, digital effects devices.
Manufacturers have the option of including whatever MIDI functions are appropriate to the product. You can find the MIDI Implementation chart for the A6 in Appendix C.
MIDI H
ARDWARE
MIDI instruments and devices are connected by a fairly simple system of cables. The
MIDI OUT
port transmits data from one device one-way through the cable to the receiving instrument’s
MIDI IN
. You can setup each device in the system to send and respond to MIDI commands in a certain way. For example, you can tell your keyboard or guitar synth to send everything in MIDI except for Program Change commands. By the same token, you can tell your sound module to respond to any
MIDI command sent to it but ignore Velocity data.
MIDI THRU
simply passes data received by
MIDI IN
right back out to another device connected to it. This makes “chaining” possible in a MIDI system.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
247
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
For some examples in connecting MIDI devices together, see our illustrations in
MIDI
Connections
starting on page 23. This MIDI Chapter will take these basic connections and provide many examples of using your A6 to control other instruments in a MIDI system, and playing your A6 from another MIDI device.
MIDI M
ESSAGES
The are two types of MIDI messages that are communicated through your network of MIDI cables: Channel and System.
Channel Messages
are typically the messages you’ll be most concerned with for routine MIDI operations and can originate (be transmitted) from virtually any device in the system. MIDI provides 16 “Channels” through which certain MIDI data is shared among devices in the system. The communication of certain messages along
Channels makes it possible to connect many devices together but allows you to specify which devices communicate directly with each other. For example, you could have seven MIDI devices that are all connected to each other. Two of the devices can be communicating on Channel 2, two others on Channel 9 and the remaining three on Channel 4, as one possible setup.
Channel messages are further divided into two groups: Voice messages and Mode messages. Because these messages are channelized (they are communicated on a designated Channel number), they are only recognized by instruments that have
been set to receive on that Channel
(or Omni On mode which tells the receiving device to respond to data from all Channels – see Mode Messages on page 251).
System Messages
, on the other hand, do not have a channel number and can be received by any device in a system. This permits devices in a MIDI system to share certain data without having to be set to a particular Channel. System messages, like
Channel messages, can originate from just about any MIDI device in the system. The three types of System messages are called Real Time messages, Common messages and
Exclusive messages.
Channel Messages: Voice Messages
Each MIDI device is assigned a Basic MIDI Channel. This is the MIDI Channel that the instrument will use to transmit MIDI data and can be set to any Channel number 1 -
16. If OMNI Mode is set to
OFF
, this is also the MIDI Channel that the instrument will
receive
on.
This principle is not set in concrete, however. For many MIDI instruments, the ability to communicate – both transmit and receive – on several Channels at once is quite common. For example, certain instruments are designed such that you can set a
Voice or group of voices to MIDI Channels other than the Basic Channel. This provides enormous flexibility in the way that the instrument can control other instruments in the system, or be controlled by another MIDI device. You might want to think of a device’s Basic Channel as the one that other Channel settings can be based – hence the word “basic”. A good place to start is a setup that instructs the unit to transmit and receive on the Basic Channel, then build from there if you need to.
The A6 is a prime example of a multiple MIDI Channel instrument in that its Mix
Channels – ranges of MIDI notes used to define splits and layers – may be assigned a specific MIDI Channel to play from. Each of the A6’s 16 Mix Channels transmit and receive on a selected MIDI Channel and allow you to specify which of its 16 voices to play. For an in-depth look at how this is implemented on the A6, see page 47, and
Chapter 11: Mix Mode
.
248 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
MIDI messages that affect your instrument’s voices include:
Note On.
This message communicates that a particular note is being played and corresponds to a key being pressed down; values range from 000 (the lowest possible note) to 127 (the highest possible note). Middle C is MIDI Note #60.
Note Off.
Where a Note On message communicates when a note is to be played, this message tells when the key has been released. This may appear a little like overkill, but remember that we’re dealing with computers here: every action requires a corresponding message to be communicated.
Velocity.
A Velocity message corresponds to the dynamics of your playing by telling the receiving device how quickly (or slowly) a note was played. Typically, Velocity affects the loudness and brightness of the sound – playing harder makes the sound louder and brighter; playing softly makes the sound quieter and less bright. In the more elaborate products, this data can be routed to other aspects of the sound as well for some very interesting results. Velocity values range from 001 (minimum velocity) to 127 (maximum velocity). A velocity of 000 is equivalent to a Note Off message.
“Channel Pressure” and “Polyphonic Key Pressure”.
These messages communicate the physical pressure applied to the keyboard after a key is played. Channel Pressure
(commonly known as Aftertouch or Mono Pressure) represents the average amount of pressure applied by all keys. Polyphonic Key Pressure produces individual pressure messages for each key. As with Velocity, these functions typically affect the loudness and brightness of the sound – pressing harder can be used to make the sound louder and brighter. Also like Velocity messages, this data can be routed to affect other aspects of the sound: pressure can be used, for example, to add vibrato.
Program Change.
Sending a Program Change command from a sequencer or another
MIDI keyboard can change synth patches automatically. There are 128 Program
Change command numbers.
Also note that not all instruments and devices number programs consistently. Some number them as 000-127, others as 001-128, and still others arrange programs in banks of 8 programs (such as A1-A8, B1-B8, C1-C8, etc.).
Pitch Bend.
This “bends” a note from its standard pitch.
Continuous Controllers.
This term is sometimes abbreviated “CC” and is followed by a number sign and a number, as in “CC #7”. If you look at the chart on the next page, you’ll see that “Continuous Controller # 7” controls MIDI (or Main) Volume.
What we mean by “continuous” is that the controller is able “to go from 0 to 127 in increments of 1”. Although this might first appear as a rough stepping from one value to the next, the resolution of 128 increments is small enough to provide a smooth transition through this range. If this resolution is not fine enough, the manufacturer can opt to add more resolution by using a second byte to define the range. Controller #’s 32 through 63 are used for this purpose.
Footpedals, breath controllers, and modulation wheels can vary sounds as you play, thus adding expressiveness. MIDI allows for 32 continuous controllers and 58 continuous/switch controllers (which can act like continuous controllers, but some are assumed to choose between two possible states, such as on and off).
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
249
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
Each type of controller is stamped with its own controller identification number. Not all controller numbers have been standardized for specific functions, but the following table lists the current list of assigned controllers.
CONTROLLER #
99
100
101
95
96
97
98
91
92
93
94
69
80
81
82
83
64
65
66
67
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
17
18
19
8
10
11
16
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
32-63
FUNCTION
Bank Select
Modulation Wheel
Breath Controller
Early DX7 Aftertouch
Foot Controller
Portamento Time
Data Slider
Main Volume
Balance
Pan
Expression
General Purpose #1
General Purpose #2
General Purpose #3
General Purpose #4
Least Significant Bytes (LSB), Controllers 0-31
Sustain Pedal
Portamento On/Off
Sostenuto Pedal
Soft Pedal
Hold 2
General Purpose #5
General Purpose #6
General Purpose #7
General Purpose #8
Reverb Depth
Tremolo Depth
Chorus Depth
Celeste Depth
Phase Depth
Data Increment
Data Decrement
Non-Registered Parameter MSB
Non-Registered Parameter LSB
Registered Parameter MSB
Registered Parameter LSB
Reset All Controllers
Local Control On/Off
All Notes Off
Omni Off
Omni On
Mono On
Poly On
DATA RANGE
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 - 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0 or 127
0
0
0
0 or 127
0
0-16; 0 = Omni Off
0
250 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
Channel Messages: Mode Messages
There are four types of messages that determine the MIDI Mode of the instrument.
The “mode” of a device refers to how it will respond to incoming MIDI data.
The four possible modes are defined by the instrument’s Receive Status – Omni On or
Omni Off – and by it’s Voice Assignment – Poly or Mono.
The Omni On or Omni Off messages determine how many channels will be recognized when the instrument or device is receiving MIDI data. Omni On means that data from all channels will be received; Omni Off tells the receiving instrument to respond to MIDI data on one channel only.
The Poly and Mono messages determine the voice assignment of the instrument. An instrument’s voice is the most basic unit of sound generation. It can be an integrated circuit chip (or chips) like the A6, or can be a sampled sound in the instrument’s memory.
Each voice plays one note at a time, so the number of notes you can play at one time will be limited by the number of voices. The A6 is a 16-voice instrument so you can play up to 16 keys on its keyboard, receive up to 16 MIDI Notes, or a combination of
16 keyboard and MIDI Notes at one time.
So in Poly mode, the receiving instrument plays incoming MIDI notes
polyphonically
up to the number of voices it has (16 maximum for the A6). In Mono mode, the receiving instrument plays incoming MIDI notes monophonically: only one voice at a time plays in response to incoming MIDI notes.
The MIDI Specification combines the two Receive Status modes with the Voice
Assignment modes and describes each as follows:
Mode 1: Omni On/Poly
The instrument responds to notes from all Channels and plays them polyphonically.
This is a popular mode for many musicians in that it makes the unit play via MIDI regardless of what Channel other units in the MIDI system are set to. Most products ship from the factory with this mode enabled so that they will respond to MIDI polyphonically right out of the box.
Mode 2: Omni On/Mono
The instrument responds to notes from all Channels and plays them monophonically on one voice. This mode causes the receiving instrument to be monophonic and is the least used mode of the four.
Mode 3: Omni Off/Poly
The instrument responds to notes from one Channel only (which is set by the user) and plays them polyphonically. This is possibly the most-used mode for the majority of musicians. In most MIDI systems, each instrument is set to play polyphonically on a specific MIDI Channel.
Mode 4: Omni Off/Mono
In this mode, the receiving device is, in essence, divided into a number of monophonic instruments: each voice is assigned its own MIDI Channel and will play only one note at a time when incoming MIDI Notes are recognized.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
251
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
System Messages: Real-Time Messages
Timing Clock.
A tempo source (such as a sequencer) emits 24 timing messages
(clocks) per quarter note. Each device synchronized to the sequencer advances by
1/24th of a quarter note when it receives the clock message, thus keeping units in sync after they’ve both started at the same time. Many devices subdivide this clock signal internally for higher resolution (e.g., 96 pulses per quarter note).
Start.
Signals all rhythmically-based units when to start playing.
Stop.
Signals all rhythmically-based units when to stop playing.
Continue.
Unlike a Start command which re-starts a sequencer or drum machine from the beginning of a song each time it occurs, sending a Continue message after a
Stop command will re-start units from where they were when they stopped.
Active Sensing
. Active Sensing is a precautionary measure in MIDI that allows all instruments in a MIDI system to turn off any playing voices in the event that one or more MIDI cables become unplugged. Because receiving instruments wait for a Note
Off command to know when a note or chord has stopped playing, yanking a MIDI cable out while notes are being played will cause receiving instruments to have any sustaining notes get “stuck on”.
With Active Sensing, a message is sent from the transmitting device to all receiving devices about three times a second. Once receiving devices recognize this message, they will expect to continue to receive it. If this message stops – using our example of a MIDI cable being accidentally pulled out – the receiving instruments will perform an All Notes Off to stop any voices that might be playing at the time. When the offending cable is found and replaced, the system returns to normal.
System Reset
. Every MIDI instrument and device has a default set of parameters (all the factory settings the unit had when you first took it out of the box). These defaults can be restored if you manually initialize the instrument (see Troubleshooting section). System Reset is the command used to accomplish this via MIDI.
System Messages: Common Messages
Song Position Pointer.
This indicates how many “MIDI beats” (normally a 16th note) have elapsed since a piece started (up to 16,384 total beats or 1,024 measures in 4/4).
It is primarily used to allow different sequencers and drum machines to auto-locate to each other. If you start your sequencer for example, the other devices will automatically jump to the same place in the song, whereupon all continue on together. The sequencer in the A6 does not respond to SPP.
Song Select
. Intended for clock-based devices (such as drum machines and sequencers), this message tells all units in the system which Song Number to select.
This handy function allows you to instruct all clock-based units in your MIDI rig to load the appropiate song data from their own internal memory remotely.
You can think of Song Select as a kind of a Program Change command for drum machines and sequencers, although Song Select commands are not channelized. In fact, drum machines and sequencers do have the ability to respond to Program
Change commands transmitted on a specific Channel. When they do, they recall an individual drum pattern or sequence. Song Select is used to recall a Song which is typically composed of many patterns or sequences in the form of a finished song.
Tune Request
. Primarily intended for analog synthesizers which need to have their oscillators tuned periodically, this command instructs all units in the system to initiate an autotune routine.
252 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
End-of-System-Exclusive Message.
This byte is sent at the completion of a System
Exclusive message and that tells all units in a MIDI rig that a Program or Sample dump in progress has completed.
System Messages: Exclusive Messages
System Exclusive.
This message (called SysEx for short) is considered “exclusive” because different manufacturers send and receive data over MIDI which is intended only for that manufacturer’s equipment. For example, sending a A6 SysEx message to an Alesis DM Pro drum module won’t do anything, but the message will be understood by another A6.
System Exclusive messages most often contain the data of individual instrument programs: when synthesizer patches are transferred via SysEx, it is called a Program
Dump; sound samples transferred between two like devices via the MIDI Sample
Dump standard.
The System Exclusive message function of MIDI makes it possible for two or more synthesizers that are the same make and model to exchange program data. Two drum machines of the same make and model can exchange pattern and song data, much the same as two identical sequencers to exchange sequence and song data.
SysEx also makes it possible for MIDI editing using personal computers. It is often the case with complex synthesizers, drum machines and sequencers to have their functions buried in layers of display pages – a group of related functions that are shown together in the display. Often, a group of related functions is so large that all of them can’t be displayed at the same time, so they are broken up into many subgroups and hence displayed on many pages. This requires you to make numerous button presses and knob turns just to get to the page you want. This scenario is compounded by the fact that certain buttons and knobs have multiple functions and it is easy to get lost or confused in making even the simplest of edits, such as naming a program.
While this not as much of an issue on the A6 due to its large display, this synthesizer literally has thousands of parameters. SysEx editing software running on a personal computer displays most (if not all) of a device’s functions on-screen simultaneously.
The frustration level drops dramatically when you can move from page to page with a mouse click, or give a program a name by just typing it on your computer’s keyboard.
SysEx also makes it possible for personal computers and other hardware devices to store program, sample, pattern, sequence or song data to a hard disk, floppy disk or other storage media.
T
O SEND AN INDIVIDUAL
P
ROGRAM OR
M
IX OUT AS A
MIDI S
YSTEM
E
XCLUSIVE DUMP
:
1. Set your sequencer or data recorder to RECORD mode. Make sure System
Exclusive filtering, if any, is OFF.
2.
From Program or Mix mode, press
STORE
. Press Soft Button
5,
SYSEX.
3.
If you're not already on the Program or Mix you want to send, select it using the
BANK and NUMBER variables on Soft Knobs 1 and 2.
4.
Make sure that the
ALL
variable is set to
OFF using Soft Knob 4.
5.
A box in the display will read, HIT STORE TO SEND THIS PROGRAM (MIX)
OUT AS A SYSEX DUMP
. Do that.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
253
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
T
O SEND AN ENTIRE
P
ROGRAM OR
M
IX
B
ANK OUT AS A
MIDI S
YSTEM
E
XCLUSIVE DUMP
:
Follow the steps above, except in step 4, set the ALL variable to ON using Soft
Knob 4.
A
BOUT RECEIVING
S
YS
E
X DUMPS
:
In most cases, simply playing the MIDI sequence with the System Exclusive dump back into the Andromeda will put the SysEx data into the same User or Card bank it was saved from. Preset banks can not be written via System Exclusive dumps: you must burn them into the User bank and use the COPY function (explained on previous pages) to burn a new Preset bank.
Before the A6 can receive a SysEx dump, press the
GLOBAL
button, go to the
MIDI page, and set
SYXRX
(Sysex Receive) to
-ON-
.
The
SYSEX page of Store mode contains a useful feature under Soft Knob 3 labeled
RCV TO
(Receive To). This gives more flexibility in receiving SysEx messages:
NORMAL means that the incoming SysEx Program or Mix will be written to the original number location. If it was a Preset Program or Mix, it will go to the
User bank. If it was a Card bank and a card is present, it will write to the
Card.
->HERE
means that the incoming SysEx Program or Mix will overwrite the
Program or Mix currently shown in the display, regardless of its original bank or number.
BANK
allows you to write to either the User bank or the Card bank as chosen by
Soft Knob 1; it does not allow you to write over a Preset bank.
254
Portions of this appendix are abridged versions of material from Power Sequencing with Master Tracks
Pro/Pro 4 and The Complete Guide to the Alesis HR-16 and MMT-8, copyright 1990 and 1989 respectively by
AMSCO Publications, and are adapted with permission.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
MIDI
AND THE
A6 A
NDROMEDA
With the previous description of MIDI basics in mind, let’s continue with a few more details concerning the MIDI functions that are present in the A6. A
MIDI
Implementation Chart
is provided in
Appendix C
that lists the MIDI functions supported by the A6.
A6 C
HANNEL
M
ESSAGES
: M
ULTITIMBRAL
S
EQUENCING
As we mentioned on page 248, certain instruments are designed such that you can set a voice or group of voices to MIDI Channels other than the Basic Channel the instrument has been set to. This is an important concept to understand when setting up the A6 as a master (transmitting MIDI to other instruments) or as a slave
(receiving MIDI from other instruments) in a MIDI music system.
While the Andromeda's Mix Mode and MIDI both have 16 channels, it is possible for the
A6 to assign any Mix Channel to any MIDI channel if desired. The
Andromeda can send and receive on up to 16 channels at once.
For complete information on multitimbral MIDI operation, see
Chapter 11: Mix
Mode.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
255
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
S
ETTING
MIDI P
ARAMETERS IN
G
LOBAL
M
ODE
The most common MIDI transmission and reception variables are under the
GLOBAL button, on the MIDI page (Soft Button 3).
MIDI Page Parameters
PAGE
MIDI
PARAMETER
MIXSEL
Mix Select
PRGSEL
Program Select
BNKSEL
Bank Select
CC TX
Continuous
Controller
Transmit
CC RX
Continuous
Controller
Receive
SYX RX
System Exclusive
Receive
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
OFF
1 ··· 16
This parameter determines on which MIDI
Channel a Program Change command will select a new Mix.
When set to
OFF
, a MIDI Program Change will select a Program Mix Channel from within a
Mix
. In this case, MIDI Channel numbers and A6
Mix Channel numbers are matched.
For example, if a MIDI Program Change command is received on MIDI Channel 5, Mix
Channel 5 responds to the command.
1 ··· 16
This parameter determines on which MIDI
Channel a Program Change command will select a new Program.
This parameter is used to enable the A6 to work with the various Bank Select methods used by various controllers, modules and computer software (sequencers, etc.)
If you are controlling the A6 from another MIDI instrument, device or computer, refer to its
Owner’s Manual to see how it sends MIDI Bank
Select messages.
NORMAL This setting uses the LSB/MSB combination of
CC32/CC0. This method is the one recommended by the MIDI Manufacturers Association.
CC0
CC32
Controller 0 only selects a bank, CC32 is ignored.
Controller 32 only selects a bank, CC0 is ignored.
OFF, ON
Allows the A6 to send Continuous Controller messages (mod wheel, pitch wheel, aftertouch, volume, etc.), or for them to be turned off.
OFF, ON Allows the A6 to receive Continuous Controller messages.
OFF, ON Allows the A6 to receive A6-specific System
Exclusive messages. This is to protect patches from becoming unintentionally overwritten.
256 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
CC MAP Page Parameters
The fourth page of the GLOBAL menu allows you to set which of the 120 MIDI
Continuous Controller messages will be transmitted by the Andromeda's controllers.
PAGE
CC MAP
PARAMETER
PED CC
Pedal
FSW CC
Footswitch
RIBVCC
Ribbon Value
RIBLCC
Ribbon Left
RIBRCC
Ribbon Right
CTL NUM
Continuous
Controller
Number
CC IN
Continuous
Controller Input
OPTIONS or RANGE DESCRIPTION
OFF
1 ··· 120
This parameter determines what type of MIDI
Continuous Controller message will be transmitted by a pedal plugged into the
CV/PEDAL jack on the rear panel.
OFF
1 ··· 120
Sets what type of MIDI Continuous Controller message will be transmitted by a pedal plugged into the SWITCH jack on the rear panel.
OFF
1 ··· 120
Sets what type of MIDI Continuous Controller message will be transmitted by the entire
Ribbon.
OFF
1 ··· 120
Sets what type of MIDI Continuous Controller message will be transmitted by the left part of the Ribbon when it is split in the middle.
OFF
1 ··· 120
Sets what type of MIDI Continuous Controller message will be transmitted by the right part of the Ribbon when it is split in the middle.
CC A-H Selects which letter (A through H) of the A6's
Modulation sources will be mapped to a particular incoming Continuous Controller message. CC A etc. appear as Sources in MOD menus all over the Andromeda, allowing MIDI control of individual synth settings in real time.
0··· 127
Sets what number CC will be used to control the
Mod source currently selected by CTL NUM above.
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
257
Chapter 12: MIDI Functions
258 A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Appendix A: Glossary
G
LOSSARY
All Notes Off
Amplitude
a command that is transmitted to all devices in a MIDI system that prevents notes from becoming stuck on.
the level of a signal, its “intensity” (or lack of it) or the “signal strength”.
Channel
Channel Messages
data that communicates Voice and Mode messages on a specific, user-selected Channel.
Controllers
one of sixteen separate “paths” that Voice and Mode data can travel on.
Default
commands that are used for musical expression (volume, sustain, vibrato, etc.) or remote control of other devices in the
MIDI system (reverb depth, bank select, etc.).
a parameter’s pre-assigned value or factory setting.
Edit, Editing
Exponential
Frequency
Gate
Global
LED
Linear
Local
Logarithmic
MIDI
MIDI IN
changes made to a parameter in a Program or Mix, or to a Global function by adjusting its numeric value, turning it on or off and so forth.
a function that produces a decelerated rate of change (it “slows down”) as it approaches its destination value.
rate or speed, usually expressed in “cycles-per-second” which indicates how many times a wave or pattern is repeated in one second. Cycles-per-second is most often referred to as “Hertz” – abbreviated “Hz”.
similar to a trigger, a gate not only performs a “go” instruction but also carries with it a duration characteristic. Using the keyboard as an example, a gate signal is active for the time that
a key is held down
; a trigger is generated only at the instant the key is first played. Translating our definition of gate to MIDI, the duration of a gate is the time that elapses between the Note On and the Note Off commands. See also “Trigger”.
any function that affects the A6 no matter what play mode it’s in: global functions affect all Programs and Mixes. You can think of global functions as “master” functions.
Light Emitting Diode: the small panel lights on the A6’s front panel. When an LED next to a knob or button is on, this indicates that the function is active.
a function that produces an even rate of change that, when depicted by a graph, resembles a straight line.
any function that is physically present on the A6.
a function that produces an accelerated rate of change (it “speeds up”) as it approaches its destination value.
“Musical Instrument Digital Interface”; refers to the system of connecting microprocessor-controlled instruments and devices for sharing information.
the port on a device that receives MIDI data
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
259
Appendix A: Glossary
MIDI OUT
MIDI THRU
Mix
Mode
Note Off
Note
Omni Off
Omni On
Page
On
the port on a device that transmits the MIDI data generated by the device.
the port on a device that passes received MIDI data to the next device in the chain.
a performance mode where two or more Programs are played at the same time. Mix mode is where you make settings for splits and layers plus numerous combinations of Programs, and keyboard/MIDI control.
a particular state that an instrument or device is currently in; in MIDI, “mode” refers to the unit’s receive state that determines
1. how MIDI messages are received, and 2. how voices will be assigned to handle MIDI notes.
a general term that indicates that a pressed key on the local keyboard has been let go, a MIDI Note Off message has been received, or the end of the Gate Time from the Sequencer or
Arpeggiator has been reached.
a general term that indicates that a key has been pressed on the
A6’s keyboard, a MIDI Note On message has been received, or notes are being played from the A6’s Arpeggiator or Sequencer.
a receive function that instructs the device to respond to commands on a specific, user-selected Channel.
a receive function that instructs the device to respond to commands on any Channel.
a group of related parameters on the display.
Parameter
Program
Program Change
RAM
ROM
a basic element of an A6 function.
the settings that cause the voices to produce a particular sound.
a command that instructs the receiving instrument to recall a specific sound program from memory.
“Random Access Memory”: the physical circuit chips inside the
A6 where data is stored. RAM is a type of memory that you can change and is also referred to as user memory.
“Read Only Memory”: the physical circuit chips inside the A6 where data is stored. ROM is a type of memory that is permanent and is also referred to as preset memory.
SysEx
“System Exclusive”; data that is unique to a particular MIDI device.
System Messages
data that is transmitted to all devices in a MIDI system; this data is not Channel-specific.
Timing Clock
a data stream that synchronizes MIDI devices, such as a sequencer or drum machine.
Trigger
a “go” signal that is routed from a source (such as the keyboard) to a modulation function. A trigger has no significant duration as it is simply an electronic pulse. Translating our definition of trigger to MIDI, a trigger is the equivalent of a Note On command. See also “Gate”.
Voice the most basic component of a synthesizer that produces sound.
A voice is all of the hardware and software that is necessary to produce one note of sound.
260 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Appendix B: Table of Software Modulation Sources
M
OD
S
OURCES
TABLE OF SOFTWARE MODULATION SOURCES
DISPLAYED AS
1.
OFFSET ONLY
2.
VOX KEY NUMBER
3.
VOX KEY ON VEL
4.
VOX KEY OFF VEL
5.
KEY AFTERTOUCH
6.
MIDI AFTERTOUCH
7.
MOD WHEEL
8.
PITCH WHEEL
9.
RIBBON VALUE
10.
RIBBON LEFT
11.
RIBBON RIGHT
12.
LFO 1
13.
LFO 2
14.
LFO 3
15.
SAMPLE AND HOLD LVL
16.
ENVELOPE 1
17.
ENVELOPE 2
18.
ENVELOPE 3
19.
TRACK GEN STEP
20.
TRACK GEN LEVEL
21.
SEQ LEVEL A
22.
SEQ LEVEL B
23.
SEQ LEVEL C
24.
ARP KEY NUMBER
25.
ARP VELOCITY
MEANING
Fine adjustment amount by the onscreen fader only: no other modulation is present.
The key or MIDI Note Number for the voice being played.
The key or MIDI Note Velocity amount for the voice being played.
The key or MIDI Note Release Velocity amount for the voice being played.
The amount of Aftertouch from the A6’s keyboard.
The amount of Aftertouch from MIDI In.
Modulation wheel amount.
Pitch wheel amount.
Ribbon controller amount from anywhere on its entire length.
Ribbon controller amount from its left side only.
Ribbon controller amount from its right side only.
The current waveform of LFO 1.
The current waveform of LFO 2.
The current waveform of LFO 3.
The output level of the Sample and Hold generator.
Envelope 1.
Envelope 2.
Envelope 3.
The quantized output of the Tracking Generator (
QUANT parameter must be on).
The output level of the Tracking Generator.
The output of the Sequencer’s Note level.
The output of the Sequencer’s Velocity level.
The output of the Sequencer’s Gate level.
The Arpeggiator’s generated note values as set by its
LENGTH , OCTAVE , CENTER and TYPE parameters.
The velocity amounts of the Arpeggiator’s generated notes.
26.
PORTA LEVEL
27.
PORTA RAW LEVEL
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
261
Appendix B: Table of Software Modulation Sources
28.
VOICE RANDOM
29.
SUSTAIN PEDAL
30.
FOOT SWITCH
31.
CONTROL PEDAL
32.
MIDI VOLUME
33.
PGM KEY NUMBER
34.
KEY TRIG RATE
35.
PGM KEY ON VEL
36.
PGM KEY OFF VEL
37.
PGM KEY DOWN
38.
PGM NUMKEYS ON
39.
TEMPO
40.
MASTER CLOCK
41.
MIDI CLOCK
42.
MIDI START
43.
MIDI STOP
44.
MIDI FIRST CLK
45.
MIDI START/CONT
46.
SAMPHOLD CLOCK
47.
PGM KEY TRIGGER
48.
EXT TRIGGER 1
49.
EXT TRIGGER 2
50.
GLOBAL RANDOM
51.
ENV 1 ATTACK
52.
ENV 1 DECAY 1
53.
ENV 1 DECAY 2
54.
ENV 1 SUSTAIN
55.
ENV 1 RELEASE 1
56.
ENV 1 RELEASE 2
57.
ENV 1 END
58.
ENV 2 ATTACK
59.
ENV 2 DECAY 1
60.
ENV 2 DECAY 2
61.
ENV 2 SUSTAIN
62.
ENV 2 RELEASE 1
A note value picked at random from the notes currently being played.
The output level of an on/off sustain pedal.
The output level of an on/off foot switch.
The output level of continuous control pedal, e.g. volume pedal.
The current MIDI volume level.
The rate of the A6’s Master Clock.
The clock rate of an external MIDI device.
A MIDI Start signal from an external MIDI device.
A MIDI Stop signal from an external MIDI device.
A MIDI Stop/Continue signal from an external MIDI device.
The clock rate of the Sample and Hold Generator.
The Attack stage of Envelope 1.
The Decay 1 stage of Envelope 1.
The Decay 2 stage of Envelope 1.
The Sustain level of Envelope 1.
The Release 1 stage of Envelope 1.
The Release 2 stage of Envelope 1.
The final Level of Envelope 1 at the end of its Release 2 stage.
The Attack stage of Envelope 2.
The Decay 1 stage of Envelope 2.
The Decay 2 stage of Envelope 2.
The Sustain level of Envelope 2.
The Release 1 stage of Envelope 2.
262 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
63.
ENV 2 RELEASE 2
64.
ENV 2 END
65.
ENV 3 ATTACK
66.
ENV 3 DECAY 1
67.
ENV 3 DECAY 2
68.
ENV 3 SUSTAIN
69.
ENV 3 RELEASE 1
70.
ENV 3 RELEASE 2
71.
ENV 3 END
72.
MIDI CC A
73.
MIDI CC B
74.
MIDI CC C
75.
MIDI CC D
76.
MIDI CC E
77.
MIDI CC F
78.
MIDI CC G
79.
MIDI CC H
Appendix B: Table of Software Modulation Sources
The Release 2 stage of Envelope 2.
The final Level of Envelope 2 at the end of its Release 2 stage.
The Attack stage of Envelope 3.
The Decay 1 stage of Envelope 3.
The Decay 2 stage of Envelope 3.
The Sustain level of Envelope 3.
The Release 1 stage of Envelope 3.
The Release 2 stage of Envelope 3.
The final Level of Envelope 3 at the end of its Release 2 stage.
A MIDI Continuous Controller, selected for A-H in
GLOBAL
mode, on the
CC MAP
page. Any of the 128 different MIDI Controller numbers may be selected for any of the eight letters and used to modulate the A6 via
MIDI. See page 257.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
263
Appendix B: Table of Software Modulation Sources
264 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Appendix C: Troubleshooting
T
ROUBLESHOOTING
T
HE
A
UTO
-T
UNE
D
ISPLAY
The basics of
AUTO TUNE
were covered in Chapter 1: pressing the button twice initiates a software routine that will automatically tune every circuit in the
Andromeda that is subject to thermal drift. Ideally, you won't have to worry about the details of Auto Tune… simply press it twice every time you turn on the unit.
But if something still sounds out of tune on several different Programs after performing a complete Auto Tune, the Auto Tune display may be able to show you what's wrong so you can temporarily overcome the problem by turning off a malfunctioning voice.
T
IPS AND
T
RICKS ABOUT
T
UNING
If
AUTO TUNE
was last pressed when the A6 was warmed up, in most cases the unit won't fall out of tune from a short power on-off. Even if it does drift a bit, it will likely drift back into tune when the temperature returns to the old level, without having to press
AUTO TUNE
again.
If you don't have enough time to wait through an entire Auto Tune, you may be able to get most of the benefits of a complete Auto Tune routine by tuning the oscillators only. Press soft button
4
( OSCFRQ ) twice. (See below.)
Background tuning
constantly monitors the analog circuitry and adjusts it. The only reason to turn it off is if you like the slight drift in tuning that analog synths are famous (and infamous) for; but in most cases leaving background tuning on is a good idea. Background tuning on/off is the second parameter of the
TUNE
menu.
If you plan on making a Program or Mix that will be used on a different Andromeda, it's particularly important to make sure the unit is in tune before you make final adjustments and store the Program; otherwise it may sound very different on another unit.
Auto Tune Parameters
The Auto Tune display is different from other displays in that soft buttons
2
-
6
pull up the page with the first press, and start the specific tuning process with the second press.
SOFT KNOB
PAGE TAB
TUNE
AUTO
VCACAL
OSCFRQ
OSCPW
FILFRQ
1 2
MASTER BKTUNE
3 4 5 6 7 8
VOICE
VOICE
VOICE
VOICE
VOICE
BAND
BAND
BAND
BAND
BAND
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
265
Appendix C: Troubleshooting
AUTO TUNE Parameters
PAGE
TUNE
AUTO
VCACAL
OSCFRQ
OSC-PW
FILFRQ
PARAMETER
OPTIONS or RANGE
DESCRIPTION
MASTER
BKTUNE
VOICE
BAND
354.35 Hz ···
546.42 Hz
ON/OFF
1-16
1-16
Sets the basic tuning reference of the
Andromeda for A4 (the A above middle C).
The default is 440.00 Hz, which is the modern concert reference. You can set it to A=440 by pressing the
INC/DEC
keys.
Background tuning: when ON , the Andromeda will constantly check the oscillators for each of the 16 voices and adjust them to the tuning reference.
Selects which of the A6's sixteen voices is currently shown in the TUNE display.
Selects which oscillator tuning band is shown in the top line of the display.
Press twice to initiate a calibration of each VCA's base levels.
Press twice to tune the oscillators only.
Press twice to tune the pulse width of the oscillators only.
Press twice to tune the filter frequencies only.
H
OW TO
U
SE THE
TUNE D
ISPLAY
In any of the Auto Tune pages except
TUNE
itself, the upper window shows the result of the latest tuning procedure. Usually, this will be of no concern, but in case there's some problem, you can track it down using the display. There are a lot of things to tune in an analog synthesizer. Each of the Andromeda's 16 voice chips contains two oscillators. Each one of those oscillators can operate over many octaves, and needs to be tuned in 17 different bands so it will play in tune in any register. In addition, the pulse width, filter frequencies, and the VCAs may be calibrated.
With so many different variables, there's not room to monitor them on a single screen. So, you need to scroll through the displays using the
VOICE
and
BAND controls to see them all. Here's an example of what a screen may look like:
1: TUNEOK
2: TUNEOK
3: TUNEOK
4: TUNEOK
5: TUNEOK
6: TUNEOK
OSC1
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
OSC2
NOTUNE
NOTUNE
OSC1PW
NOTUNE
NOTUNE
OSC2PW
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
FILT1
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TUNEOK
TOOHI
FILT2 12
VOICE
1
BAND
The TUNEOK in the Oscillator columns means that the first six bands (which represent the lower octaves of the range) of this voice (12, in this case) went through an Auto
Tune process and were OK. The NOTUNE in the Oscillator Pulse Width column shows that the Pulse Width has not gone through an Auto Tune process. The
TOOHI in the 6 th
band of Filter 2 shows that Auto Tune was not able to bring this band into
266 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Appendix C: Troubleshooting
range. (Unless you're using Filter 2 as an oscillator, and playing it in the highest octaves, this won't be noticable.)
It isn't unusual for the very highest bands of the oscillators to be out-of-range after an
Auto Tune procedure, especially if the unit is cold. Try again after the unit has warmed up. Even when the tuning is not exact enough to "win" an "OK" from the computer, it may still sound OK. But if a voice won't show "OK" in its lower bands, after several attempts, the unit may require servicing.
T
O CHECK FOR AN OUT
-
OF
-
TUNE VOICE
:
1.
Press
AUTO TUNE
once.
2.
Turn the VOICE knob (soft knob
7
) to show Voice 1 in the display.
3.
Note any voice bands that do NOT say
TUNEOK
.
4.
Turn the BAND knob (soft knob
8
) to show band 7 at the top of the display.
5.
Again, note any voices that say
TOOHI
or
TOOLO
.
6.
Turn the BAND knob (soft knob
8
) to show band 13 at the top of the display.
7.
Again, note any voices that say
TOOHI
or
TOOLO
.
8.
Turn the VOICE knob (soft knob
7
) to show the next voice in the display, and repeat steps 3–8 until all bands of all sixteen voices are checked.
If a band isn't in tune, let the instrument warm up for a while, and perform a complete Auto Tune again before proceeding to the next step.
T
O TURN OFF AN UNTUNED VOICE
:
If the Auto Tune procedure doesn't fix a voice and it's noticeably out of tune, there may be a physical problem with the instrument. In this case, Auto Tune will automatically turn the voice off. All other voices may be in tune… it's only when this untuned voice is called on that you could hear a pitch problem. But the Andromeda does allow you to turn off individual voices using its Voice Monitor feature. You'll lose a voice of polyphony, but the voices that remain will be in tune.
After you know which voice can't be tuned using the procedure above:
1.
Press
GLOBAL
.
2.
Press
VOXMON
(soft button
8
).
3.
To turn a voice off, press any of the
SELECT
buttons (
1/9
through
8/16
). Press
SHIFT
to access voices 9–16.
If a voice was already OFF, the reason it showed
NOTUNE
in the display is that
Auto Tune was initiated while the voice was off. Turn the voice on and try Auto Tune again.
Another way to check quickly for "problem" voices is to watch the
VOXMON
display while playing. An "X" appears above the voice number as it's played. When you hear the voice that's out of tune, note which voice has an "X" above it.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
267
Appendix C: Troubleshooting
U
PGRADING THE
O
PERATING
S
YSTEM
While the Andromeda's sound-generating electronics are all analog, they are controlled by a digital microprocessor with software, just like a computer. This software resides in flash RAM memory, and is upgradable via a MIDI System
Exclusive dump from a computer sequencer capable of reading Standard MIDI Files.
Each operating system has a version number, such as "1.10". Over the course of time,
Alesis may make improvements to the operating system and make a new operating system available to registered Andromeda owners. Any improved operating system will have a higher number, such as "1.11" or "2.00". Check www.alesis.com or your
Alesis dealer for information about the latest version of A6 software. If you have a sequencer capable of sending System Exclusive dumps, you can upgrade the software yourself. Upgrading the software will not affect, in most cases, your
Programs and Mixes, but check the documentation to be sure, and make a backup copy (to card or a SysEx file) of your User banks before proceeding.
T
O DISPLAY THE VERSION OF SOFTWARE IN YOUR
A6:
Turn on the A6 while holding down soft button
6
. The display will show two different parts of the operating system: the OS burner or bootloader, and on the bottom line something like this:
PRESS STORE TO SEND A6 OS VERSION: X.XX OUT AS SYSEX
The "X.XX" is your current operating system. The bootloader, which is the basic code allowing you to upgrade the operating system itself, will probably never need upgrading.
Tip:
Before upgrading to a new version of software, connect the MIDI OUT of the A6 to the MIDI IN of a sequencer, set it to record a SysEx dump, and press
STORE
from this page. This will give you a backup copy of the old operating system in case there is a problem with transmitting the new one.
268
T
O UPGRADE THE SYSTEM SOFTWARE OF YOUR
A6:
The following instructions are a guideline only. Check Alesis.com for the most recent software upgrade procedures.
1.
Obtain the new operating system (OS), on a disc or via the Internet.
If the file is compressed (such as a .zip file), it will need to be decompressed via a shareware utility such as Unzip or Stuffit before using. The file will have the extension
".mid" (for MIDI files) or ".syx" (for System Exclusive only files). Check Alesis.com for detailed, up-to-date information about the operating system.
2.
Start your sequencer program and open the file with the new OS on it.
Make sure the program is capable of playing back long SysEx files without interruption.
You may need to open a blank sequence and import the SysEx file. It's a good idea to try playing the file to see how it's handled, before trying to send it to the A6. It is normal for many sequencers to "freeze" the display while sending a SysEx message, so it may seem that nothing is happening, but wait several minutes for the transmission to complete.
3.
Connect the sequencer's MIDI OUT to the MIDI IN of the Andromeda.
4.
Turn on the Andromeda while holding down soft button
7
. A screen will appear showing the current "bootloader" version (which is NOT the same version
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Appendix C: Troubleshooting
number as the operating software itself). It will also display, "IF RAM CARD IS
IN PLEASE REMOVE IT AND PRESS ANY SWITCH." Do that.
5.
The display will now say, "Press STORE to upgrade OS—any other switch to exit." Press
STORE
.
6.
A window will now appear showing the blocks of memory that will be received.
Press
PLAY
on your sequencer. You should see the count of blocks increment, and the progress bar will slowly fill in. This takes several minutes for a complete operating system.
7.
Eventually, after all blocks have been received, the screen will display a message
"GOOD DOWNLOAD–PRESS STORE TO BURN FLASH". For several minutes, messages of "Erasing Block XX" and "Writing Block XX" will appear.
Do not interrupt this process for any reason, or you will have to restart the whole procedure again. At worst, your memory may be corrupted requiring service.
8.
At the end of the process, the Andromeda will display a message indicating that the new OS has been burned to memory. It will automatically restart, and return the unit to Program mode.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
269
Appendix C: Troubleshooting
T
ROUBLESHOOTING
C
HART
If you experience problems while operating your Andromeda A6, please use the following table to check for possible causes and solutions before contacting Alesis customer service for assistance. Some of them may seem rather obvious, but you’d be amazed at how easy it can be to overlook the basics.
SYMPTOM
The display does not light up when the
ON/OFF
switch is turned on.
No sound.
Voices are out of tune with each other.
Unit responding strangely on all programs.
Unit not responding to
MIDI input.
CAUSE
No power.
SOLUTION
Check that the power cable is plugged in properly.
Volume is turned down.
Raise the
VOLUME
pot,
LEVEL
pot or volume pedal if one is being used.
MIDI Volume on master controller is set to 0.
Output has been switched to AUX or OFF.
Check MIDI Volume level on master MIDI device.
Press OUTPUT switch on right side until MAIN LED is lit.
Set to MIDI (local keyboard off) mode in the Global menu.
Voices are turned off.
Temperature changes after power-up affecting analog circuits.
Software glitch in memory.
Wrong MIDI channel being received.
Reception of MIDI
Program Change, CC,
SysEx, or other types of messages turned off.
Set to LOCAL mode.
Set to LOCAL or LOCMID on the GLOBAL/MIDI page, MODE parameter.
Press
GLOBAL
, go to the
VOXMON page, and turn the voices back on using the Mix Channel Select keys.
Press AUTO TUNE twice.
Then, enable Background
Tuning (see "The Auto
Tune Display" above).
Reinitialize Global parameters by turning unit on while holding Soft
Button 4.
Set MIDI channel using
GLOBAL/KEYBD page.
Or, if a Mix, make sure the
Channel is enabled (green
LED on) and is set to the right MIDI channel on the
MIX/PROG page.
Turn them on using the
GLOBAL/MIDI and CC
MAP pages.
Set to MIDI or LOCMID on the GLOBAL/MIDI page,
MODE parameter.
270 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Appendix C: Troubleshooting
SYMPTOM CAUSE SOLUTION
Unit "hangs" (won't respond to top panel) whenever a particular
Program, Mix, or Bank is accessed
Corrupted data in memory.
Mod wheel doesn't work as expected.
Mod wheel wasn't in lowest position when the unit was reinitialized.
Replace an individual
Program or Mix by a SysEx dump or the COPY feature in STORE mode.
If the entire User bank is corrupted, turn the unit on while pressing soft button
3. This erases the contents
of the User bank
and reinitializes the Global parameters as well.
If a Preset bank is corrupted, press STORE and use the COPY feature to overwrite the entire bank with a non-corrupted bank. Banks are also available on the Alesis web site.
Reinitialize the unit (turn on while holding down soft button 4) with the mod wheel in its full down position.
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
271
Appendix C: Troubleshooting
C
LEANING AND
M
AINTENANCE
While your Andromeda A6 should not need much attention, here are some tips for preventive maintenance:
• Disconnect the AC power Adapter, then use a damp cloth to clean the A6’s metal and plastic surfaces. For heavy dirt, use a non-abrasive household cleaner such as Formula 409® or Fantastik®. DO NOT SPRAY THE
CLEANER DIRECTLY ONTO THE FRONT OR BACK OF THE UNIT AS IT
MAY CONTAMINATE THE INTERNAL CARD SLOT CONTACTS, THE
DISPLAY OR THE FRONT PANEL BUTTONS! Spray onto a cloth, then use the cloth to clean the unit.
• Periodically check the power adapter for signs of fraying or damage.
• Unplug the Andromeda’s AC power adapter when not in use for extended periods of time.
• Place a dust cover over the unit when it is not in use.
• Vacuum around the RAM card slot to keep dust from falling into it. DO NOT
SPRAY ANY KIND OF CLEANER OR LUBRICANT into the card slot.
• The one place where contact cleaner may be useful is on the three 1/4” back panel jacks and cables. Periodically disconnect the A6 from AC power and all cables, and clean the 1/4” cable ends with rubbing alcohol or electronic contact cleaner, then work the plug into the jack repeatedly. DO NOT SPRAY
CONTACT CLEANER DIRECTLY INTO THE JACKS. It’s better to use a damp plug to clean the jacks, or use a cotton or foam swab (but be careful not to get cotton or foam stuck in the unit). While Alesis does not endorse the use of any specific product, certain contact enhancers (such as Cramolin™) may be used to keep the connections from corroding in the future.
272 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Appendix D: Specifications
S
PECIFICATIONS
MIDI I
MPLEMENTATION
C
HART
Basic
Channel
Mode
Function
Default
Changed
Default
Messages
Altered
Note
Number
Velocity
After
Touch
True Voice
Note On
Note Off
Keys
Ch’s
Pitch Bender
Control
Change
0 - 120
Prog
Change
System
Exclusive
System
Common
True #
System
Realtime
Aux
Messages
O
Song Position
Song Select
Tune Request
Clock
Commands
Local On/Off
All Notes Off
Active Sense
System Reset
O
X
X
X
X
O
O
X
O
X
X
X
Transmitted
1 - 16
1 - 16 each
Mode 3
X
* * * * * * * *
33-96
* * * * * * * *
O
O
X
O
1
0 - 127
* * * * * * * *
Notes
1
O , X is selectable
O
O
O
O
O
X
O
X
X
O
Recognized
1 - 16
1 - 16 each
Mode 3
X
33-96
33-96
X
X
O
X
O
O
O
1
0 - 127
0 - 127
Remarks
Memorized
Transmitted from CV pedals
CC #122
CC #123
CC #121
Mode 1: OMNI ON, POLY
Mode 2: OMNI ON, MONO
Mode 3: OMNI OFF, POLY
Mode 4: OMNI OFF, MONO
O : Yes
X : No
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
273
Appendix D: Specifications
S
PECIFICATIONS
Polyphony
16-voice, 16-channel multitimbral
Synthesis Method
True analog subtractive
Oscillators
2 oscillators (with sub-oscillation) per voice, 5 waveforms available (sine, triangle, square, up saw, down saw)
Filters
2-pole multimode resonating filter per voice, 4-pole lowpass resonating filter per voice
Program Memory
256 preset and 128 user-defined
Mix Memory
128 user-defined
Audio Outputs
16 mono outputs, one for each of 16 voices (eight 1/4" TRS jacks)
Stereo main outputs (two 1/4" jacks)
2 mono aux outputs (two 1/4" jacks)
Stereo headphone output (1/4" TRS jack)
Audio Inputs
Two 1/4" jacks
External Audio Filter Inputs
Three 1/4" jacks – one each for Voices 1-16, Voice 15, and Voice 16
Pedal Jacks
Pedal/CV, Switch and Sustain – each with dedicated 1/4" jack
MIDI Connections
MIDI In, Out, Thru
Memory Card Slot
PCMCIA-format
Power
100-230 VAC, 50/60 Hz 30W
Dimensions
(WxHxD)
40.1" x 4.8" x 16.1"
1019mm x 122mm x 409mm
Weight
47lbs.
21 kg
274 A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
Appendix E: Warranty
W
ARRANTY
This product is warranted by Alesis to the original purchaser against defects in material and workmanship for a period of 1 year for parts and labor from the date of purchase. Complete terms of the Limited Warranty are stated on the Warranty Card packed with the product. Please retain a copy of your dated sales receipt for proof of warranty status should repairs be necessary.
REFER ALL SERVICING TO ALESIS
We believe that your Andromeda A6 should provide years of trouble-free use.
However, should problems occur, DO NOT attempt to service the unit yourself.
Service on this product should be performed only by qualified technicians. THERE
ARE NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE.
OBTAINING REPAIR SERVICE
Before contacting Alesis, check over all your connections, and make sure you’ve read the manual. Your Alesis dealer may be able to offer further assistance.
Customers in the USA:
If the problem persists, copy down the serial number of your Andromeda A6 and call
Alesis USA at 1-800-5-ALESIS and request the Technical Support Department. Talk the problem over with one of our technicians; if necessary, you will be given a return authorization (RA) number and instructions on how to return the unit to Alesis or the nearest authorized service center. All units must be shipped prepaid and C.O.D.
shipments will not be accepted.
You must indicate the RA number on the shipping label or the shipment will not be accepted. If you do not have the original packing, ship the A6 in a sturdy carton with shock-absorbing materials such as foam or “bubble-pack” surrounding the unit.
Shipping damage caused by inadequate packing is not covered by the Alesis warranty. Ship the unit with insurance via a carrier that provides a tracking system.
Tape a note to the top of the unit describing the problem, include your name and a phone number where Alesis can contact you if necessary, as well as instructions on where you want the product returned. Alesis will pay for standard one-way shipping back to you on any repair covered under the terms of this warranty.
Field repairs are not authorized during the warranty period, and repair attempts by unqualified personnel may invalidate the warranty.
Customers outside the USA:
Contact your local Alesis dealer for warranty assistance. Do not return products to the factory unless you have been given specific instructions to do so. Your warranty is valid only in the country of purchase.
Internet Addresses:
Important information and advice is available on our web site:
http://www.alesis.com
E-mail may be addressed to: [email protected]
A
NDROMEDA
A6 R
EFERENCE
M
ANUAL
275

Public link updated
The public link to your chat has been updated.
Advertisement
Key features
- 16-voice real analog synthesizer
- Studio-quality effects system
- Elaborate MIDI system
- Classic 16-event Sequencer
- Ribbon Controller
- CV inputs
- Arpeggiator
- Performance wheels